2010 Nissan Sentra Owner's Manual
User Manual: 2010-sentra
Open the PDF directly: View PDF .
Page Count: 360
Download | |
Open PDF In Browser | View PDF |
® 2010 S E NTRA OWNER’S MANUAL For your safety, read carefully and keep in this vehicle. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : FOREWORD READ FIRST—THEN DRIVE SAFELY Welcome to the growing family of new NISSAN owners. This vehicle is delivered to you with confidence. It was produced using the latest techniques and strict quality control. Before driving your vehicle, please read this Owner’s Manual carefully. This will ensure familiarity with controls and maintenance requirements, assisting you in the safe operation of your vehicle. This manual was prepared to help you understand the operation and maintenance of your vehicle so that you may enjoy many miles (kilometers) of driving pleasure. Please read through this manual before operating your vehicle. WARNING IMPORTANT SAFETY INFORMATION REMINDERS FOR SAFETY! A separate Warranty Information Booklet explains details about the warranties covering your vehicle. The “NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide” explains details about maintaining and servicing your vehicle. Additionally, a separate Customer Care/Lemon Law Booklet (U.S. only) will explain how to resolve any concerns you may have with your vehicle, as well as clarify your rights under your state’s lemon law. Follow these important driving rules to help ensure a safe and comfortable trip for you and your passengers! Your NISSAN dealership knows your vehicle best. When you require any service or have any questions, they will be glad to assist you with the extensive resources available to them. ● ALWAYS use your seat belts and appropriate child restraint systems. Preteen children should be seated in the rear seat. ● NEVER drive under the influence of alcohol or drugs. ● ALWAYS observe posted speed limits and never drive too fast for conditions. ● ALWAYS give your full attention to driving and avoid using vehicle features or taking other actions that could distract you. ● ALWAYS provide information about the proper use of vehicle safety features to all occupants of the vehicle. ● ALWAYS review this Owner’s Manual for important safety information. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : MODIFICATION OF YOUR VEHICLE This vehicle should not be modified. Modification could affect its performance, safety or durability, and may even violate governmental regulations. In addition, damage or performance problems resulting from modifications may not be covered under NISSAN warranties. WHEN READING THE MANUAL This manual includes information for all options available on this model. Therefore, you may find some information that does not apply to your vehicle. CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65 WARNING WARNING All information, specifications and illustrations in this manual are those in effect at the time of printing. NISSAN reserves the right to change specifications or design without notice and without obligation. IMPORTANT INFORMATION ABOUT THIS MANUAL You will see various symbols in this manual. They are used in the following ways: WARNING This is used to indicate the presence of a hazard that could cause death or serious personal injury. To avoid or reduce the risk, the procedures must be followed precisely. APD1005 If you see this symbol, it means “Do not do this” or “Do not let this happen.” If you see a symbol similar to these in an illustration, it means the arrow points to the front of the vehicle. CAUTION This is used to indicate the presence of a hazard that could cause minor or moderate personal injury or damage to your vehicle. To avoid or reduce the risk, the procedures must be followed carefully. Arrows in an illustration that are similar to these indicate movement or action. Arrows in an illustration that are similar to these call attention to an item in the illustration. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Engine exhaust, some of its constituents, and certain vehicle components contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids contained in vehicles and certain products of component wear contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. CALIFORNIA PERCHLORATE ADVISORY Some vehicle parts, such as lithium batteries, may contain perchlorate material. The following advisory is provided: “Perchlorate Material – special handling may apply, See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.” BLUETOOTH威 is a trademark owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc., U.S.A. and licensed to Visteon. XM Radio威 requires subscription, sold separately after first 90 days. Not available in Alaska, Hawaii or Guam. For more information, visit www.xmradio.com. © Nissan Mexicana, S. A. de C. V. All rights reserved. No part of this Owner’s Manual may be reproduced or stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted in any form, or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or otherwise, without the prior written permission of Nissan Mexicana, S. A. de C. V. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : NISSAN CUSTOMER CARE PROGRAM NISSAN CARES . . . Both NISSAN and your NISSAN dealer are dedicated to serving all your automotive needs. Your satisfaction with your vehicle and your NISSAN dealer are our primary concerns. Your NISSAN dealer is always available to assist you with all your automobile sales and service needs. However, if there is something that your NISSAN dealer cannot assist you with or you would like to provide NISSAN directly with comments or questions, please contact the NISSAN Consumer Affairs Department using our toll-free number: For U.S. customers 1-800-NISSAN-1 (1-800-647-7261) For Canadian customers 1-800-387-0122 The Consumer Affairs Department will ask for the following information: – Your name, address, and telephone number – Vehicle identification number (attached to the top of the instrument panel on the driver’s side) – Date of purchase – Current odometer reading – Your NISSAN dealer’s name You can write to NISSAN with the information at: For U.S. customers Nissan North America, Inc. Consumer Affairs Department P.O. Box 685003 Franklin, TN 37068-5003 For Canadian customers Nissan Canada Inc. 5290 Orbitor Drive Mississauga, Ontario L4W 4Z5 – Your comments or questions OR We appreciate your interest in NISSAN and thank you for buying a quality NISSAN vehicle. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Table of Contents Illustrated table of contents 0 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1 Instruments and controls 2 Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4 Starting and driving 5 In case of emergency 6 Appearance and care 7 Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8 Technical and consumer information 9 Index I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 10 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 0 Illustrated table of contents Air bags, seat belts and child restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-2 Exterior front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-3 Exterior rear. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-4 Passenger compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-5 Instrument panel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-6 Engine compartment check locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-8 Warning/indicator lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-10 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : AIR BAGS, SEAT BELTS AND CHILD RESTRAINTS 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. Top tether anchor (P. 1-28) Rear headrest (P. 1-5) Rear seat belts (P. 1-13) Roof-mounted curtain side-impact supplemental air bag (P. 1-43) Front seat-mounted side-impact supplemental air bag (P. 1-43) Front-seat Active Head Restraint (P. 1-10) Front seat belts (P. 1-13) Supplemental front-impact air bags (P. 1-43) Seats (P. 1-2) Occupant classification sensor (pressure sensor) (P.1-43) Seat belt with pretensioner (P. 1-57) LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) (P. 1-26) See the page number indicated in parentheses for operating details. LII0088 0-2 Illustrated table of contents I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : EXTERIOR FRONT 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. Engine hood (P. 3-23) Windshield wiper and washer switch (P. 2-20) Windshield (P. 8-20) Moonroof (if so equipped) (P. 2-37) Power windows (if so equipped) (P. 2-34) Door locks, keyfob (if so equipped), NISSAN Intelligent Key ™ (if so equipped), keys (P. 3-4, 3-7, 3-11, 3-2) Mirrors (P. 3-28) Tire pressure (P. 8-31) Flat tire (P. 6-2) Tire chains (P. 8-38) Headlight and turn signal switch (P. 2-22) Replacing bulbs (P. 8-28) Fog light switch (if so equipped) (P. 2-22) Tie down hook (if so equipped) (P. 6-14) See the page number indicated in parentheses for operating details. LII0089 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Illustrated table of contents 0-3 EXTERIOR REAR 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Trunk lid (P.3-23 ) Vehicle loading (P. 9-12) Interior trunk lid release (P. 3-24) Rear window defroster switch (P. 2-21) Child safety locks (P. 3-7) Fuel-filler door (P. 3-25) Fuel-filler cap, fuel recommendation (P. 3-25, P. 9-3) 8. Replacing bulbs (P. 8-28) 9. Rear tie down hook (if so equipped) (P. 6-14) 10. Exterior trunk lid release/request button (P. 3-17, 3-24) 11. Rear view camera (P. 4-8) See the page number indicated in parentheses for operating details. LII0176 0-4 Illustrated table of contents I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : PASSENGER COMPARTMENT 1. 2. 3. Rear seat (P. 1-3) Moonroof (if so equipped) (P. 2-37) Interior lights, illuminated entry, moonroof switch (if so equipped) (P. 2-39, P. 2-22, P. 2-37) 4. Sun visors (P. 3-27) 5. Rearview mirror (P. 3-28) 6. Glove box (P. 2-31) 7. Cup holders (P. 2-30) 8. Parking brake, parking on hills (P. 5-19, P. 5-23) 9. Front seat (P. 1-2) 10. Front console (P. 2-31) 11. Rear armrest, cup holders (if so equipped) (P. 1-7, P 2-30) See the page number indicated in parentheses for operating details. LII0091 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Illustrated table of contents 0-5 INSTRUMENT PANEL 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. WIC1600 1. 2. Headlight/fog light (if so equipped) /turn signal switch (P. 2-22); Manual shift paddles (if so equipped) (P.5-15) Steering wheel switch for audio control and Bluetooth姞 Hands-Free Phone System (if so equipped) (P. 4-60, 4-62) 0-6 Illustrated table of contents 3. 4. 5. 6. Driver’s supplemental air bag/Horn (P. 1-43, 2-25) Meters and gauges (P. 2-3) Instrument brightness control (P. 2-23) Cruise control main/set switches (if so equipped) (P. 5-20) I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 19. 20. 21. 22. 23. 24. Windshield wiper/washer switch (P. 2-20) Storage bin (if so equipped) (P. 2-27) Audio system (P. 4-31, 4-34, 4-38) Center ventilator (P. 4-14) Passenger’s supplemental air bag (P. 1-43) Side ventilator (P. 4-14) Storage bin (if so equipped) (P. 2-28) Engine oil pressure gauge (if so equipped) (P. 2-7) g (gravity)-force gauge (if so equipped) (P. 2-6) Hazard warning flasher switch (if so equipped) (P. 2-24) Hazard warning flasher switch (if so equipped) (P. 2-24); Manual shift mode switch (if so equipped) (P.5-15) Navigation system* (if so equipped) (P. 4-44) Glove box (P. 2-31) Front passenger air bag status light (P. 1-43) Climate control (P. 4-14) Shift selector (P. 5-12) Power outlet (P. 2-26) Ignition switch (P. 5-7) 25. 26. 27. 28 Tilt steering (P.3-27) Storage bin (P. 2-28) Hood release lever (P. 3-23) Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) off switch (if so equipped) (P.2-16) * Refer to the separate Navigation System Owner’s Manual (if so equipped). See the page number indicated in parentheses for operating details. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Illustrated table of contents 0-7 ENGINE COMPARTMENT CHECK LOCATIONS MR20DE engine 1. 2. 3. Engine coolant reservoir (P. 8-8) Engine oil filler cap (P. 8-9) Brake fluid reservoir/Clutch fluid reservoir (M/T model) (P. 8-13) 4. Battery (P. 8-15) 5. Air cleaner (P. 8-18) 6. Fuse/fusible link box (P. 8-22) 7. Radiator cap (P. 8-8) 8. Engine oil dipstick (P. 8-9) 9. Drive belt location (P.8-16) 10. Windshield-washer fluid reservoir (P. 8-14) See the page number indicated in parentheses for operating details. LDI0709 0-8 Illustrated table of contents I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : QR25DE engine 1. 2. 3. Engine coolant reservoir (P. 8-8) Engine oil filler cap (P. 8-9) Brake fluid reservoir/Clutch fluid reservoir (M/T model) (P. 8-13) 4. Battery (P. 8-15) 5. Air cleaner (P. 8-18) 6. Fuse/fusible link box (P. 8-22) 7. Radiator cap (P. 8-8) 8. Engine oil dipstick (P. 8-9) 9. Drive belt location (P.8-16) 10. Windshield-washer fluid reservoir (P. 8-14) *Engine cover removed for clarity. See the page number indicated in parentheses for operating details. WDI0637 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Illustrated table of contents 0-9 WARNING/INDICATOR LIGHTS Warning light or Name Page Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning light (if so equipped) 2-10 Brake warning light 2-10 or Charge warning light 2-11 Door open warning light 2-11 Electric power steering warning light 2-11 Engine oil pressure warning light 2-11 0-10 Illustrated table of contents Warning light Name Page Indicator light Name Page Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) position indicator light (CVT models) 2-14 Low fuel warning light 2-12 Low tire pressure warning light (if so equipped) 2-12 2-13 Cruise main switch indicator light (if so equipped) 2-14 Low windshieldwasher fluid warning light (if so equipped) 3-3 Cruise set switch indicator light (if so equipped) 2-14 NISSAN Intelligent Key™ warning light (if so equipped) 2-13 Front passenger air bag status light 2-14 P position selecting warning light (CVT models) (if so equipped) Seat belt warning light and chime 2-13 High beam indicator light (blue) 2-14 Supplemental air bag warning light 2-14 Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) 2-15 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : or Indicator light Name Page Overdrive off indicator light (CVT models) 2-15 Security indicator light 2-15 Side light and headlight indicator light (green) 2-16 Slip indicator light (if so equipped) 2-16 Turn signal/hazard indicator lights 2-16 Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF indicator light (if so equipped) 2-16 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Illustrated table of contents 0-11 MEMO 0-12 Illustrated table of contents I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2 Front manual seat adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2 Rear folding seat system (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . 1-3 Head restraints. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7 Adjustable headrest (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10 Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13 Precautions on seat belt usage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13 Pregnant women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16 Injured persons. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16 Three-point type seat belt with retractor . . . . . . . . . . 1-16 Seat belt extenders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22 Seat belt maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22 Child safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23 Infants. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23 Small children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23 Larger children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24 Child restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24 Precautions on child restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24 LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-26 Rear-facing child restraint installation using LATCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-29 Rear-facing child restraint installation using the seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-31 Forward-facing child restraint installation using LATCH. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-33 Forward-facing child restraint installation using the seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-35 Installing top tether strap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-39 Booster seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-39 Supplemental restraint system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-43 Precautions on supplemental restraint system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-43 Supplemental air bag warning labels . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-58 Supplemental air bag warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-58 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : SEATS ● The seatback should not be reclined any more than needed for comfort. Seat belts are most effective when the passenger sits well back and straight up in the seat. If the seatback is reclined, the risk of sliding under the lap belt and being injured is increased. CAUTION When adjusting the seat positions, be sure not to contact any moving parts to avoid possible injuries and/or damage. ARS1152 WARNING ● Do not ride in a moving vehicle when the seatback is reclined. This can be dangerous. The shoulder belt will not be against your body. In an accident, you could be thrown into it and receive neck or other serious injuries. You could also slide under the lap belt and receive serious internal injuries. ● For the most effective protection when the vehicle is in motion, the seat should be upright. Always sit well back in the seat with both feet on the floor and adjust the seat properly. See “Precautions on seat belt usage” later in this section. ● After adjustment, gently rock in the seat to make sure it is securely locked. ● Do not leave children unattended inside the vehicle. They could unknowingly activate switches or controls. Unattended children could become involved in serious accidents. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-2 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system FRONT MANUAL SEAT ADJUSTMENT WRS0719 WRS0720 Forward and backward Reclining Pull the center of the bar up and hold it while you slide the seat forward or backward to the desired position. Release the bar to lock the seat in position. To recline the seatback, pull the lever up and lean back. To bring the seatback forward, pull the lever up and lean your body forward. Release the lever to lock the seatback in position. The reclining feature allows adjustment of the seatback for occupants of different sizes for added comfort and to help obtain proper seat belt fit. See “Precautions on seat belt usage” later in this section. Also, the seatback can be reclined to allow occupants to rest when the vehicle is stopped and the shift selector (CVT) is in P (Park) or the manual transmission is in N (Neutral) with the parking brake applied. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : WRS0721 Seat lifter (if so equipped for driver’s seat) Pull up or push down the adjusting lever to adjust the seat height until the desired position is achieved. REAR FOLDING SEAT SYSTEM (if so equipped) Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-3 ● Properly secure all cargo with ropes or straps to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. Do not place cargo higher than the seatbacks. In a sudden stop or collision, unsecured cargo could cause personal injury. ● When returning the seatbacks to the upright position, be certain they are completely secured in the latched position. If they are not completely secured, passengers may be injured in an accident or sudden stop. LRS0728 Interior trunk access (if so equipped) The trunk can be accessed from the rear seat for loading and unloading, as shown. 1. Stow outboard seat belts with clip before folding rear seatbacks. When folding the passenger’s side rear seatback, first disconnect and stow the center seat belt. See “Stowing the rear center seat belt” later in this section. WRS0726 A located on the top 2. Pull up on the strap 䊊 outboard side of the seat to be folded. 3. Fold seatback down. WARNING ● Never allow anyone to ride in the cargo area or on the rear seat when it is in the fold-down position. Use of these areas by passengers without proper restraints could result in serious injury in an accident or sudden stop. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-4 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system ● Closely supervise children when they are around cars to prevent them from playing and becoming locked in the trunk where they could be seriously injured. Keep the car locked, with the rear seatback and trunk lid securely latched when not in use, and prevent children’s access to car keys. WRS0827 LRS0730 LRS0733 2. Fold down the rear headrest. Pull the headrest forward and rotate until it clicks into the 1 . locked position 䊊 Folding the rear cushions and seatbacks (if so equipped) 1. Lift up on the front edge of the seat cushion and fold it toward the front of the vehicle. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-5 ● Properly secure all cargo with ropes or straps to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. Do not place cargo higher than the seatbacks. In a sudden stop or collision, unsecured cargo could cause personal injury. ● When returning the seatbacks to the upright position, be certain they are completely secured in the latched position. If they are not completely secured, passengers may be injured in an accident or sudden stop. LRS0734 LRS0731 3. To return the headrest to the normal position, 1 and release then rotate up push down 䊊 2 . until in position 䊊 4. Fold down seatbacks. See “Interior trunk access” earlier in this section. WARNING ● Never allow anyone to ride in the cargo area or on the rear seat when it is in the fold-down position. Use of these areas by passengers without proper restraints could result in serious injury in an accident or sudden stop. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-6 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system ● Closely supervise children when they are around cars to prevent them from playing and becoming locked in the trunk where they could be seriously injured. Keep the car locked, with the rear seatback and trunk lid securely latched when not in use, and prevent children’s access to car keys. HEAD RESTRAINTS WARNING WIC1097 Center armrest (if so equipped) Pull the armrest down until it is horizontal. Head restraints supplement the other vehicle safety systems. They may provide additional protection against injury in certain rear end collisions. Adjust the head restraints properly, as specified in this section. Check the adjustment after someone else uses the seat. Do not attach anything to the head restraint stalks or remove the head restraint. Do not use the seat if the head restraint has been removed. If the head restraint was removed, reinstall and properly adjust the head restraint before an occupant uses the seating position. Failure to follow these instructions can reduce the effectiveness of the head restraints. This may increase the risk of serious injury or death in a collision. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : LRS0893 The illustration shows the seating positions equipped with head restraints. All of the head restraints are adjustable. 䉱 Indicates the seating position is equipped with a head restraint. Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-7 LRS0887 Components 1. Head restraint 2. Adjustment notches WRS0134 Adjustment Adjust the head restraint so the center is level with the center of the seat occupant’s ears. 3. Lock knob 4. Stalks I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-8 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system LRS0888 To raise the head restraint, pull it up. LRS0889 To lower, push and hold the lock knob and push the head restraint down. LRS0890 Removal LRS0891 Install Use the following procedure to remove the adjustable head restraints. 1. Pull the head restraint up to the highest position. 2. Push and hold the lock knob. 1. Align the head restraint stalks with the holes in the seat. Make sure the head restraint is facing the correct direction. The stalk with 1 must be installed the adjustment notches 䊊 2 . in the hole with the lock knob 䊊 3. Remove the head restraint from the seat. 2. Push and hold the lock knob and push the head restraint down. 4. Store the head restraint properly so it is not loose in the vehicle. 3. Properly adjust the head restraint before an occupant uses the seating position. 5. Reinstall and properly adjust the head restraint before an occupant uses the seating position. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-9 Adjust the Active Head Restraints properly as described in this section. ADJUSTABLE HEADREST (if so equipped) WARNING SPA1025 Front-seat Active Head Restraints The Active Head Restraint moves forward utilizing the force that the seatback receives from the occupant in a rear-end collision. The movement of the head restraint helps support the occupant’s head by reducing its backward movement and helping absorb some of the forces that may lead to whiplash-type injuries. Active Head Restraints are effective for collisions at low to medium speeds in which it is said that whiplash injury occurs most. Active Head Restraints operate only in certain rear-end collisions. After the collision, the head restraints return to their original position. The adjustable headrests supplement the other vehicle safety systems. They may provide additional protection against injury in certain rear end collisions. Adjust the headrests properly, as specified in this section. Check the adjustment after someone else uses the seat. Do not attach anything to the adjustable headrest stalks or remove the adjustable headrests. Do not use the seat if the adjustable headrests have been removed. If the headrest was removed, reinstall and properly adjust the headrest before an occupant uses the seating position. Failure to follow these instructions can reduce the effectiveness of the adjustable headrests. This may increase the risk of serious injury or death in a collision. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-10 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system LRS0898 The illustration shows the seating positions equipped with adjustable headrests. All of the headrests are adjustable. 䡲 Indicates the seating position is equipped with an adjustable headrest. + Indicates the seating position is not equipped with a head restraint or adjustable headrest. LRS0887 Components 1. Adjustable headrest 2. Adjustment notches WRS0134 LRS0888 To raise the headrest, pull it up. Adjustment Adjust the headrest so the center is level with the center of the seat occupant’s ears. 3. Lock knob 4. Stalks I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-11 LRS0889 To lower, push and hold the lock knob and push the headrest down. LRS0890 Removal LRS0891 Install Use the following procedure to remove the adjustable headrests. 1. Pull the headrest up to the highest position. 2. Push and hold the lock knob. 3. Remove the headrest from the seat. 4. Store the headrest properly so it is not loose in the vehicle. 5. Reinstall and properly adjust the headrest before an occupant uses the seating position. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-12 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1. Align the headrest stalks with the holes in the seat. Make sure the headrest is facing the correct direction. The stalk with the ad1 must be installed in the justment notches 䊊 2 . hole with the lock knob 䊊 2. Push and hold the lock knob and push the headrest down. 3. Properly adjust the headrest before an occupant uses the seating position. SEAT BELTS SSS0136 PRECAUTIONS ON SEAT BELT USAGE If you are wearing your seat belt properly adjusted and you are sitting upright and well back in your seat with both feet on the floor, your chances of being injured or killed in an accident and/or the severity of injury may be greatly reduced. NISSAN strongly encourages you and all of your passengers to buckle up every time you drive, even if your seating position includes a supplemental air bag. Most U.S. states and Canadian provinces or territories specify that seat belts be worn at all times when a vehicle is being driven. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-13 SSS0134 WARNING SSS0016 WARNING ● Every person who drives or rides in this vehicle should use a seat belt at all times. Children should be properly restrained in the rear seat and, if appropriate, in a child restraint. ● The seat belt should be properly adjusted to a snug fit. Failure to do so may reduce the effectiveness of the entire restraint system and increase the chance or severity of injury in an accident. Serious injury or death can occur if the seat belt is not worn properly. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-14 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system ● Be sure the seat belt tongue is securely fastened to the proper buckle. ● Do not wear the seat belt inside out or twisted. Doing so may reduce its effectiveness. ● Do not allow more than one person to use the same seat belt. ● Never carry more people in the vehicle than there are seat belts. SSS0014 WARNING ● Always route the shoulder belt over your shoulder and across your chest. Never put the belt behind your back, under your arm or across your neck. The belt should be away from your face and neck, but not falling off your shoulder. ● Position the lap belt as low and snug as possible AROUND THE HIPS, NOT THE WAIST. A lap belt worn too high could increase the risk of internal injuries in an accident. ● If the seat belt warning light glows continuously while the ignition is turned ON with all doors closed and all seat belts fastened, it may indicate a malfunction in the system. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer. ● No changes should be made to the seat belt system. For example, do not modify the seat belt, add material, or install devices that may change the seat belt routing or tension. Doing so may affect the operation of the seat belt system. Modifying or tampering with the seat belt system may result in serious personal injury. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ● Once a seat belt pretensioner has activated, it cannot be reused and must be replaced together with the retractor. See your NISSAN dealer. ● Removal and installation of pretensioner system components should be done by a NISSAN dealer. ● All seat belt assemblies, including retractors and attaching hardware, should be inspected after any collision by a NISSAN dealer. NISSAN recommends that all seat belt assemblies in use during a collision be replaced unless the collision was minor and the belts show no damage and continue to operate properly. Seat belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and replaced if either damage or improper operation is noted. ● All child restraints and attaching hardware should be inspected after any collision. Always follow the restraint manufacturer’s inspection instructions and replacement recommendations. The child restraints should be replaced if they are damaged. Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-15 PREGNANT WOMEN NISSAN recommends that pregnant women use seat belts. The seat belt should be worn snug and always position the lap belt as low as possible around the hips, not the waist. Place the shoulder belt over your shoulder and across your chest. Never run the lap/shoulder belt over your abdominal area. Contact your doctor for specific recommendations. INJURED PERSONS NISSAN recommends that injured persons use seat belts. Check with your doctor for specific recommendations. THREE-POINT TYPE SEAT BELT WITH RETRACTOR WARNING ● Every person who drives or rides in this vehicle should use a seat belt at all times. ● Do not ride in a moving vehicle when the seatback is reclined. This can be dangerous. The shoulder belt will not be against your body. In an accident, you could be thrown into it and receive neck or other serious injuries. You could also slide under the lap belt and receive serious internal injuries. ● For the most effective protection when the vehicle is in motion, the seat should be upright. Always sit well back in the seat with both feet on the floor and adjust the seat belt properly. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-16 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system WRS0719 Manual front seat shown Fastening the seat belts 1. Adjust the seat. See “Seats” earlier in this section. The Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) mode allows the seat belt to extend and retract to allow the driver and passengers some freedom of movement in the seat. The ELR locks the seat belt when the vehicle slows down rapidly or during certain impacts. The Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode (child restraint mode) locks the seat belt for child restraint installation. WRS0137 2 䊊 Slowly pull the seat belt out of the retractor and insert the tongue into the buckle until you hear and feel the latch engage. ● The retractor is designed to lock during a sudden stop or on impact. A slow pulling motion permits the seat belt to move, and allows you some freedom of movement in the seat. ● If the seat belt cannot be pulled from its fully retracted position, firmly pull the belt and release it. Then smoothly pull the belt out of the retractor. WRS0138 3 䊊 4 䊊 Position the lap belt portion low and snug on the hips as shown. Pull the shoulder belt portion toward the retractor to take up extra slack. Be sure the shoulder belt is routed over your shoulder and across your chest. The front passenger seat and the rear seating positions three-point seat belts have two modes of operation: ● Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) When the ALR mode is activated, the seat belt cannot be extended again until the seat belt tongue is detached from the buckle and fully retracted. The seat belt returns to the ELR mode after the seat belt fully retracts. See “Child restraints” later in this section for more information. The ALR mode should be used only for child restraint installation. During normal seat belt use by an occupant, the ALR mode should not be activated. If it is activated, it may cause uncomfortable seat belt tension. It can also change the operation of the front passenger air bag. See “Front passenger air bag and status light” later in this section. ● Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-17 To increase your confidence in the seat belts, check the operation as follows: WARNING When fastening the seat belts, be certain that the seatbacks are completely secured in the latched position. If they are not completely secured, passengers may be injured in an accident or sudden stop. ● Grasp the shoulder belt and pull forward quickly. The retractor should lock and restrict further belt movement. If the retractor does not lock during this check or if you have any questions about seat belt operation, see a NISSAN dealer. LRS0767 Unfastening the seat belts 1 䊊 To unfasten the seat belt, press the button on the buckle. The seat belt automatically retracts. Checking seat belt operation Seat belt retractors are designed to lock seat belt movement by two separate methods: ● When the seat belt is pulled quickly from the retractor. ● When the vehicle slows down rapidly. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-18 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system SSS0240 Center of the rear seat (except SE-R model) The rear seat center seat belt has a connector 1 and a seat belt tongue 䊊 2 . Both the tongue 䊊 connector tongue and the seat belt tongue must be securely latched for proper seat belt operation. SSS0241 WARNING ● Always fasten the connector tongue and the seat belt in the order shown. ● Always make sure both the connector tongue and the seat belt tongue are secured when using the seat belt or installing a child restraint. Do not use the seat belt or child restraint with only the seat belt tongue attached. This could result in serious personal injury in case of an accident or a sudden stop. WRS0735 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-19 Stowing the rear center seat belt When folding down the rear seat, the center seat belt can be retracted into a stowed position as follows: 1 䊊 2 䊊 3 䊊 ● If the rear center seat belt connector and the seatbacks are not secured in the correct position, serious personal injury may result in an accident or sudden stop. Hold the connector tongue so that the seat belt does not retract suddenly when the tongue is released from the connector buckle. Release the connector tongue by inserting a suitable tool such as key into the A. connector buckle 䊊 Retract the seat belt up to the retractor base. Insert the seat belt connector buckle into the fabric sleeve to stow. WARNING ● Do not unfasten the rear center seat belt connector except when folding down the rear seat. ● When attaching the rear center seat belt connector, be certain that the seatbacks are completely secured in the latched position and the rear center seat belt connector is completely secured. WRS0736 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-20 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system Attaching the rear center seat belt WARNING Always be sure the center seat belt connector tongue and connector buckle are attached. Disconnect only when folding down the rear seat. ● Do not unfasten the rear center seat belt connector except when folding down the rear seat. To connect the buckle: ● When attaching the rear center seat belt connector, be certain that the seatbacks are completely secured in the latched position and the rear center seat belt connector is completely secured. 1 䊊 2 䊊 3 䊊 Pull out the connector buckle from the fabric sleeve. Pull out the connector tongue. Pull the seat belt and secure the receiver buckle until it clicks. The center seat belt connector tongue and receiver buckle are indicated by the > and < marks. The center seat belt connector tongue can be attached only into the rear center seat belt connector buckle. ● If the rear center seat belt connector and the seatbacks are not secured in the correct position, serious personal injury may result in an accident or sudden stop. LRS0242 Shoulder belt height adjustment (front seats) The shoulder belt anchor height should be adjusted to the position best for you. See “Precautions on seat belt usage” earlier in this section. To 1 and adjust, pull out the adjustment button 䊊 move the shoulder belt anchor to the desired 2 , so the belt passes over the center of position 䊊 the shoulder. The belt should be away from your face and neck, but not falling off your shoulder. Release the adjustment button to lock the shoulder belt anchor into position. To fasten the seat belt, see “Fastening the seat belts” earlier in this section. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-21 WARNING WARNING ● After adjustment, release the adjustment button and try to move the shoulder belt anchor up and down to make sure it is securely fixed in position. ● Only NISSAN seat belt extenders, made by the same company which made the original equipment seat belts, should be used with NISSAN seat belts. ● The shoulder belt anchor height should be adjusted to the position best for you. Failure to do so may reduce the effectiveness of the entire restraint system and increase the chance or severity of injury in an accident. ● Adults and children who can use the standard seat belt should not use an extender. Such unnecessary use could result in serious personal injury in the event of an accident. SEAT BELT EXTENDERS If, because of body size or driving position, it is not possible to properly fit the lap/shoulder belt and fasten it, an extender that is compatible with the installed seat belts is available that can be purchased. The extender adds approximately 8 in (200 mm) of length and may be used for either the driver or front passenger seating position. See a NISSAN dealer for assistance with purchasing an extender if an extender is required. ● Never use seat belt extenders to install child restraints. If the child restraint is not secured properly, the child could be seriously injured in a collision or a sudden stop. SEAT BELT MAINTENANCE ● To clean the seat belt webbing, apply a mild soap solution or any solution recommended for cleaning upholstery or carpet. Then wipe with a cloth and allow the seat belts to dry in the shade. Do not allow the seat belts to retract until they are completely dry. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-22 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system ● If dirt builds up in the shoulder belt guide of the seat belt anchors, the seat belts may retract slowly. Wipe the shoulder belt guide with a clean, dry cloth. ● Periodically check to see that the seat belt and the metal components, such as buckles, tongues, retractors, flexible wires and anchors work properly. If loose parts, deterioration, cuts or other damage on the webbing is found, the entire seat belt assembly should be replaced. CHILD SAFETY Children need adults to help protect them. They need to be properly restrained. In addition to the general information in this manual, child safety information is available from many other sources, including doctors, teachers, government traffic safety offices, and community organizations. Every child is different, so be sure to learn the best way to transport your child. There are three basic types of child restraint systems: ● Rear-facing child restraint ● Forward-facing child restraint ● Booster seat The proper restraint depends on the child’s size. Generally, infants up to about 1 year and less than 20 lbs (9 kg) should be placed in rear-facing child restraints. Forward-facing child restraints are available for children who outgrow rearfacing child restraints and are at least 1 year old. Booster seats are used to help position a vehicle lap/shoulder belt on a child who can no longer use a forward-facing child restraint. WARNING Infants and children need special protection. The vehicle’s seat belts may not fit them properly. The shoulder belt may come too close to the face or neck. The lap belt may not fit over their small hip bones. In an accident, an improperly fitting seat belt could cause serious or fatal injury. Always use appropriate child restraints. All U.S. states and Canadian provinces or territories require the use of approved child restraints for infants and small children. See “Child Restraints” later in this section. A child restraint may be secured in the vehicle by using either the LATCH (Lower Anchor and Tethers for CHildren) system or with the vehicle seat belt. See “Child Restraints” section for more information. NISSAN recommends that all pre-teens and children be restrained in the rear seat. Studies show that children are safer when properly restrained in the rear seat than in the front seat. tem (Air bag system) for the front passenger. See “Supplemental restraint system” later in this section. INFANTS Infants up to at least 1 year old should be placed in a rear-facing child restraint. NISSAN recommends that infants be placed in child restraints that comply with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards. You should choose a child restraint that fits your vehicle and always follow the manufacturer’s instructions for installation and use. SMALL CHILDREN Children that are over one year old and weigh at least 20 lbs (9 kg) can be placed in a forwardfacing child restraint. Refer to the manufacturer’s instructions for minimum and maximum weight and height recommendations. NISSAN recommends that small children be placed in child restraints that comply with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards. You should choose a child restraint that fits your vehicle and always follow the manufacturer’s instructions for installation and use. This is especially important because your vehicle has a supplemental restraint sysI nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-23 CHILD RESTRAINTS LARGER CHILDREN Children who are too large for child restraints should be seated and restrained by the seat belts which are provided. The seat belt may not fit properly if the child is less than 4 ft 9 in (142.5 cm) tall and weighs between 40 lbs (18 kg) and 80 lbs (36 kg). A booster seat should be used to obtain proper seat belt fit. WARNING Never let a child stand or kneel on any seat and do not allow a child in the cargo area. The child could be seriously injured or killed in a sudden stop or collision. NISSAN recommends that a child be placed in a commercially available booster seat if the shoulder belt fits close to the face or neck or if the lap portion of the seat belt goes across the abdomen. The booster seat should raise the child so that the shoulder belt is properly positioned across the top, middle portion of the shoulder and the lap belt is low on the hips. A booster seat can only be used in seating positions that have a three-point type seat belt. The booster seat should fit the vehicle seat and have a label certifying that it complies with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards. Once the child has grown so the shoulder belt is no longer on or near the face and neck, use the shoulder belt without the booster seat. ARS1098 PRECAUTIONS ON CHILD RESTRAINTS I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-24 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system – Infants and children should never be held on anyone’s lap. Even the strongest adult cannot resist the forces of a collision. – Do not put a seat belt around both a child and another passenger. WRS0256 WARNING ● Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper use and installation of child restraints could result in serious injury or death of a child or other passengers in a sudden stop or collision: – The child restraint must be used and installed properly. Always follow all of the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions for installation and use. – NISSAN recommends that all child restraints be installed in the rear seat. Studies show that children are safer when properly restrained in the rear seat than in the front seat. If you must install a forward-facing child restraint in the front seat, see “Forward-facing child restraint installation using the seat belts” later in this section. – Even with the NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System, never install a rearfacing child restraint in the front seat. An inflating air bag could seriously injure or kill a child. A rearfacing child restraint must only be used in the rear seat. – Be sure to purchase a child restraint that will fit the child and vehicle. Some child restraints may not fit properly in your vehicle. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : – Child restraint anchor points are designed to withstand loads from child restraints that are properly fitted. – Never use the anchor points for adult seat belts or harnesses. – A child restraint with a top tether strap should not be used in the front passenger seat. – Keep seatbacks as upright as possible after fitting the child restraint. – Infants and children should always be placed in an appropriate child restraint while in the vehicle. ● When the child restraint is not in use, keep it secured with the LATCH system or a seat belt. In a sudden stop or collision, loose objects can injure occupants or damage the vehicle. CAUTION A child restraint in a closed vehicle can become very hot. Check the seating surface and buckles before placing a child in the child restraint. Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-25 This vehicle is equipped with a universal child restraint anchor system, referred to as the LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) system. Some child restraints include rigid or webbing-mounted attachments that can be connected to these anchors. For details, see “LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) system” later in this section. If you do not have a LATCH compatible child restraint, the vehicle seat belts can be used. Several manufacturers offer child restraints for infants and children of various sizes. When selecting any child restraint, keep the following points in mind: ● If the child restraint is compatible with your vehicle, place your child in the child restraint and check the various adjustments to be sure the child restraint is compatible with your child. Choose a child restraint that is designed for your child’s height and weight. Always follow all recommended procedures. All U.S. states and Canadian provinces or territories require that infants and small children be restrained in an approved child restraint at all times while the vehicle is being operated. Canadian law requires the top tether strap on forward-facing child restraints be secured to the designated anchor point on the vehicle. ● Choose only a restraint with a label certifying that it complies with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213 or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213. LRS0724 LATCH system lower anchor locations LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) SYSTEM Your vehicle is equipped with special anchor points that are used with LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) system compatible child restraints. This system may also be referred to as the ISOFIX or ISOFIX compatible system. With this system, you do not have to use a vehicle seat belt to secure the child restraint. ● Check the child restraint in your vehicle to be sure it is compatible with the vehicle’s seat and seat belt system. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-26 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system LATCH lower anchor WARNING Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper use and installation of child restraints could result in serious injury or death of a child or other passengers in a sudden stop or collision: – Attach LATCH system compatible child restraints only at the locations shown in the illustration. – Do not secure a child restraint in the center rear seating position using the LATCH lower anchors. The child restraint will not be secured properly. – Inspect the lower anchors by inserting your fingers into the lower anchor area. Feel to make sure there are no obstructions over the anchors such as seat belt webbing or seat cushion material. The child restraint will not be secured properly if the lower anchors are obstructed. WRS0700 LATCH lower anchor location LATCH lower anchor location The LATCH lower anchors are located at the rear of the seat cushion near the seatback. A label is attached to the seatback to help you locate the LATCH lower anchors. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : LRS0661 LATCH webbing-mounted attachment Installing child restraint LATCH lower anchor attachments LATCH compatible child restraints include two rigid or webbing-mounted attachments that can be connected to two anchors located at certain seating positions in your vehicle. With this system, you do not have to use a vehicle seat belt to secure the child restraint. Check your child restraint for a label stating that it is compatible with LATCH. This information may also be in the instructions provided by the child restraint manufacturer. Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-27 Top tether anchor WARNING Do not allow cargo to contact the top tether strap when it is attached to the top tether anchor. Properly secure the cargo so it does not contact the top tether strap. Cargo that is not properly secured or cargo that contacts the top tether strap may damage it during a collision. A child could be seriously injured or killed in a collision if the top tether strap is damaged. LRS0662 LRS0723 LATCH rigid-mounted attachment The child restraint top tether strap must be used when installing the child restraint with the LATCH lower anchor attachments or seat belts. See “Top tether anchor” for installation instructions. Top tether anchor point locations 1 are located on the rear parcel Anchor points 䊊 shelf. When installing a child restraint, carefully read and follow the instructions in this manual and those supplied with the child restraint. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-28 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system REAR-FACING CHILD RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING LATCH Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the “Child safety” and “Child restraints” sections before installing a child restraint. Follow these steps to install a rear-facing child restraint using the LATCH system: 1. Position the child restraint on the seat. Always follow the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions. WRS0801 Rear-facing web-mounted – step 2 2. Secure the child restraint anchor attachments to the LATCH lower anchors. Check to make sure the LATCH attachment is properly attached to the lower anchors. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : WRS0802 Rear-facing rigid-mounted – step 2 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-29 5. Check to make sure the child restraint is properly secured prior to each use. If the child restraint is loose, repeat steps 1 through 4. LRS0673 Rear-facing – step 3 3. For child restraints that are equipped with webbing-mounted attachments, remove any additional slack from the anchor attachments. Press downward and rearward firmly in the center of the child restraint with your hand to compress the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while tightening the webbing of the anchor attachments. LRS0674 Rear-facing – step 4 4. After attaching the child restraint, test it before you place the child in it. Push it from side to side while holding the child restraint near the LATCH attachment path. The child restraint should not move more than 1 inch (25 mm), from side to side. Try to tug it forward and check to see if the LATCH attachment holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the LATCH attachment as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again. You may need to try a different child restraint or try installing by using the vehicle seat belt (if applicable). Not all child restraints fit in all types of vehicles. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-30 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system WARNING ● The three-point seat belt with Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) must be used when installing a child restraint. Failure to use the ALR mode will result in the child restraint not being properly secured. The restraint could tip over or be loose and cause injury to a child in a sudden stop or collision. Also, it can change the operation of the front passenger air bag. See “Front passenger air bag and status light” later in this section. WRS0256 REAR-FACING CHILD RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING THE SEAT BELTS ● When installing a child restraint system in the rear center position, both the center seat belt connector tongue and buckle tongue must be secured. See “Attaching the rear center seat belt” in this section. WRS0256 Rear-facing – step 1 Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the “Child safety” and “Child restraints” sections before installing a child restraint. Follow these steps to install a rear-facing child restraint using the vehicle seat belts in the rear seats: 1. Child restraints for infants must be used in the rear-facing direction and therefore must not be used in the front seat. Position the child restraint on the seat. Always follow the restraint manufacturer’s instructions. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-31 WRS0761 Rear-facing – step 2 2. Route the seat belt tongue through the child restraint and insert it into the buckle until you hear and feel the latch engage. Be sure to follow the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions for belt routing. LRS0669 Rear-facing – step 3 3. Pull the shoulder belt until the belt is fully extended. At this time, the seat belt retractor is in the Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode (child restraint mode). It reverts to the Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) mode when the seat belt is fully retracted. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-32 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system LRS0670 Rear-facing – step 4 4. Allow the seat belt to retract. Pull up on the shoulder belt to remove any slack in the belt. 7. Check to make sure that the child restraint is properly secured prior to each use. If the seat belt is not locked, repeat steps 1 through 6. After the child restraint is removed and the seat belt fully retracted, the ALR mode (child restraint mode) is canceled. FORWARD-FACING CHILD RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING LATCH WRS0762 Rear-facing – step 5 5. Remove any additional slack from the seat belt; press downward and rearward firmly in the center of the child restraint to compress the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while pulling up on the seat belt. WRS0763 Rear-facing – step 6 6. After attaching the child restraint, test it before you place the child in it. Push it from side to side while holding the child restraint near the seat belt path. The child restraint should not move more than 1 inch (25 mm), from side to side. Try to tug it forward and check to see if the belt holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the seat belt as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again. You may need to try a different child restraint. Not all child restraints fit in all types of vehicles. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the “Child safety” and “Child restraints” sections before installing a child restraint. Follow these steps to install a forward-facing child restraint using the LATCH system: 1. Position the child restraint on the seat. Always follow the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions. Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-33 WRS0799 Forward-facing web-mounted – step 2 2. Secure the child restraint anchor attachments to the LATCH lower anchors. Check to make sure the LATCH attachment is properly attached to the lower anchors. If the child restraint is equipped with a top tether strap, route the top tether strap and secure the tether strap to the tether anchor point. See “Installing top tether strap” in this section. Do not install child restraints that require the use of a top tether strap in seating positions that do not have a top tether anchor. WRS0800 Forward-facing rigid-mounted – step 2 3. The back of the child restraint should be secured against the vehicle seatback. If necessary, adjust or remove the headrest to obtain the correct child restraint fit. If the headrest is removed, store it in a secure place. Be sure to reinstall the headrest when the child restraint is removed. See “Adjustable headrest” in this section for headrest adjustment information. If the seating position does not have an adjustable headrest and it is interfering with the proper child restraint fit, try another seating position or a different child restraint. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-34 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system LRS0671 Forward-facing – step 4 4. For child restraints that are equipped with webbing-mounted attachments, remove any additional slack from the anchor attachments. Press downward and rearward firmly in the center of the child restraint with your knee to compress the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while tightening the webbing of the anchor attachments. 5. Tighten the tether strap according to the manufacturer’s instructions to remove any slack. 7. Check to make sure the child restraint is properly secured prior to each use. If the child restraint is loose, repeat steps 1 through 6. FORWARD-FACING CHILD RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING THE SEAT BELTS WARNING WRS0697 Forward-facing – step 6 6. After attaching the child restraint, test it before you place the child in it. Push it from side to side while holding the child restraint near the LATCH attachment path. The child restraint should not move more than 1 inch (25 mm), from side to side. Try to tug it forward and check to see if the LATCH attachment holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the LATCH attachment as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again. You may need to try a different child restraint. Not all child restraints fit in all types of vehicles. The three-point seat belt with Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) must be used when installing a child restraint. Failure to use the ALR mode will result in the child restraint not being properly secured. The restraint could tip over or be loose and cause injury to a child in a sudden stop or collision. Also, it can change the operation of the front passenger air bag. See “Front passenger air bag and status light” later in this section. When installing a child restraint system in the rear center position, both the center seat belt connector tongue and buckle tongue must be secured. See “Attaching the rear center seat belt” in this section. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : WRS0699 Forward-facing (front passenger seat) – step 1 Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the “Child safety” and “Child restraints” sections before installing a child restraint. Follow these steps to install a forward-facing child restraint using the vehicle seat belt in the rear seats or in the front passenger seat: 1. If you must install a child restraint in the front seat, it should be placed in a forward-facing direction only. Move the seat to the rearmost position. Child restraints for infants must be used in the rear-facing direction and, therefore, must not be used in the front seat. Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-35 2. Position the child restraint on the seat. Always follow the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions. The back of the child restraint should be secured against the vehicle seatback. If necessary, adjust or remove the head restraint or headrest to obtain the correct child restraint fit. If the head restraint or headrest is removed, store it in a secure place. Be sure to reinstall the head restraint or headrest when the child restraint is removed. See “Head restraints” or “Adjustable headrest” in this section for head restraint or headrest adjustment, removal and installation information. If the seating position does not have an adjustable head restraint or headrest and it is interfering with the proper child restraint fit, try another seating position or a different child restraint. WRS0680 Forward-facing – step 3 3. Route the seat belt tongue through the child restraint and insert it into the buckle until you hear and feel the latch engage. Be sure to follow the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions for belt routing. If the child restraint is equipped with a top tether strap, route the top tether strap and secure the tether strap to the tether anchor point (rear seat installation only). See “Installing top tether strap” in this section. Do not install child restraints that require the use of a top tether strap in seating positions that do not have a top tether anchor. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-36 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system LRS0667 Forward-facing – step 4 4. Pull the shoulder belt until the belt is fully extended. At this time, the seat belt retractor is in the Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode (child restraint mode). It reverts to Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) mode when the seat belt is fully retracted. LRS0668 Forward-facing – step 5 5. Allow the seat belt to retract. Pull up on the shoulder belt to remove any slack in the belt. WRS0681 Forward-facing – step 6 6. Remove any additional slack from the seat belt; press downward and rearward firmly in the center of the child restraint with your knee to compress the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while pulling up on the seat belt. 7. Tighten the tether strap according to the manufacturer’s instructions to remove any slack. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : WRS0698 Forward-facing – step 8 8. After attaching the child restraint, test it before you place the child in it. Push it from side to side while holding the child restraint near the seat belt path. The child restraint should not move more than 1 inch (25 mm), from side to side. Try to tug it forward and check to see if the belt holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the seat belt as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again. You may need to try a different child restraint. Not all child restraints fit in all types of vehicles. Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-37 9. Check to make sure the child restraint is properly secured prior to each use. If the seat belt is not locked, repeat steps 2 through 8. LRS0351 Forward-facing – step 10 (Type A) LRS0316 Forward-facing — step 10 (Type B) 10. If the child restraint is installed in the front passenger seat, place the ignition switch in the ON position. The front passenger air bag or should illumistatus light nate. If this light is not illuminated see, ⬙Front passenger air bag and status light⬙ in this section. Move the child restraint to another seating position. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer. After the child restraint is removed and the seat belt is fully retracted, the ALR mode (child restraint mode) is canceled. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-38 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 2. If necessary, raise or remove the headrest to position the top tether strap over the top of the seatback. If the headrest is removed, store it in a secure place. Be sure to reinstall the headrest when the child restraint is removed. See “Adjustable headrest” in this section for headrest adjustment, removal and installation information. 3. Secure the tether strap to the tether anchor point on the rear parcel shelf. 4. Refer to the appropriate child restraint installation procedure steps in this section before tightening the tether strap. LRS0723 INSTALLING TOP TETHER STRAP First, secure the child restraint with the LATCH lower anchors (rear outboard seat positions only) or the seat belt, as applicable. If you have any questions when installing a top tether strap, consult your NISSAN dealer for details. BOOSTER SEATS Precautions on booster seats WARNING If a booster seat and seat belt are not used properly, the risk of a child being injured in a sudden stop or collision greatly increases: – Make sure the shoulder portion of the belt is away from the child’s face and neck and the lap portion of the belt does not cross the stomach. – Make sure the shoulder belt is not behind the child or under the child’s arm. – A booster seat must only be installed in a seating position that has a lap/shoulder belt. 1 from the anchor 1. Flip up the anchor cover 䊊 point which is located directly behind the child seat. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-39 LRS0455 LRS0453 LRS0464 Booster seats of various sizes are offered by several manufacturers. When selecting any booster seat, keep the following points in mind: ● Make sure the child’s head will be properly supported by the booster seat or vehicle seat. The seatback must be at or above the center of the child’s ears. For example, if a 1 is chosen, the low back booster seat 䊊 vehicle seatback must be at or above the center of the child’s ears. If the seatback is lower than the center of the child’s ears, a 2 should be used. high back booster seat 䊊 All U.S. states and Canadian provinces or territories require that infants and small children be restrained in an approved child restraint at all times while the vehicle is being operated. ● Choose only a booster seat with a label certifying that it complies with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213 or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213. ● Check the booster seat in your vehicle to be sure it is compatible with the vehicle’s seat and seat belt system. ● If the booster seat is compatible with your vehicle, place the child in the booster seat and check the various adjustments to be sure the booster seat is compatible with the child. Always follow all recommended procedures. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-40 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system The instructions in this section apply to booster seat installation in the rear seats or the front passenger seat. Booster seat installation CAUTION Do not use the lap/shoulder belt in the Automatic Locking Retractor mode when using a booster seat with the seat belts. Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the “Child safety”, “Child restraints” and “Booster seats” sections before installing a child restraint. Follow these steps to install a booster seat in the rear seat or in the front passenger seat: WRS0699 LRS0454 1. If you must install a booster seat in the front seat, move the seat to the rearmost position. Front passenger position 3. The booster seat should be positioned on the vehicle seat so that it is stable. 2. Position the booster seat on the seat. Only place it in a front-facing direction. Always follow the booster seat manufacturer’s instructions. If necessary, adjust or remove the head restraint or headrest to obtain the correct booster seat fit. If the head restraint or headrest is removed, store it in a secure place. Be sure to reinstall the head restraint or headrest when the booster seat is removed. See “Head restraints” or “Adjustable headrest” in this section for head restraint or headrest adjustment, removal and installation information. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-41 If the seating position does not have an adjustable head restraint or headrest and it is interfering with the proper booster seat fit, try another seating position or a different booster seat. 4. Position the lap portion of the seat belt low and snug on the child’s hips. Be sure to follow the booster seat manufacturer’s instructions for adjusting the seat belt routing. 5. Pull the shoulder belt portion of the seat belt toward the retractor to take up extra slack. Be sure the shoulder belt is positioned across the top, middle portion of the child’s shoulder. Be sure to follow the booster seat manufacturer’s instructions for adjusting the seat belt routing. LRS0351 Type A 6. Follow the warnings, cautions and instructions for properly fastening a seat belt shown in “Three-point type seat belt with retractor” earlier in this section. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-42 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system LRS0316 Type B 7. If the booster seat is installed in the front passenger seat, place the ignition switch in the ON position. The front passenger air bag or may or may not status light illuminate, depending on the size of the child and the type of booster seat being used. See “Front passenger air bag and status light” later in this section. SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM PRECAUTIONS ON SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM This Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) section contains important information concerning the following systems: ● Driver and passenger supplemental frontimpact air bag (NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System) ● Front seat-mounted side-impact supplemental air bag ● Roof-mounted curtain side-impact supplemental air bag ● Seat belt with pretensioner Supplemental front-impact air bag system: The NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System can help cushion the impact force to the head and chest of the driver and front passenger in certain frontal collisions. Front seat-mounted side-impact supplemental air bag system: This system can help cushion the impact force to the chest and pelvic area of the driver and front passenger in certain side impact collisions. The side air bags are designed to inflate on the side where the vehicle is impacted. Roof-mounted curtain side-impact supplemental air bag system: This system can help cushion the impact force to the head of occupants in front and rear outboard seating positions in certain side-impact collisions. The curtain air bags are designed to inflate on the side where the vehicle is impacted. These supplemental restraint systems are designed to supplement the crash protection provided by the driver and front passenger seat belts and are not a substitute for them. Seat belts should always be correctly worn and the occupant seated a suitable distance away from the steering wheel, instrument panel and door finishers. (See “Seat belts” earlier in this section for instructions and precautions on seat belt usage.) The supplemental air bags operate only when the ignition switch is in the ON or START position. After placing the ignition switch in the ON position, the supplemental air bag warning light illuminates. The supplemental air bag warning light will turn off after about 7 seconds if the system is operational. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-43 ● The driver and front passenger seat belt buckles are equipped with sensors that detect if the seat belts are fastened. The Advanced Air Bag System monitors the severity of a collision and seat belt usage then inflates the air bags. Failure to properly wear seat belts can increase the risk or severity of injury in an accident. WRS0031 WARNING ● The front air bags ordinarily will not inflate in the event of a side impact, rear impact, rollover, or lower severity frontal collision. Always wear your seat belts to help reduce the risk or severity of injury in various kinds of accidents. ● The front passenger air bag will not inflate if the passenger air bag status light is lit or if the front passenger seat is unoccupied. See “Front passenger air bag and status light” later in this section. ● The seat belts and the front air bags are most effective when you are sitting well back and upright in the seat. The front air bags inflate with great force. Even with the NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System, if you are unrestrained, leaning forward, sitting sideways or out of position in any way, you are at greater risk of injury or death in a crash. You may also receive serious or fatal injuries from the front air bag if you are up against it when it inflates. Always sit back against the seatback and as far away as practical from the steering wheel or instrument panel. Always use the seat belts. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-44 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system ● The front passenger seat is equipped with an occupant classification sensor (pressure sensor) that turns the front passenger air bag OFF under some conditions. This sensor is only used in this seat. Failure to be properly seated and wearing the seat belt can increase the risk or severity of injury in an accident. See “Front Passenger air bag and status light” later in this section. ● Keep hands on the outside of the steering wheel. Placing them inside the steering wheel rim could increase the risk that they are injured when the front air bag inflates. ARS1133 ARS1041 WARNING ● Never let children ride unrestrained or extend their hands or face out of the window. Do not attempt to hold them in your lap or arms. Some examples of dangerous riding positions are shown in the illustrations. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-45 ARS1042 ARS1043 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-46 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system ARS1044 ARS1045 WRS0256 SSS0101 ● Children may be severely injured or killed when the front air bags, side air bags or curtain air bags inflate if they are not properly restrained. Pre-teens and children should be properly restrained in the rear seat, if possible. Front seat-mounted side-impact supplemental air bags and roof-mounted curtain side-impact supplemental air bags: WARNING ● Even with the NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System, never install a rear-facing child restraint in the front seat. An inflating front air bag could seriously injure or kill your child. See “Child restraints” earlier in this section for details. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : WARNING ● The side air bags and curtain air bags ordinarily will not inflate in the event of a frontal impact, rear impact, rollover or lower severity side collision. Always wear your seat belts to help reduce the risk or severity of injury in various kinds of accidents. Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-47 WARNING SSS0188 ● The seat belts, the side air bags and curtain air bags are most effective when you are sitting well back and upright in the seat with both feet on the floor. The side air bag and curtain air bag inflate with great force. Do not allow anyone to place their hand, leg or face near the side air bag on the side of the seatback of the front seat or near the side roof rails. Do not allow anyone sitting in the front seats or rear outboard seats to extend their hand out of the window or lean against the door. Some examples of dangerous riding positions are shown in the previous illustrations. WRS0032 WARNING ● When sitting in the rear seat, do not hold onto the seatback of the front seat. If the side air bag inflates, you may be seriously injured. Be especially careful with children, who should always be properly restrained. Some examples of dangerous riding positions are shown in the illustrations. ● Do not use seat covers on the front seatbacks. They may interfere with side air bag inflation. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-48 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system SSS0159 SSS0162 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-49 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Roof-mounted curtain side-impact supplemental air bags Front seat-mounted side-impact supplemental air bag modules Supplemental front-impact air bag modules Crash zone sensor Air Bag Control Unit (ACU) Occupant classification sensor (pressure sensor) Pretensioner Side satellite sensor NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System (front seats) This vehicle is equipped with the NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System for the driver and front passenger seats. This system is designed to meet certification requirements under U.S. regulations. It is also permitted in Canada. However, all of the information, cautions and warnings in this manual still apply and must be followed. LRS0725 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-50 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system The driver supplemental front-impact air bag is located in the center of the steering wheel. The passenger supplemental front-impact air bag is mounted in the dashboard above the glove box. The front air bags are designed to inflate in higher severity frontal collisions, although they may in- flate if the forces in another type of collision are similar to those of a higher severity frontal impact. They may not inflate in certain frontal collisions. Vehicle damage (or lack of it) is not always an indication of proper front air bag system operation. The NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System has dual stage inflators. It also monitors information from the crash zone sensor, the Air bag Control Unit (ACU), seat belt buckle sensors, occupant classification sensor (pressure sensor) and passenger seat belt tension sensor. Inflator operation is based on the severity of a collision and seat belt usage for the driver. For the front passenger, it additionally monitors the weight of an occupant or object on the seat and seat belt tension. Based on information from the sensors, only one front air bag may inflate in a crash, depending on the crash severity and whether the front occupants are belted or unbelted. Additionally, the front passenger air bag may be automatically turned OFF under some conditions, depending on the weight detected on the passenger seat and how the seat belt is used. If the front passenger air bag is OFF, the passenger air bag status light will be illuminated (if the seat is unoccupied, the light will not be illuminated, but the air bag will be off). See “Front passenger air bag and status light” later in this section for further details. One front air bag inflating does not indicate improper performance of the system. force of the front air bag inflating can increase the risk of injury if the occupant is too close to, or is against, the front air bag module during inflation. If you have any questions about your air bag system, please contact NISSAN or your NISSAN dealer. If you are considering modification of your vehicle due to a disability, you may also contact NISSAN. Contact information is contained in the front of this Owner’s Manual. The front air bags deflate quickly after a collision. When a front air bag inflates, a fairly loud noise may be heard, followed by the release of smoke. This smoke is not harmful and does not indicate a fire. Care should be taken to not inhale it, as it may cause irritation and choking. Those with a history of a breathing condition should get fresh air promptly. The front air bags operate only when the ignition switch is in the ON or START position. After placing the ignition switch in the ON position, the supplemental air bag warning light illuminates. The supplemental air bag warning light will turn off after about 7 seconds if the system is operational. Front air bags, along with the use of seat belts, help to cushion the impact force on the face and chest of the front occupants. They can help save lives and reduce serious injuries. However, an inflating front air bag may cause facial abrasions or other injuries. Front air bags do not provide restraint to the lower body. Even with NISSAN advanced air bags, seat belts should be correctly worn and the driver and passenger seated upright as far as practical away from the steering wheel or instrument panel. The front air bags inflate quickly in order to help protect the front occupants. Because of this, the I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-51 ● Occupied passenger seat and the passenger meet the conditions outlined in this secor is OFF to intion: The light dicate that the front passenger air bag is operational. Front passenger air bag LRS0351 Type A Front passenger air bag and status light WARNING The front passenger air bag is designed to automatically turn OFF under some conditions. Read this section carefully to learn how it operates. Proper use of the seat, seat belt and child restraints is necessary for most effective protection. Failure to follow all instructions in this manual concerning the use of seats, seat belts and child restraints can increase the risk or severity of injury in an accident. LRS0316 Type B Status light The front passenger air bag status light or is located near the climate controls. The light operates as follows: ● Unoccupied passenger’s seat: The or is OFF and the front passenger air bag is OFF and will not inflate in a crash. ● Passenger’s seat occupied by a small adult, child or child restraint as outlined in this or illuminates to section: The indicate that the front passenger air bag is OFF and will not inflate in a crash. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-52 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system The front passenger air bag is designed to automatically turn OFF when the vehicle is operated under some conditions as described below in accordance with U.S. regulations. If the front passenger air bag is OFF, it will not inflate in a crash. The driver air bag and other air bags in your vehicle are not part of this system. The purpose of the regulation is to help reduce the risk of injury or death from an inflating air bag to certain front passenger seat occupants, such as children, by requiring the air bag to be automatically turned OFF. Certain sensors are used to meet the requirements. One sensor used is the occupant classification sensor (pressure sensor). It is in the bottom of the front passenger seat cushion and is designed to detect an occupant and objects on the seat by weight. It works together with seat belt sensors described later. For example, if a child is in the front passenger seat, the Advanced Air Bag System is designed to turn the passenger air bag OFF in accordance with the regulations. Also, if a child restraint of the type specified in the regula- tions is on the seat, its weight and the child’s weight can be detected and cause the air bag to turn OFF. Occupant classification sensor operation can vary depending on the front passenger seat belt sensors. The front passenger seat belt sensors are designed to detect if the seat belt is buckled and the amount of tension on the seat belt, such as when it is in the Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode (child restraint mode). Based on the weight on the seat detected by the occupant classification sensor and the belt tension detected on the seat belt, the Advanced Air Bag System determines whether the front passenger air bag should be automatically turned OFF as required by the regulations. Front passenger seat adult occupants who are properly seated and using the seat belt as outlined in this manual should not cause the passenger air bag to be automatically turned OFF. For small adults it may be turned OFF, however if the occupant takes his/her weight off the seat cushion (for example, by not sitting upright, by sitting on an edge of the seat, or by otherwise being out of position), this could cause the sensor to turn the air bag OFF. In addition, if the occupant improperly uses the seat belt in the ALR mode (child restraint mode), this could cause the air bag to be turned OFF. Always be sure to be seated and wearing the seat belt properly for the most effective protection by the seat belt and supplemental air bag. NISSAN recommends that pre-teens and children be properly restrained in a rear seat. NISSAN also recommends that appropriate child restraints and booster seats be properly installed in a rear seat. If this is not possible, the occupant classification sensor and seat belt sensors are designed to operate as described above to turn the front passenger air bag OFF for specified child restraints as required by the regulations. Failing to properly secure child restraints and to use the ALR mode (child restraint mode) may allow the restraint to tip or move in an accident or sudden stop. This can also result in the passenger air bag inflating in a crash instead of being OFF. See “Child restraints” earlier in this section for proper use and installation. If the front passenger seat is not occupied the passenger air bag is designed not to inflate in a crash. However, heavy objects placed on the seat could result in air bag inflation, because of the object’s weight detected by the occupant classification sensor. Other conditions could also result in air bag inflation, such as if a child is standing on the seat, or if two children are on the seat, contrary to the instructions in this manual. Always be sure that you and all vehicle occupants are seated and restrained properly. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Using the passenger air bag status light, you can monitor when the front passenger air bag is automatically turned OFF with the seat occupied. The light will not illuminate when the front passenger seat is unoccupied. If an adult occupant is in the seat but the passenger air bag status light is illuminated (indicating that the air bag is OFF), it could be that the person is a small adult, or is not sitting on the seat properly or not using the seat belt properly. If a child restraint must be used in the front seat, the passenger air bag status light may or may not be illuminated, depending on the size of the child and the type of child restraint being used. If the air bag status light is not illuminated (indicating that the air bag might inflate in a crash), it could be that the child restraint or seat belt is not being used properly. Make sure that the child restraint is installed properly, the seat belt is used properly and the occupant is positioned properly. If the air bag status light is not illuminated, reposition the occupant or child restraint in a rear seat. If the passenger air bag status light will not illuminate even though you believe that the child restraint, the seat belts and the occupant are properly positioned, the system may be sensing an unoccupied seat (in which case the air bag is OFF). Your NISSAN dealer can check that the system is OFF by using a special tool. However, Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-53 until you have confirmed with your dealer that your air bag is working properly, reposition the occupant or child restraint in a rear seat. The air bag system and passenger air bag status light will take a few seconds to register a change in the passenger seat status. For example, if a large adult who is sitting in the front passenger seat exits the vehicle, the passenger air bag status light will go from OFF to ON for a few seconds and then to OFF. This is normal system operation and does not indicate a malfunction. If a malfunction occurs in the front passenger air bag system, the supplemental air bag warning , located in the meter and gauges area light in the center of the instrument panel, will blink. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer. Other supplemental front-impact air bag precautions WARNING ● Do not place any objects on the steering wheel pad or on the instrument panel. Also, do not place any objects between any occupant and the steering wheel or instrument panel. Such objects may become dangerous projectiles and cause injury if the front air bags inflate. ● Immediately after inflation, several front air bag system components will be hot. Do not touch them; you may severely burn yourself. ● No unauthorized changes should be made to any components or wiring of the supplemental air bag system. This is to prevent accidental inflation of the supplemental air bag or damage to the supplemental air bag system. ● Do not make unauthorized changes to your vehicle’s electrical system, suspension system or front end structure. This could affect proper operation of the front air bag system. ● Tampering with the front air bag system may result in serious personal injury. Tampering includes changes to the steering wheel and the instrument panel assembly by placing material over the steering wheel pad and above the instrument panel or by installing additional trim material around the air bag system. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-54 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system ● Modifying or tampering with the front passenger seat may result in serious personal injury. For example, do not change the front seats by placing material on the seat cushion or by installing additional trim material, such as seat covers, on the seat that are not specifically designed to assure proper air bag operation. Additionally, do not stow any objects under the front passenger seat or the seat cushion and seatback. Such objects may interfere with the proper operation of the occupant classification sensor (pressure sensor). ● No unauthorized changes should be made to any components or wiring of the seat belt system. This may affect the front air bag system. Tampering with the seat belt system may result in serious personal injury. inflate if the forces in another type of collision are similar to those of a higher severity side impact. They are designed to inflate on the side where the vehicle is impacted. They may not inflate in certain side collisions. ● Work on and around the front air bag system should be done by a NISSAN dealer. Installation of electrical equipment should also be done by a NISSAN dealer. The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) wiring should not be modified or disconnected. Unauthorized electrical test equipment and probing devices should not be used on the air bag system. ● A cracked windshield should be replaced immediately by a qualified repair facility. A cracked windshield could affect the function of the supplemental air bag system. *The SRS wiring harness connectors are yellow and orange for easy identification. When selling your vehicle, we request that you inform the buyer about the supplemental front air bag system and guide the buyer to the appropriate sections in this Owner’s Manual. Vehicle damage (or lack of it) is not always an indication of proper side air bag and curtain air bag operation. LRS0259 Front seat-mounted side-impact supplemental air bag and roofmounted curtain side-impact supplemental air bag systems The side air bags are located in the outside of the seatback of the front seats. The curtain air bags are located in the side roof rails. These systems are designed to meet voluntary guidelines to help reduce the risk of injury to out-of-position occupants. However, all of the information, cautions and warnings in this manual still apply and must be followed. The side air bags and curtain air bags are designed to inflate in higher severity side collisions, although they may I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : When the side air bags and curtain air bags inflate, a fairly loud noise may be heard, followed by release of smoke. This smoke is not harmful and does not indicate a fire. Care should be taken not to inhale it, as it may cause irritation and choking. Those with a history of a breathing condition should get fresh air promptly. Side air bags, along with the use of seat belts, help to cushion the impact force on the chest of the front occupants. Curtain air bags help to cushion the impact force to the head of occupants in the front and rear outboard seating positions. They can help save lives and reduce serious injuries. However, an inflating side air bag and curtain air bag may cause abrasions or other injuries. Side air bags and curtain air bags do not provide restraint to the lower body. The seat belts should be correctly worn and the driver and passenger seated upright as far as practical away from the side air bag. Rear seat passengers should be seated as far away as Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-55 practical from the door finishers and side roof rails. The side air bags and curtain air bags inflate quickly in order to help protect the front and rear outboard occupants. Because of this, the force of the side air bag and curtain air bag inflating can increase the risk of injury if the occupant is too close to, or is against, these air bag modules during inflation. The side air bags and curtain air bags will deflate quickly after the collision is over. The side air bags and curtain air bags operate only when the ignition switch is in the ON or START position. After placing the ignition switch in the ON position, the supplemental air bag warning light illuminates. The supplemental air bag warning light will turn off after about 7 seconds if the system is operational. WARNING ● Do not place any objects near the seatback of the front seats. Also, do not place any objects (an umbrella, bag, etc.) between the front door finisher and the front seat. Such objects may become dangerous projectiles and cause injury if a side air bag inflates. ● Right after inflation, several side air bag and curtain air bag system components will be hot. Do not touch them; you may severely burn yourself. ● No unauthorized changes should be made to any components or wiring of the side air bag and curtain air bag systems. This is to prevent damage to or accidental inflation of the side air bag and curtain air bag or damage to the side air bag and curtain air bag systems. ● Do not make unauthorized changes to your vehicle’s electrical system, suspension system or side panel. This could affect proper operation of the side air bag and curtain air bag systems. ● Tampering with the side air bag system may result in serious personal injury. For example, do not change the front seats by placing material near the seatbacks or by installing additional trim material, such as seat covers, around the side air bag. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-56 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system ● Work around and on the side air bag and curtain air bag systems should be done by a NISSAN dealer. Installation of electrical equipment should also be done by a NISSAN dealer. The SRS wiring harnesses* should not be modified or disconnected. Unauthorized electrical test equipment and probing devices should not be used on the side air bag system. * The SRS wiring harness connectors are yellow and orange for easy identification. When selling your vehicle, we request that you inform the buyer about the side air bag and curtain air bag systems and guide the buyer to the appropriate sections in this Owner’s Manual. Seat belts with pretensioners (front seats) WARNING ● The pretensioners cannot be reused after activation. They must be replaced together with the retractor and buckle as a unit. ● If the vehicle becomes involved in a frontal collision but a pretensioner is not activated, be sure to have the pretensioner system checked and, if necessary, replaced by your NISSAN dealer. ● No unauthorized changes should be made to any components or wiring of the pretensioner system. This is to prevent damage to or accidental activation of the pretensioners. Tampering with the pretensioner system may result in serious personal injury. ● Work around and on the pretensioner system should be done by a NISSAN dealer. Installation of electrical equipment should also be done by a NISSAN dealer. Unauthorized electrical test equipment and probing devices should not be used on the pretensioner system. ● If you need to dispose of a pretensioner or scrap the vehicle, contact a NISSAN dealer. Incorrect disposal procedures could cause personal injury. The pretensioner system activates in conjunction with the front air bag system. Working with the seat belt retractor, it helps tighten the seat belt when the vehicle becomes involved in certain types of collisions, helping to restrain front seat occupants. The pretensioner is encased within the seat belt retractor. These seat belts are used the same way as conventional seat belts. If any abnormality occurs in the pretensioner system, the supplemental air bag warning will not come on, will flash intermitlight tently or will turn on for 7 seconds and remain on after the ignition switch has been placed in the ON or START position. In this case, the pretensioner system may not function properly. It must be checked and repaired. Take your vehicle to the nearest NISSAN dealer. When selling your vehicle, we request that you inform the buyer about the pretensioner system and guide the buyer to the appropriate sections in this Owner’s Manual. When a pretensioner activates, smoke is released and a loud noise may be heard. This smoke is not harmful and does not indicate a fire. Care should be taken not to inhale it, as it may cause irritation and choking. Those with a history of a breathing condition should get fresh air promptly. After pretensioner activation, load limiters allow the seat belt to release webbing (if necessary) to reduce forces against the chest. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-57 When the ignition switch is placed in the ON or START position, the supplemental air bag warning light illuminates for about 7 seconds and then turns off. This means the system is operational. If any of the following conditions occur, the front air bag, side air bag, curtain air bag and pretensioner systems need servicing: ● The supplemental air bag warning light remains on after approximately 7 seconds. ● The supplemental air bag warning light flashes intermittently. WRS0897 1. SRS Front Air Bag Warning Labels SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAG WARNING LABELS Warning labels about the supplemental frontimpact air bag system are placed in the vehicle as shown in the illustration. LRS0100 SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAG WARNING LIGHT The supplemental air bag warning light, in the instrument panel, monidisplaying tors the circuits of the supplemental front-impact air bag, front seat-mounted side-impact supplemental air bag, roof-mounted curtain side-impact supplemental air bag and seat belt pretensioner systems. The monitored circuits include the Air bag Control Unit (ACU), crash zone sensor, satellite sensors, occupant classification system, front air bag modules, side air bag modules, curtain air bag modules, pretensioners and all related wiring. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 1-58 Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system ● The supplemental air bag warning light does not come on at all. Under these conditions, the front air bag, side air bag, curtain air bag or pretensioner systems may not operate properly. They must be checked and repaired. Take your vehicle to the nearest NISSAN dealer. WARNING If the supplemental air bag warning light is on, it could mean that the front air bag, side air bag, curtain air bag and/or pretensioner systems will not operate in an accident. To help avoid injury to yourself or others, have your vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as possible. Repair and replacement procedure The front air bags, side air bags, curtain air bags and pretensioners are designed to inflate on a one-time-only basis. As a reminder, unless it is damaged, the supplemental air bag warning light remains illuminated after inflation has occurred. Repair and replacement of these supplemental air bag systems should be done only by a NISSAN dealer. When maintenance work is required on the vehicle, the front air bags, side air bags, curtain air bags, pretensioners and related parts should be pointed out to the person performing the maintenance. The ignition switch should always be placed in the LOCK position when working under the hood or inside the vehicle. ● The front air bag, side air bag, curtain air bag systems and the pretensioner system should be inspected by a NISSAN dealer if there is any damage to the front end or side portion of the vehicle. ● If you need to dispose of the supplemental air bag or pretensioner systems or scrap the vehicle, contact a NISSAN dealer. Incorrect disposal procedures could cause personal injury. WARNING ● Once a front air bag, side air bag, or curtain air bag has inflated, the air bag module will not function again and must be replaced. Additionally, if any of the front air bags inflate, the activated pretensioner must also be replaced. The air bag module and pretensioner should be replaced by a NISSAN dealer. The air bag module and pretensioner cannot be repaired. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-59 2 Instruments and controls Headlight control switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22 Instrument panel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2 Daytime running light system (Canada only) . . . . . . 2-23 Meters and gauges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3 Instrument brightness control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-23 Speedometer and odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4 Turn signal switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24 Trip computer (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4 Fog light switch (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24 Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5 Hazard warning flasher switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24 g (gravity)-force gauge (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6 Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-25 Fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6 Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) off switch Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7 (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-25 Engine oil pressure gauge (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . 2-7 Heated seat (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26 Outside temperature display (if so equipped) . . . . . . 2-8 Power outlet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26 Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders . . . . . . . 2-9 Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-27 Checking bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10 Map pockets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-27 Warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10 Storage bin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28 Indicator lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14 Storage trays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28 Audible reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16 Instrument panel storage (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . 2-28 Security systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17 Seatback pockets (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29 Vehicle security system (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . 2-17 Cup holders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30 NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19 Glove box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31 Windshield wiper and washer switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-20 Console box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31 Switch operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-20 Trunk divider (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31 Rear window and outside mirror (if so equipped) defroster switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21 Cargo net (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-32 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Headlight and turn signal switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22 Grocery hooks (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-33 Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34 Power windows (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34 Manual windows (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37 Moonroof (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37 Electric moonroof. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37 Interior light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39 Map lights (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-40 Trunk light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : INSTRUMENT PANEL 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. WIC1600 1. 2. Headlight/fog light (if so equipped) /turn signal switch (P. 2-22); Manual shift paddles (if so equipped) (P.5-15) Steering wheel switch for audio control and Bluetooth姞 Hands-Free Phone System (if so equipped) (P. 4-60, 4-62) 2-2 Instruments and controls 3. 4. 5. 6. Driver’s supplemental air bag/Horn (P. 1-43, 2-25) Meters and gauges (P. 2-3) Instrument brightness control (P. 2-23) Cruise control main/set switches (if so equipped) (P. 5-20) I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 19. 20. 21. 22. 23. 24. Windshield wiper/washer switch (P. 2-20) Storage bin (if so equipped) (P. 2-27) Audio system (P. 4-31, 4-34, 4-38) Center ventilator (P. 4-14) Passenger’s supplemental air bag (P. 1-43) Side ventilator (P. 4-14) Storage bin (if so equipped) (P. 2-28) Engine oil pressure gauge (if so equipped) (P. 2-7) g (gravity)-force gauge (if so equipped) (P. 2-6) Hazard warning flasher switch (if so equipped) (P. 2-24) Hazard warning flasher switch (if so equipped) (P. 2-24); Manual shift mode switch (if so equipped) (P.5-15) Navigation system* (if so equipped) (P. 4-44) Glove box (P. 2-31) Front passenger air bag status light (P. 1-43) Climate control (P. 4-14) Shift selector (P. 5-12) Power outlet (P. 2-26) Ignition switch (P. 5-7) METERS AND GAUGES 25. 26. 27. 28 Tilt steering (P.3-27) Storage bin (P. 2-28) Hood release lever (P. 3-23) Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) off switch (if so equipped) (P.2-16) * Refer to the separate Navigation System Owner’s Manual (if so equipped). See the page number indicated in parentheses for operating details. LIC1014 1. 2. 3. Tachometer Fuel gauge/odometer/transmission position indicator/engine coolant temperature gauge/Instrument brightness level/trip computer (if so equipped) Speedometer I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4. Instrument brightness control/change button for twin trip odometer/change button for trip computer (if so equipped) Instruments and controls 2-3 Changing the display Push the instrument brightness control/change button to change the display as follows: With twin trip odometer: Odometer → Trip A → Trip B → Odometer With trip computer: Odometer → Trip A → Trip B → DTE → Instant Fuel Economy → Average Fuel Economy → Average Speed → Journey time → Odometer LIC1015 WIC1508 SPEEDOMETER AND ODOMETER Odometer/Twin trip odometer Speedometer The odometer/twin trip odometer is displayed when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position. The speedometer indicates the vehicle speed. The odometer records the total distance the vehicle has been driven. The twin trip odometer records the distance of individual trips. To switch between the odometer and the twin trip odometers press the instrument brightness control/change button. 2-4 Instruments and controls I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Resetting the trip odometer Push the instrument brightness control/change button for more than 1 second to reset the currently displayed trip odometer to zero. TRIP COMPUTER (if so equipped) When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, modes of the trip computer can be selected by pushing the trip computer change button on the instrument panel located near the speedometer. The following modes can be selected in the display: ● ● ● ● ● Distance to empty Instant fuel economy Average fuel consumption Average speed Journey time Distance to empty (dte—mile or km) Average speed (mph or km/h) The distance to empty (dte) mode provides you with an estimation of the distance that can be driven before refueling. The dte is constantly being calculated, based on the amount of fuel in the fuel tank and the actual fuel consumption. The average speed mode shows the average vehicle speed since last reset. Resetting is done by pressing the trip or change button for more than approximately 1 second. The display is updated every 30 seconds. The first 30 seconds after a reset, the display shows (----). The display is updated every 30 seconds. NOTE: Journey time When driving uphill or rounding curves, the fuel in the tank shifts, which may momentarily change the display. The journey time mode shows the time since the last reset. The displayed time can be reset by pressing the change button for more than approximately 1 second. Instant fuel economy Trip computer reset The instant fuel economy mode shows the instant fuel consumption. The display updates instantly when driving. Pushing the change button for more than 3 seconds will reset all modes except Trip A and distance to empty (dte). Average fuel consumption (Mpg or l/100km) LIC1021 TACHOMETER The tachometer indicates engine speed in revolutions per minute (rpm). Do not rev the engine 1 . into the red zone 䊊 CAUTION When engine speed approaches the red zone, shift to a higher gear or reduce engine speed. Operating the engine in the red zone may cause serious engine damage. The average fuel consumption mode shows the average fuel consumption since the last reset. Resetting is done by pressing the change button for more than approximately 1 second. The display is updated every 30 seconds. At about the first 1/3 miles (500 m) after a reset, the display shows (----). I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Instruments and controls 2-5 indicates that the fuel-filler door is The located on the passenger’s side of the vehicle. CAUTION ● If the vehicle runs out of fuel, Malfunction Indicator Light the (MIL) may come on. Refuel as soon as possible. After a few driving trips, light should turn off. If the the light remains on after a few driving trips, have the vehicle inspected by a NISSAN dealer. LIC1113 g (gravity)-FORCE GAUGE (if so equipped) This gauge shows the straight-line acceleration and deceleration g-forces while you are driving. NOTE: The g-force gauge does not indicate cornering g-forces. LIC1529 FUEL GAUGE NOTE: The ignition switch must be placed in the ON position for the gauge to give a reading. The gauge indicates the approximate fuel level in the tank. The gauge may move slightly during braking, turning, acceleration, or going up or down hills. The low fuel warning light comes on when the amount of fuel in the tank is getting low. Refill the fuel tank before the gauge registers E (Empty). 2-6 Instruments and controls I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ● For additional information, see “Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)” later in this section. CAUTION If the gauge indicates a coolant temperature near the hot (H) end of the normal range, reduce vehicle speed to decrease the temperature. If the gauge is over the normal range, stop the vehicle as soon as safely possible. If the engine is overheated, continued operation of the vehicle may seriously damage the engine. See “If your vehicle overheats” in the “In case of emergency” section for immediate action required LIC1530 LIC1114 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE GAUGE ENGINE OIL PRESSURE GAUGE (if so equipped) NOTE: The gauge indicates the engine lubrication system oil pressure while the engine is running. When the engine speed is high, the engine oil pressure is also high. When the engine speed is low, the gauge indicates lower oil pressure. The ignition switch must be placed in the ON position for the gauge to give a reading. The gauge indicates the engine coolant temperature. The engine coolant temperature is within the normal range when the reading is within the zone A shown in the illustration. 䊊 Engine oil pressure also changes based on engine temperature. The oil pressure will be higher when the engine is cold and lower when the engine is warm. The engine coolant temperature varies with the outside air temperature and driving conditions. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Instruments and controls 2-7 CAUTION ● This gauge is not designed to indicate low engine oil level. Use the dipstick to check the oil level. (See “Engine oil” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section.) ● If the gauge needle does not move with the proper amount of engine oil, have the vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer. Continued vehicle operation in such a condition could cause serious damage to the engine. OUTSIDE TEMPERATURE DISPLAY (if so equipped) The outside temperature function provides a display of the outside temperature when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position. The display of positive temperatures is unsigned (blank), negative temperatures are prefixed with a minus sign. 2-8 Instruments and controls I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : WARNING/INDICATOR LIGHTS AND AUDIBLE REMINDERS or Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning light (if so equipped) NISSAN Intelligent Key™ warning light (if so equipped) Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) or Brake warning light P position selecting warning light (CVT models) (if so equipped) Overdrive off indicator light (CVT models) Charge warning light Seat belt warning light and chime Security indicator light Door open warning light Supplemental air bag warning light Side light and headlight indicator light (green) Electric power steering warning light Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) position indicator light (CVT models) Slip indicator light (if so equipped) Engine oil pressure warning light Cruise main switch indicator light (if so equipped) Turn signal/hazard indicator lights Low fuel warning light Cruise set switch indicator light (if so equipped) Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF indicator light (if so equipped) Low tire pressure warning light (if so equipped) or Low windshield-washer fluid warning light (if so equipped) High beam indicator light (blue) Front passenger air bag status light I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Instruments and controls 2-9 CHECKING BULBS With all doors closed, apply the parking brake and place the ignition switch in the ON position without starting the engine. The following lights will come on: or , , , , , If equipped, the following lights come on briefly and then go off: or , , , If any light fails to come on, it may indicate an open circuit in the electrical system. Have the system repaired promptly. WARNING LIGHTS or Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning light (if so equipped) When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, the Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning light illuminates and then turns off. This indicates the ABS is operational. 2-10 Instruments and controls If the ABS warning light illuminates while the engine is running, or while driving, it may indicate the ABS is not functioning properly. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer. If an ABS malfunction occurs, the anti-lock function is turned off. The brake system then operates normally, but without anti-lock assistance. See ⬙Brake system⬙ in the ⬙Starting and driving⬙ section. or Brake warning light This light functions for both the parking brake and the foot brake systems. Parking brake indicator When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, the light comes on when the parking brake is applied. Low brake fluid warning light When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, the light warns of a low brake fluid level. If the light comes on while the engine is running with the parking brake not applied, stop the vehicle and perform the following: 1. Check the brake fluid level. Add brake fluid as necessary. See “Brake fluid” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 2. If the brake fluid level is correct, have the warning system checked by a NISSAN dealer. WARNING ● Your brake system may not be working properly if the warning light is on. Driving could be dangerous. If you judge it to be safe, drive carefully to the nearest service station for repairs. Otherwise, have your vehicle towed because driving it could be dangerous. ● Pressing the brake pedal with the engine stopped and/or a low brake fluid level may increase your stopping distance and braking will require greater pedal effort as well as pedal travel. ● If the brake fluid MINIMUM or MIN fluid reservoir, do brake system has NISSAN dealer. level is below the mark on the brake not drive until the been checked at a Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning indicator When the parking brake is released and the brake fluid level is sufficient, if both the brake warning light and the Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) waning light illuminate, it may indicate the ABS is not functioning properly. Have the brake system checked, and if necessary, repaired by a NISSAN dealer promptly. Avoid high-speed driving and abrupt braking. (See “Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning light” in this section.) Charge warning light If this light comes on while the engine is running, it may indicate the charging system is not functioning properly. Turn the engine off and check the generator belt. If the belt is loose, broken, missing, or if the light remains on, see a NISSAN dealer immediately. CAUTION Do not continue driving if the generator belt is loose, broken or missing. Door open warning light This light comes on when any of the doors are not closed securely while the ignition switch is placed in the ON position. Electric power steering warning light WARNING ● If the engine is not running or is turned off while driving, the power assist for the steering will not work. Steering will be harder to operate. ● When the power steering warning light illuminates with the engine running, there will be no power assist for the steering. You will still have control of the vehicle but the steering will be harder to operate. Have the power steering system checked by a NISSAN dealer. When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, the power steering warning light illuminates. After starting the engine, the power steering warning light turns off. This indicates the power steering system is operational. If the power steering warning light illuminates while the engine is running, it may indicate the power steering system is not functioning properly and may need servicing. Have the power steering system checked by a NISSAN dealer. When the power steering warning light illuminates with the engine running, there will be no I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : power assist for the steering but you will still have control of the vehicle. At this time, greater steering effort is required to operate the steering wheel, especially in sharp turns and at low speeds. See “Power steering” in the “Starting and driving” section. Engine oil pressure warning light This light warns of low engine oil pressure. If the light flickers or comes on during normal driving, pull off the road in a safe area, stop the engine immediately and call a NISSAN dealer or other authorized repair shop. The engine oil pressure warning light is not designed to indicate a low oil level. Use the dipstick to check the oil level. See “Engine oil” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual. CAUTION Running the engine with the engine oil pressure warning light on could cause serious damage to the engine almost immediately. Such damage is not covered by warranty. Turn off the engine as soon as it is safe to do so. Instruments and controls 2-11 Low fuel warning light This light comes on when the fuel level in the fuel tank is getting low. Refuel as soon as it is convenient, preferably before the fuel gauge reaches E (Empty). There will be a small reserve of fuel in the tank when the fuel gauge reaches E (Empty), showing no more fuel bars. Low tire pressure warning light (if so equipped) Your vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) that monitors the tire pressure of all tires except the spare. The low tire pressure warning light warns of low tire pressure or indicates that the TPMS is not functioning properly. After the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, this light illuminates for about 1 second and turns off. Low tire pressure warning: If the vehicle is being driven with low tire pressure, the warning light will illuminate. When the low tire pressure warning light illuminates, you should stop and adjust the tire pressure of all 4 tires to the recommended COLD tire pressure shown on the 2-12 Instruments and controls Tire and Loading Information label located in the driver’s door opening. The low tire pressure warning light does not automatically turn off when the tire pressure is adjusted. After the tire is inflated to the recommended pressure, the vehicle must be driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h) to activate the TPMS and turn off the low tire pressure warning light. Use a tire pressure gauge to check the tire pressure. For additional information, see “Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)” in the “Starting and driving” section and in the “In case of emergency” section. TPMS malfunction: If the TPMS is not functioning properly, the low tire pressure warning light will flash for approximately 1 minute when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position. The light will remain on after the 1 minute. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer. For additional information, see “Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)” in the “Starting and driving” section and “Tire pressure” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : WARNING ● If the light does not illuminate with the ignition switch placed in the ON position, have the vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as possible. ● If the light illuminates while driving, avoid sudden steering maneuvers or abrupt braking, reduce vehicle speed, pull off the road to a safe location and stop the vehicle as soon as possible. Driving with under-inflated tires may permanently damage the tires and increase the likelihood of tire failure. Serious vehicle damage could occur and may lead to an accident and could result in serious personal injury. Check the tire pressure for all four tires. Adjust the tire pressure to the recommended COLD tire pressure shown on the Tire and Loading Information label located in the driver’s door opening to turn the low tire pressure warning light OFF. If the light still comes on while driving after adjusting the tire pressure, a tire may be flat. If you have a flat tire, replace it with a spare tire as soon as possible. ● When a spare tire is mounted or a wheel is replaced the TPMS will not function and the low tire pressure warning light will flash for approximately 1 minute. The light will remain on after 1 minute. Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon as possible for tire replacement and/or system resetting. ● Replacing tires with those not originally specified by NISSAN could affect the proper operation of the TPMS. CAUTION ● The TPMS is not a substitute for the regular tire pressure check. Be sure to check the tire pressure regularly. ● If the vehicle is being driven at speeds of less than 16 MPH (25 km/h), the TPMS may not operate correctly. ● Be sure to install the specified size of tires to the 4 wheels correctly. Low windshield-washer fluid warning light (if so equipped) This light comes on when the windshield-washer fluid is at a low level. Add windshield-washer fluid as necessary. See “Windshield-washer fluid” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual. NISSAN Intelligent Key™ warning light (if so equipped) The Intelligent Key warning light illuminates green when the ignition switch can be turned. The Intelligent Key warning light illuminates red when the ignition switch cannot be turned. The Intelligent Key warning light blinks red if the Intelligent Key is taken outside of the vehicle while the ignition switch is placed in the ACC or ON position. ● If the Intelligent Key warning light blinks, make sure of the location of the Intelligent Key as soon as possible. The Intelligent Key should be carried by the driver while operating the vehicle. ● The Intelligent Key warning light turns off about 10 seconds after the Intelligent Key is brought inside the vehicle. The Intelligent Key warning light blinks green indicating that the Intelligent Key battery is almost discharged. See “NISSAN Intelligent Key™ (if so equipped)” in the “Pre-driving checks and adjustments” section. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : P position selecting warning light (CVT models) (if so equipped) The light blinks red and the warning buzzer sounds if you are outside of the vehicle with the Intelligent Key and the engine is off, but the shift selector is not in the P (Park) position. When the warning light blinks, place the ignition switch in the ON position, move the shift selector to the P position, then place the ignition switch in the LOCK position. Seat belt warning light and chime The light and chime remind you to fasten your seat belts. The light illuminates whenever the ignition switch is placed in the ON or START position and remains illuminated until the driver’s seat belt is fastened. At the same time, the chime sounds for about 6 seconds unless the driver’s seat belt is securely fastened. The seat belt warning light may also illuminate if the front passenger’s seat belt is not fastened when the front passenger’s seat is occupied . For 7 seconds after the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, the system does not activate the warning light for the front passenger. Instruments and controls 2-13 Refer to “Seat belts” in the “Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system” section for precautions on seat belt usage. Supplemental air bag warning light When the ignition switch is placed in the ON or START position, the supplemental air bag warning light illuminates for about 7 seconds and then turns off. This means the system is operational. If any of the following conditions occur, the front air bag, side air bag, curtain air bag, and pretensioner systems need servicing and your vehicle must be taken to a NISSAN dealer: ● The supplemental air bag warning light remains on after approximately 7 seconds. ● The supplemental air bag warning light flashes intermittently. ● The supplemental air bag warning light does not come on at all. Unless checked and repaired, the supplemental restraint system (air bag system) and/or the pretensioners may not function properly. For additional details see “Supplemental restraint system” in the “Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system” section of this manual. 2-14 Instruments and controls WARNING If the supplemental air bag warning light is on, it could mean that the front air bag, side air bag, curtain air bag systems and/or pretensioner systems will not operate in an accident. To help avoid injury to yourself or others, have your vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as possible. INDICATOR LIGHTS Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) position indicator light (CVT models) When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, this indicator light shows the shift selector position. See “Driving the vehicle” in the “Starting and driving” section of this manual. Cruise main switch indicator light (if so equipped) The light comes on when the cruise control main switch is pushed. The light goes out when the main switch is pushed again. When the cruise main switch indicator light comes on, the cruise control system is operational. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Cruise set switch indicator light (if so equipped) The light comes on while the vehicle speed is controlled by the cruise control system. If the light blinks while the engine is running, it may indicate the cruise control system is not functioning properly. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer. or Front passenger air bag status light The front passenger air bag status light ( or ) will be lit and the passenger front air bag will be OFF depending on how the front passenger seat is being used. For front passenger air bag status light operation, see “Front passenger air bag and status light” in the “Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system” section of this manual. High beam indicator light (blue) This blue light comes on when the headlight high beams are on and goes out when the low beams are selected. The high beam indicator light also comes on when the passing signal is activated. Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) If this indicator light comes on steady or blinks while the engine is running, it may indicate a potential emission control malfunction. The Malfunction Indicator Light may also come on steady if the fuel-filler cap is loose or missing, or if the vehicle runs out of fuel. Check to make sure the fuel-filler cap is installed and closed tightly, and that the vehicle has at least 3 gallons (11.4 liters) of fuel in the fuel tank. light should After a few driving trips, the turn off if no other potential emission control system malfunction exists. If this indicator light comes on steady for 20 seconds and then blinks for 10 seconds when the engine is not running, it indicates that the vehicle is not ready for an emission control system inspection/maintenance test. See “Readiness for inspection/maintenance (I/M) test” in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual. Operation The Malfunction Indicator Light will come on in one of two ways: ● Malfunction Indicator Light on steady — An emission control system malfunction has been detected. Check the fuel-filler cap. If the fuel-filler cap is loose or missing, tighten or install the cap and continue to drive the light should turn off after vehicle. The light does not a few driving trips. If the turn off after a few driving trips, have the vehicle inspected by a NISSAN dealer. You do not need to have your vehicle towed to the dealer. ● Malfunction Indicator Light blinking — An engine misfire has been detected which may damage the emission control system. To reduce or avoid emission control system damage: – do not drive at speeds above 45 MPH (72 km/h). – avoid hard acceleration or deceleration. – avoid steep uphill grades. – if possible, reduce the amount of cargo being hauled or towed. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : The Malfunction Indicator Light may stop blinking and come on steady. Have the vehicle inspected by a NISSAN dealer. You do not need to have your vehicle towed to the dealer. CAUTION Continued vehicle operation without having the emission control system checked and repaired as necessary could lead to poor driveability, reduced fuel economy, and possible damage to the emission control system. Overdrive off indicator light (CVT models) The overdrive off indicator light illuminates when the overdrive off mode is selected. For additional information, see “Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT)” in the “Starting and driving” section of this manual. Security indicator light For vehicles without Intelligent Key: This light blinks whenever the ignition switch is placed in the LOCK, OFF or ACC position. Instruments and controls 2-15 For vehicles with Intelligent Key: This light blinks when the ignition switch is placed in the LOCK position with the key removed from the ignition switch. The blinking security indicator light indicates that the security systems equipped on the vehicle are operational. For additional information, see “Security systems” later in this section. Side light and headlight indicator light (green) The side light and headlight indicator light illuminates when the side light or headlight position is selected. See “Headlight and turn signal switch” later in this section for further details. Slip indicator light (if so equipped) This indicator will blink when the VDC system is operating, thus alerting the driver to the fact that the road surface is slippery and the vehicle is nearing its traction limits. You may feel or hear the system working; this is normal. The light will blink for a few seconds after the VDC system stops limiting wheel spin. 2-16 Instruments and controls indicator light also comes on when The you place the ignition switch in the ON position. The light will turn off after approximately 2 seconds if the system is operational. If the light does not come on have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer. Turn signal/hazard indicator lights The appropriate light flashes when the turn signal switch is activated. Both lights flash when the hazard switch is turned on. Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF indicator light (if so equipped) This indicator light comes on when the Vehicle Dynamic Control off switch is pushed to OFF. This indicates the Vehicle Dynamic Control system is not operating. Push the Vehicle Dynamic Control off switch again or restart the engine and the system will operate normally. See “Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system” in the “Starting and driving” section of this manual. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : The Vehicle Dynamic Control light also comes on when you place the ignition switch in the ON position. The light will turn off after about 2 seconds if the system is operational. If the light stays on or comes on along with the SLIP indicator light while you are driving, have the Vehicle Dynamic Control system checked by a NISSAN dealer. While the Vehicle Dynamic Control system is operating, you might feel slight vibration or hear the system working when starting the vehicle or accelerating, but this is normal. AUDIBLE REMINDERS Brake pad wear warning The disc brake pads have audible wear warnings. When a disc brake pad requires replacement, it makes a high pitched scraping sound when the vehicle is in motion, whether or not the brake pedal is depressed. Have the brakes checked as soon as possible if the warning sound is heard. Key reminder chime A chime sounds if the driver’s door is opened while the key is left in the ignition switch. Remove the key and take it with you when leaving the vehicle. SECURITY SYSTEMS Light reminder chime Parking brake reminder chime With the ignition switch placed in the OFF position, a chime sounds when the driver’s door is opened if the headlights or parking lights are on. A chime sounds if the parking brake is set and the vehicle is driven. The chime will stop if the parking brake is released or the vehicle speed returns to zero. Turn the headlight control switch off before leaving the vehicle. NISSAN Intelligent Key™ door buzzer (if so equipped) The Intelligent Key door buzzer sounds if any one of the following improper operations is found. ● The ignition switch is not returned to the LOCK position when locking the doors. LIC0301 Your vehicle may have two types of security systems: ● The Intelligent Key is left inside the vehicle when locking the doors. ● Vehicle security system (if so equipped) ● The Intelligent Key is taken outside the vehicle when operating the vehicle. ● NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System VEHICLE SECURITY SYSTEM (if so equipped) ● Any doors are not closed securely when locking the doors. When the buzzer sounds, be sure to check both the vehicle and the Intelligent Key. See “NISSAN Intelligent Key™” in the “Pre-driving checks and adjustments” section. The vehicle security system provides visual and audible alarm signals if someone opens the doors when the system is armed. It is not, however, a motion detection type system that activates when a vehicle is moved or when a vibration occurs. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Instruments and controls 2-17 The system helps deter vehicle theft but cannot prevent it, nor can it prevent the theft of interior or exterior vehicle components in all situations. Always secure your vehicle even if parking for a brief period. Never leave your keys in the ignition, and always lock the vehicle when unattended. Be aware of your surroundings, and park in secure, well-lit areas whenever possible. Many devices offering additional protection, such as component locks, identification markers, and tracking systems, are available at auto supply stores and specialty shops. Your NISSAN dealer may also offer such equipment. Check with your insurance company to see if you may be eligible for discounts for various theft protection features. How to arm the vehicle security system 1. Close all windows. (The system can be armed even if the windows are open.) 2. Place the ignition switch in the LOCK position and remove the key. 3. Close all doors. Lock all doors. The doors can be locked with: ● the power door lock switch (if the door is opened, locked and then closed). ● the key — master or mechanical (Intelligent Key models). 2-18 Instruments and controls ● any request switch (Intelligent Key models). ● the keyfob or Intelligent Key. Keyfob and Intelligent Key operation: button. All doors lock. ● Push the The hazard lights flash twice and the horn beeps once to indicate all doors are locked. button is pushed with ● When the all doors locked, the hazard lights flash twice and the horn beeps once as a reminder that the doors are already locked. The horn may or may not beep. Refer to “Silencing the horn beep feature” in the “Pre-driving checks and adjustments” section later in this manual. indicator light comes 4. Confirm that the light stays on for about 30 on. The seconds. The vehicle security system is now pre-armed. After about 30 seconds the vehicle security system automatically shifts light begins into the armed phase. The to flash once every 3 seconds. If, during the 30-second pre-arm time period, the driver’s door is unlocked by the key, a request switch, the keyfob or Intelligent Key, or if the I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ignition switch is placed in the ACC or ON position, the system will not arm. ● If the key is turned slowly when locking the driver’s door, the system may not arm. Furthermore, if the key is turned beyond the vertical position toward the unlock position to remove the key, the system may be disarmed when the key is removed. If the indicator light fails to glow for 30 seconds, unlock the door once and lock it again. ● Even when the driver and/or passengers are in the vehicle, the system will arm with all doors closed and locked with the ignition switch placed in the OFF position. Vehicle security system activation The vehicle security system will give the following alarm: ● The headlights blink and the horn sounds intermittently. ● The alarm automatically turns off after approximately 50 seconds. However, the alarm reactivates if the vehicle is tampered with again. The alarm can be shut off by unlocking the driver’s door with the key, a request button on switch or by pressing the the keyfob or Intelligent Key. The alarm is activated by: ● opening a door without using the key, a request switch, keyfob or Intelligent Key (even if the door is unlocked by using the inside lock knob or the power door lock switch). How to stop an activated alarm The alarm stops only by unlocking the driver’s door with the key, pressing the button on the keyfob or Intelligent Key, or by unlocking all doors with any request switch (Intelligent Key models). NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM The NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System will not allow the engine to start without the use of a registered key. If the engine fails to start using a registered key (for example, when interference is caused by another registered key, an automated toll road device or automatic payment device on the key ring), restart the engine using the following procedures: 1. Leave the ignition switch placed in the ON position for approximately 5 seconds. 2. Place the ignition switch in the OFF or LOCK position and wait approximately 10 seconds. 3. Repeat steps 1 and 2. 4. Restart the engine while holding the device (which may have caused the interference) separate from the registered key. This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules and RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions; (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. CHANGES OR MODIFICATIONS NOT EXPRESSLY APPROVED BY THE PARTY RESPONSIBLE FOR COMPLIANCE COULD VOID THE USER’S AUTHORITY TO OPERATE THE EQUIPMENT. If the no start condition re-occurs, NISSAN recommends placing the registered key on a separate key ring to avoid interference from other devices. Statement related to Section 15 of FCC Rules for NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System (CONT ASSY — IMMOBILIZER, ANT ASSY — IMMOBILIZER) I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Instruments and controls 2-19 WINDSHIELD WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH If the light still remains on and/or the engine will not start, see a NISSAN dealer for NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System service as soon as possible. Please bring all registered keys that you have when visiting your NISSAN dealer for service. LIC0474 WIC0854 Security indicator light SWITCH OPERATION For vehicles without Intelligent Key: This light blinks whenever the ignition switch is placed in the LOCK, OFF or ACC position. The windshield wiper and washer operates when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position. Push the lever down to operate the wiper at the following speed: For vehicles with Intelligent Key: This light blinks when the ignition switch is placed in the LOCK position with the key removed from the ignition switch. 1 䊊 This function indicates the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System is operational. If the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System is malfunctioning, the light will remain on while the ignition switch is placed in the ON position. 2-20 Instruments and controls 2 䊊 3 䊊 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Intermittent (INT) — intermittent operation can be adjusted by turning the knob toward A (Slower) or 䊊 B (Faster). 䊊 Low (LO) — continuous low speed operation High (HI) — continuous high speed operation 4 to have one sweep operaPush the lever up 䊊 tion (MIST) of the wiper. 5 to operate the Pull the lever toward you 䊊 washer. The wiper will also operate several times. WARNING In freezing temperatures the washer solution may freeze on the windshield and obscure your vision which may lead to an accident. Warm the windshield with the defroster before you wash the windshield. REAR WINDOW AND OUTSIDE MIRROR (if so equipped) DEFROSTER SWITCH ● Pre-mix windshield-washer fluid concentrates with water to the manufacturer’s recommended levels before pouring the fluid into the windshield-washer fluid reservoir tank. Do not use the windshield-washer fluid reservoir tank to mix the windshield-washer fluid concentrate and water. CAUTION LIC0720 ● Do not operate the washer continuously for more than 30 seconds. To defrost the rear window glass and outside mirrors (if so equipped), start the engine and push the rear window defroster switch on. The rear window defroster indicator light on the switch comes on. Push the switch again to turn the defroster off. ● Do not operate the washer if the reservoir tank is empty. ● Do not fill the windshield-washer fluid reservoir tank with windshield-washer fluid concentrates at full strength. Some methyl alcohol based windsheild-washer fluid concentrates may permanently stain the grille if spilled while filling the windshieldwasher fluid reservoir tank. The rear window defroster automatically turns off after approximately 15 minutes. CAUTION When cleaning the inner side of the rear window, be careful not to scratch or damage the rear window defroster. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Instruments and controls 2-21 HEADLIGHT AND TURN SIGNAL SWITCH LIC0706 Type A HEADLIGHT CONTROL SWITCH Lighting 1 䊊 䊊 2 When turning the switch to the position, the front parking, tail, license plate and instrument panel lights come on. LIC0688 Headlight beam select CAUTION 1 䊊 Use the headlights with the engine running to avoid discharging the vehicle battery. When turning the switch to the position, the headlights come on and all the other lights remain on. 2-22 Instruments and controls WIC0859 Type B 2 䊊 3 䊊 To select the high beam function, push the lever forward. The high beam lights come on light illuminates. and the Pull the lever back to select the low beam. Pulling and releasing the lever flashes the headlight high beams on and off. Battery saver system I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : If the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position while the headlight switch is in the or position, the headlights will turn off after 5 minutes. CAUTION Even though the battery saver feature automatically turns off the headlights after a period of time, you should turn the headlight switch to the OFF position when the engine is not running to avoid discharging the vehicle battery. WARNING When the daytime running light system is active, tail lights on your vehicle are not on. It is necessary at dusk to turn on your headlights. Failure to do so could cause an accident injuring yourself and others. DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM (Canada only) The headlights automatically illuminate at a reduced intensity when the engine is started with the parking brake released. The daytime running lights operate with the headlight switch in the position. Turn the OFF position or in the position for full headlight switch to the illumination when driving at night. WIC1294 INSTRUMENT BRIGHTNESS CONTROL The instrument brightness control operates when the headlight control switch is in the or position and the ignition switch is placed in the ON position. If the parking brake is applied before the engine is started, the daytime running lights do not illuminate. The daytime running lights illuminate when the parking brake is released. The daytime running lights will remain on until the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position. The brightness level will be shown briefly in the meter’s display area whenever the control is operated. Turn the control to adjust the brightness of instrument panel lights when driving at night. When the maximum or minimum intensity is met, a short chime will sound. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Instruments and controls 2-23 HAZARD WARNING FLASHER SWITCH WIC0861 LIC0394 TURN SIGNAL SWITCH WIC0860 FOG LIGHT SWITCH (if so equipped) Turn signal To turn the fog lights on, turn the headlight switch to the position, then turn the fog light switch to the position. Push the switch on to warn other drivers when you must stop or park under emergency conditions. All turn signal lights flash. 1 䊊 Move the lever up or down to signal the turning direction. When the turn is completed, the turn signals cancel automatically. Lane change signal 2 䊊 To signal a lane change, move the lever up or down to the point where the indicator light begins to flash, but the lever does not latch. WARNING To turn the fog lights off, turn the fog light switch to the OFF position. ● If stopping for an emergency, be sure to move the vehicle well off the road. The headlights must be on and the low beams selected for the fog lights to operate. The fog lights automatically turn off when the high beam headlights are selected. ● Do not use the hazard warning flashers while moving on the highway unless unusual circumstances force you to drive so slowly that your vehicle might become a hazard to other traffic. ● Turn signals do not work when the hazard warning flasher lights are on. 2-24 Instruments and controls I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : HORN VEHICLE DYNAMIC CONTROL (VDC) OFF SWITCH (if so equipped) The flashers will operate with the ignition switch placed in any position. Some state laws may prohibit the use of the hazard warning flasher switch while driving. WIC1324 WIC0534 To sound the horn, push the top portion of the steering wheel’s center pad. The vehicle should be driven with the Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system on for most driving conditions. If the vehicle is stuck in mud or snow, the VDC system reduces the engine output to reduce wheel spin. The engine speed will be reduced even if the accelerator is depressed to the floor. If maximum engine power is needed to free a stuck vehicle, turn the VDC system off. To turn off the VDC system, push the VDC OFF indicator will come on. switch. The Push the VDC OFF switch again or restart the engine to turn on the system. See “Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system” in the “Starting and driving” section. WARNING Do not disassemble the horn. Doing so could affect proper operation of the supplemental front air bag system. Tampering with the supplemental front air bag system may result in serious personal injury. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Instruments and controls 2-25 HEATED SEAT (if so equipped) POWER OUTLET CAUTION ● Do not use the seat heater for extended periods or when no one is using the seat. ● Do not put anything on the seat which insulates heat, such as a blanket, cushion, seat cover, etc. Otherwise, the seat may become overheated. ● Do not place anything hard or heavy on the seat or pierce it with a pin or similar object. This may result in damage to the heater. WIC1441 The front seats are warmed by built-in heaters. 1. Start the engine. 2. Push the low or high position of the switch, as desired, depending on the temperature. The indicator light in the switch will illuminate. The heater is controlled by a thermostat, automatically turning the heater on and off. The indicator light will remain on as long as the switch is on. 3. When the seat is warmed or before you leave the vehicle, be sure to turn the switch off. 2-26 Instruments and controls ● Any liquid spilled on the heated seat should be removed immediately with a dry cloth. ● When cleaning the seat, never use gasoline, benzine, thinner, or any similar materials. ● If any abnormalities are found or the heated seat does not operate, turn the switch off and have the system checked by your NISSAN dealer. ● The battery could run down if the seat heater is operated while the engine is not running. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : LIC1022 Instrument panel The power outlets are for powering electrical accessories such as cellular telephones. They are rated at 12 Volt, 120W (10A) maximum. The power outlet located on the bottom center portion of the instrument panel is powered directly by the vehicle’s battery. The power outlet located in the console (if so equipped) is powered only when the ignition switch is placed in the ACC or ON position. STORAGE ● Avoid using power outlets when the air conditioner, headlights or rear window defroster is on. ● Before inserting or disconnecting a plug, be sure the electrical accessory being used is turned OFF. ● Push the plug in as far as it will go. If good contact is not made, the plug may overheat or the internal temperature fuse may open. LIC1478 ● When not in use, be sure to close the cap. Do not allow water to contact the outlet. Console (if so equipped) LIC1023 MAP POCKETS CAUTION ● The outlet and plug may be hot during or immediately after use. ● The power outlets are not designed for use with a cigarette lighter. ● Do not use with accessories that exceed a 12 volt, 120W (10A) power draw. Do not use double adapters or more than one electrical accessory. ● Use power outlets with the engine running to avoid discharging the vehicle battery. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Instruments and controls 2-27 LIC1025 STORAGE BIN WIC1036 STORAGE TRAYS Pull the lid down to open the storage bin. Some models are equipped with a soft lining in the storage bin for storing sunglasses. WARNING WARNING Do not place sharp objects in the trays to help prevent injury in an accident or sudden stop. LIC1024 Keep the storage bin closed while driving to prevent an accident. INSTRUMENT PANEL STORAGE (if so equipped) To open the storage tray, push and release. The storage tray will automatically move to the open position. 2-28 Instruments and controls I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ● The inside of the storage tray can get hot. Do not place objects inside which can melt or be easily deformed. WARNING Keep the tray lid closed while driving to help prevent contents from becoming projectiles causing injury in an accident or during a sudden stop. LIC1116 Type A LIC1328 Type B SEATBACK POCKETS (if so equipped) The seatback pockets are located on the back of the driver’s and passenger’s seats. The pockets can be used to store maps. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Instruments and controls 2-29 CAUTION ● Avoid abrupt starting and braking when the cup holder is being used to prevent spilling the drink. If the liquid is hot, it can scald you or your passenger. ● Use only soft cups in the cup holder. Hard objects can injure you in an accident. WIC1531 WIC1097 Rear (if so equipped) Lower the rear center armrest to access the cup holders. Front CUP HOLDERS Adjust the cup holder size by turning the adjustment knob and sliding the cup holder divider to the desired position. 2-30 Instruments and controls I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : The trunk divider allows for the creation of a hidden storage compartment in the trunk or when lowered, a temporary storage surface for wet items. The trunk divider can be accessed through the lowering of the rear seats or through the trunk. WIC1487 GLOVE BOX WIC1504 CONSOLE BOX Open the glove box by pulling the handle. WARNING Keep glove box lid closed while driving to help prevent injury in an accident or a sudden stop. 1 To open the console box, press in on the lever 䊊 2 . and raise the lid 䊊 To close, push the lid down until the lock latches. TRUNK DIVIDER (if so equipped) CAUTION The trunk divider does not contain any secure locking mechanisms so it should not be used as a secure storage for valuables. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Instruments and controls 2-31 LIC1030 Accessing through rear seats Once the rear seats have been lowered, the trunk divider can be opened by pressing down on the securing latch and pushing the divider toward the rear of the vehicle. For more information on the lowering of rear seats, see “Interior trunk access” in the “Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system” section of this manual. LIC1031 Accessing through trunk Access the trunk divider by opening the trunk. To remove the trunk divider, press down on securing 1 and lower the trunk divider to about 45°. latch 䊊 Pull and lift the divider out of the holding brackets 2 to remove from the trunk. 䊊 WIC1032 CARGO NET (if so equipped) WARNING ● Properly secure all cargo with ropes or straps to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. In a sudden stop or collision, unsecured cargo could cause personal injury. ● Be sure to secure all four hooks into the retainers. The cargo restrained in the net must not exceed 30 lbs. (13.6 kg) or the net may not stay secured. 2-32 Instruments and controls I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : The cargo net helps keep packages in the cargo area from moving around while the vehicle is in motion. LIC0802 To install the cargo net, attach the net to the retainers. To remove the cargo net, detach the net from the cargo net retainers. LIC0748 GROCERY HOOKS (if so equipped) The grocery hooks are located in the trunk and can be used to hang a standard size plastic grocery bag. CAUTION Do not apply a total load of more than 20 lbs (9 kg) to a single grocery hook. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Instruments and controls 2-33 WINDOWS POWER WINDOWS (if so equipped) Driver’s side power window switch The driver’s side control panel is equipped with switches to open or close the front and rear passenger windows. WARNING ● Make sure that all passengers have their hands, etc. inside the vehicle while it is in motion and before closing the windows. Use the window lock switch to prevent unexpected use of the power windows. ● Do not leave children unattended inside the vehicle. They could unknowingly activate switches or controls and become trapped in a window. Unattended children could become involved in serious accidents. The power windows operate when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, or for about 45 seconds after the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position. If the driver’s or passenger’s door is opened during this period of about 45 seconds, power to the windows is canceled. 2-34 Instruments and controls To open a window, push the switch to the first detent and continue to hold it down until the desired window position is reached. To close a window, pull the switch to the first detent and continue to hold up until the desired window position is reached. WIC1100 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Window lock button Power door lock switch Front passenger’s side window switch Right rear passenger’s window switch Left rear passenger’s window switch Driver’s side automatic switch I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : WIC1129 Front passenger’s power window switch The passenger’s window switch operates only the corresponding passenger’s window. To open the window, push the switch to the first detent and continue to hold it down until the desired 1 . To close the window position is reached 䊊 window, pull the switch to the first detent and continue to hold it up until the desired window 2 . position is reached 䊊 LIC0718 LIC0410 Rear power window switch Automatic operation The rear power window switches open or close only the corresponding windows. To open the 1 . To window, push the switch and hold it down 䊊 2 . close the window, pull the switch up 䊊 To fully open a window equipped with automatic operation, press the window switch down to the second detent and release it; it need not be held. The window automatically opens all the way. To stop the window, lift the switch up while the window is opening. Locking passengers’ windows When the window lock button is depressed, only the driver’s side window can be opened or closed. Push it again to cancel the window lock function. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : To fully close a window equipped with automatic operation, pull the switch up to the second detent and release it; it need not be held. The window automatically closes all the way. To stop the window, press the switch down while the window is closing. Instruments and controls 2-35 Auto-reverse function The auto-reverse function can be activated when a window is closed by automatic operation. Depending on the environment or driving conditions, the auto-reverse function may be activated if an impact or load similar to something being caught in the window occurs. WARNING There are some small distances immediately before the closed position which cannot be detected. Make sure that all passengers have their hands, etc., inside the vehicle before closing the window. If the vehicle’s battery is disconnected, replaced, or jump started, the power window auto-reverse function may not operate properly. If this occurs, please contact the dealer to re-initialize the power window auto-reverse system. If the control unit detects something caught in a window equipped with automatic operation as it is closing, the window will be immediately lowered. 2-36 Instruments and controls When the automatic operation for the driver’s power window switch does not operate If the automatic operation for the driver’s power window switch does not operate properly, perform the following procedure to initialize the power window switch. 1. Place the ignition switch in the ON position. 2. Press and hold the driver’s window switch down until the window opens completely. 3. Release the switch. 4. Pull and hold the driver’s window switch up to the second detent until the window glass has reached the full close position. Continue to hold the window switch in the up position for 5 seconds after the window glass has reached the full close position. (It is necessary for this entire step to be completed with one continuous pull of the window switch.) 5. Release the switch. Initialization is now complete. The automatic operation for the driver’s power window switch should now operate. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : If the automatic operation does not operate properly after performing the above procedure, see a NISSAN dealer for assistance. No initialization is required for all the other window switches. MOONROOF (if so equipped) Sliding the moonroof To open the moonroof, push and hold the switch toward DOWN/OPEN. The moonroof will stop when the switch is released or when the moonroof is fully open. To close the moonroof, push and hold the switch toward UP/CLOSE. The moonroof will stop when the switch is released or when the moonroof is fully closed. Tilting the moonroof WIC0263 WIC1482 MANUAL WINDOWS (if so equipped) ELECTRIC MOONROOF The side windows can be opened or closed by turning the hand crank on each door. This moonroof only operates with the ignition switch placed in the ON position. NOTE: If the battery is discharged or is disconnected, the moonroof may not operate correctly, and must be reset. Close the moonroof by pushing and holding the switch toward UP/CLOSE. Release the switch, then push and hold the UP/CLOSE switch to tilt the moonroof up. The moonroof will stop when the switch is released or when the moonroof reaches the maximum tilt position. To tilt the moonroof down, push and hold the switch toward DOWN/OPEN. The moonroof will stop when the switch is released or when the moonroof is fully closed. See “Resetting the moonroof switch” later in this section. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Instruments and controls 2-37 WARNING ● In an accident you could be thrown from the vehicle through an open moonroof. Always use seat belts and child restraints. ● Do not allow anyone to stand up or extend any portion of their body out of the moonroof opening while the vehicle is in motion or while the moonroof is closing. CAUTION ● Remove water drops, snow, ice or sand from the moonroof before opening. ● Do not place heavy objects on the moonroof or surrounding area. Resetting the moonroof switch The moonroof switch may not operate properly and may need to be reset if any of the following conditions have occurred: ● the battery terminal has been disconnected, ● the moonroof has been manually moved, ● the moonroof motor has been removed and reinstalled after the moonroof has been repositioned or adjusted, 2-38 Instruments and controls ● the moonroof glass panel has been adjusted or changed, or ● the electrical supply interrupted and/or some malfunction has been detected. Use the following reset procedure to return moonroof operation to normal. 1. Press the UP/CLOSE side of the moonroof switch, until it stops and then release the switch. 2. Push and hold the UP/CLOSE side of the moonroof switch. The moonroof panel will begin to move in about 10 seconds. 3. Continue to hold the UP/CLOSE side of the moonroof switch while the panel moves in a jogging motion to the full tilt position. When the panel reaches the full tilt position it will back up a little and stop. 4. Release the UP/CLOSE side of the moonroof switch. 5. Within 5 seconds of completing step 4, press and continuously hold the UP/CLOSE side of the moonroof switch. After a delay of 5 seconds, the panel will move from the tilt position to the open position and back to the close position. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 6. Release the UP/CLOSE side of the moonroof switch. Do not disconnect the power for at least 2 seconds. The moonroof is now restarted. NOTE: If the UP/CLOSE side of the moonroof switch is released anytime during the restarting process, all learned profile data will be discarded and the procedure will have to be started over. If the moonroof still does not operate properly, have the moonroof system checked, and if necessary repaired, by a NISSAN dealer. Auto-reverse function (when closing or tilting down the moonroof) The auto-reverse function can be activated when the moonroof is closed or tilted down by automatic operation when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position or for about 45 seconds after the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position. Depending on the environment or driving conditions, the auto-reverse function may be activated if an impact or load similar to something being caught in the moonroof occurs. INTERIOR LIGHT WARNING There are some small distances immediately before the closed position which cannot be detected. Make sure that all passengers have their hands, etc., inside the vehicle before closing the moonroof. When closing: If the control unit detects something caught in the moonroof as it moves to the front, the moonroof will immediately open backward. WARNING ● In an accident you could be thrown from the vehicle through an open moonroof. Always use seat belts and child restraints. ● Do not allow anyone to stand up or extend any portion of their body out of the moonroof opening while the vehicle is in motion or while the moonroof is closing. CAUTION When tilting down: If the control unit detects something caught in the moonroof as it tilts down, the moonroof will immediately tilt up. If the auto-reverse function malfunctions and repeats opening or tilting up the moonroof, keep pushing the tilt down switch within 5 seconds after it happens; the moonroof will fully close gradually. Make sure nothing is caught in the moonroof. ● Remove water drops, snow, ice or sand from the moonroof before opening. WIC0264 ● Do not place heavy objects on the moonroof or surrounding area. The interior light has a three-position switch and operates regardless of ignition switch position. Sunshade Open and close the sunshade by sliding it forward or backward. 1 , the When the switch is in the ON position 䊊 interior light illuminates, regardless of door position. If the moonroof does not close When the switch is in the center O position, the interior light illuminates by opening a door. Have your NISSAN dealer check and repair the moonroof. The interior light will stay on for about 30 seconds when: ● The doors are unlocked while the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position and all doors are closed. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Instruments and controls 2-39 MAP LIGHTS (if so equipped) ● The driver’s door is opened and then closed while the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position. ● The ignition switch is placed in the OFF position while all doors are closed. The interior light will turn off while the 30 second timer is activated when: ● The driver’s door is locked by the keyfob, a key or the lock-unlock switch. ● The ignition switch is placed in the ON position. 2 , the When the switch is in the OFF position 䊊 interior light does not illuminate, regardless of door position. NOTE: If the interior lights are turned off automatically by the battery saver feature, the ignition switch must be placed in the ON position before the interior lights will illuminate again. For information regarding the interior light bulb replacement, refer to “Exterior and interior lights” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual. CAUTION Do not use for extended periods of time with the engine stopped. This could result in a discharged battery. Some vehicles are equipped with a battery saver feature that will automatically turn off the interior lights after approximately 10 minutes if: CAUTION Do not use for extended periods of time with the engine stopped. This could result in a discharged battery. ● doors are open, or ● the interior light switch is in the ON position. 2-40 Instruments and controls WIC1540 To turn the map lights on, press the button. To turn them off, press the button again. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : TRUNK LIGHT The light illuminates when the trunk lid is opened. When the trunk lid is closed, the light goes off. For bulb replacement procedures, refer to “Exterior and interior lights” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Instruments and controls 2-41 MEMO 2-42 Instruments and controls I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 3 Pre-driving checks and adjustments Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2 NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System keys . . . . . . . . . 3-2 NISSAN Intelligent Key™ (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . 3-3 Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4 Locking with key. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5 Locking with inside lock knob . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5 Locking with power door lock switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6 Automatic door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6 Child safety rear door lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7 Remote keyless entry system (models without NISSAN Intelligent Key™) (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7 How to use remote keyless entry system . . . . . . . . . . 3-8 NISSAN Intelligent Key™ (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11 Operating range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13 Door locks/unlocks precaution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13 NISSAN Intelligent Key™ Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14 How to use the remote keyless entry function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17 Warning lights and audible reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20 Warning signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-21 Troubleshooting guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22 Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23 Trunk lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23 Trunk lid release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24 Key operation (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24 Interior trunk lid release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24 Fuel-filler door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25 Opener operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25 Fuel-filler cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25 Steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27 Tilt operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27 Sun visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27 Vanity mirrors (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27 Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28 Rearview mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28 Outside mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : KEYS from. If you still have a key, your NISSAN dealer can duplicate it. NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM KEYS You can only drive your vehicle using the master keys which are registered to the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System components in your vehicle. These keys have a transponder chip in the key head. The master key can be used for all the locks. Never leave these keys in the vehicle. LPD0348 1. 2. 3. Two master keys (black) with transponder chip and chrome NISSAN brand symbol on one side Transponder chip Key number plate A key number plate is supplied with your keys. Record the key number and keep it in a safe place (such as your wallet), not in the vehicle. If you lose your keys, see a NISSAN dealer for duplicates by using the key number. NISSAN does not record key numbers so it is very important to keep track of your key number plate. A key number is only necessary when you have lost all keys and do not have one to duplicate 3-2 Pre-driving checks and adjustments Additional or replacement keys: If you still have a key, the key number is not necessary when you need extra NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System keys. Your dealer can duplicate your existing key. As many as 5 NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System keys can be used with one vehicle. You should bring all NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System keys that you have to your NISSAN dealer for registration. This is because the registration process will erase the memory of all key codes previously registered into the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System. After the registration process, these components will only recognize keys coded into the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System during registration. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Any key that is not given to your dealer at the time of registration will no longer be able to start your vehicle. Do not allow the immobilizer system key, which contains an electrical transponder, to come into contact with salt water. This could affect system function. Never leave these keys in the vehicle. As many as 4 Intelligent Keys can be registered and used with one vehicle. The new keys must be registered by a NISSAN dealer prior to use with the Intelligent Key and NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System of your vehicle. Since the registration process requires erasing all memory in the Intelligent Key components when registering new keys, be sure to take all Intelligent Keys that you have to the NISSAN dealer. CAUTION WPD0363 1. 2. 3. Two Intelligent Keys Mechanical keys (inside Intelligent Keys) Key number plate NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY™ (if so equipped) Your vehicle can only be driven with the Intelligent Keys which are registered to your vehicle’s Intelligent Key components and NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System components. Listed below are conditions or occurrences which will damage the Intelligent Key: ● Do not allow the Intelligent Key, which contains electrical components, to come into contact with water or salt water. This could affect the system function. ● Wetting may damage the Intelligent Key. If the Intelligent Key gets wet, immediately wipe until it is completely dry. ● Do not place the Intelligent Key for an extended period in an area where temperatures exceed 140°F (60°C). ● Do not attach the Intelligent Key with a key holder that contains a magnet. ● Do not place the Intelligent Key near equipment that produces a magnetic field, such as a TV, audio equipment and personal computers. If an Intelligent Key is lost or stolen, NISSAN recommends erasing the ID code of that Intelligent Key from the vehicle. This may prevent the unauthorized use of the Intelligent Key to operate the vehicle. For information regarding the erasing procedure, contact a NISSAN dealer. ● Do not drop the Intelligent Key. ● Do not strike the Intelligent Key sharply against another object. ● Do not change or modify the Intelligent Key. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-3 DOORS CAUTION Always carry the mechanical key installed in the Intelligent Key slot. See “Doors” in this section and “Storage” in the “Instruments and Controls” section of this manual. SPA1951 Mechanical key WARNING ● Always have the doors locked while driving. Along with the use of seat belts, this provides greater safety in the event of an accident by helping to prevent persons from being thrown from the vehicle. This also helps keep children and others from unintentionally opening the doors, and will help keep out intruders. ● Before opening any door, always look for and avoid oncoming traffic. The Intelligent Key contains the mechanical key, which can be used in case of a discharged battery. ● Do not leave children unattended inside the vehicle. They could unknowingly activate switches or controls. Unattended children could become involved in serious accidents. To remove the mechanical key, release the lock knob on the back of the Intelligent Key. To install the mechanical key, firmly insert it into the Intelligent Key until the lock knob returns to the lock position. The mechanical key can be used for operation in the same way as an ordinary key. 3-4 Pre-driving checks and adjustments When the doors are locked using one of the following methods, the doors can not be opened using the inside or outside door handles. The doors must be unlocked to open the doors. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : LPD0349 Driver’s side LOCKING WITH KEY Manual (if so equipped) To lock a door, turn the key toward the front of the 1 . To unlock, turn the key toward the rear vehicle 䊊 2 . 䊊 WPD0291 LPD0483 Power (if so equipped) The power door lock system allows you to lock or unlock all doors at the same time. 1 of the vehicle Turning the key toward the front 䊊 locks all doors. 2 of the Turning the key one time toward the rear 䊊 vehicle unlocks that door. From that position, 3 (where the key can returning the key to neutral 䊊 only be removed and inserted) and turning it toward the rear again within 5 seconds unlocks 4 . all doors 䊊 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Inside lock LOCKING WITH INSIDE LOCK KNOB To lock the door without the key, move the inside 1 , then close the lock knob to the lock position 䊊 door. To unlock the door without the key, move the 2 . inside lock knob to the unlock position 䊊 Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-5 Lockout protection When the power door lock switch (driver’s or front passenger’s side) is moved to the lock position with the key in the ignition switch and any door open, all doors will lock and then unlock automatically. This helps to prevent the keys from being accidently locked inside the vehicle. AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCKS ● All doors lock automatically when the vehicle speed reaches 15 MPH (24 km/h). WPD0381 Door lock switch LOCKING WITH POWER DOOR LOCK SWITCH To lock all the doors without a key, push the door lock switch (driver’s or front passenger’s side) to 1 . When locking the door this the lock position 䊊 way, be certain not to leave the key inside the vehicle. To unlock all the doors without a key, push the door lock switch (driver’s or front passenger’s 2 . side) to the unlock position 䊊 3-6 Pre-driving checks and adjustments ● All doors unlock automatically when the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position (models with Intelligent Key system) or when the key is removed from the ignition switch (models without Intelligent Key system). The automatic unlock function can be deactivated or activated. To deactivate or activate the automatic door unlock system, perform the following procedure: 1. Close all doors. 2. Place the ignition switch in the ON position. 3. Within 20 seconds of performing Step 2, push and hold the power door lock switch to position (UNLOCK) for more than the 5 seconds. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4. When activated, the hazard indicator will flash twice. When deactivated, the hazard indicator will flash once. 5. The ignition switch must be placed in the OFF and ON position again between each setting change. When the automatic door unlock system is deactivated, the doors do not unlock when the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position (models with Intelligent Key system) or when the key is removed from the ignition switch (models without Intelligent Key system). To unlock the door manually, use the inside lock knob or the power door lock switch (driver’s or front passenger’s side). REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY SYSTEM (models without NISSAN Intelligent Key™) (if so equipped) WARNING ● Radio waves could adversely affect electric medical equipment. Those who use a pacemaker should contact the electric medical equipment manufacturer for the possible influences before use. LIC0716 CHILD SAFETY REAR DOOR LOCK Child safety locks help prevent the rear doors from being opened accidentally, especially when small children are in the vehicle. The child safety lock levers are located on the edge of the rear doors. 1 , the When the lever is in the unlock position 䊊 door can be opened from the outside or the inside. 2 , When the lever is in the lock position 䊊 the door can be opened only from the outside. ● The remote keyless entry keyfob transmits radio waves when the buttons are pressed. The FAA advises radio waves may affect aircraft navigation and communication systems. Do not operate the remote keyless entry keyfob while on an airplane. Make sure the buttons are not operated unintentionally when the unit is stored for a flight. As many as 5 keyfobs can be used with one vehicle. For information concerning the purchase and use of additional keyfobs, contact a NISSAN dealer. The keyfob will not function when: ● the battery is discharged ● the distance between the vehicle and the keyfob is over 33 ft (10 m) The panic alarm will not activate when the key is in the ignition switch. CAUTION Listed below are conditions or occurrences which will damage the keyfob: It is possible to lock/unlock all doors, turn the interior lights on, and activate the panic alarm by using the keyfob from outside the vehicle. ● Do not allow the keyfob, which contains electrical components, to come into contact with water or salt water. This could affect the system function. Be sure to remove the key from the vehicle before locking the doors. ● Do not drop the keyfob. The keyfob can operate at a distance of approximately 33 ft (10 m) from the vehicle. The effective distance depends on the conditions around the vehicle. ● Do not change or modify the keyfob. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ● Do not strike the keyfob sharply against another object. ● Wetting may damage the keyfob. If the keyfob gets wet, immediately wipe until it is completely dry. Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-7 button is pressed with all ● When the doors locked, the hazard lights flash twice and the horn beeps once as a reminder that the doors are already locked. ● Do not place the keyfob for an extended period in an area where temperatures exceed 140°F (60°C). ● Do not attach the keyfob with a key holder that contains a magnet. ● If a door is open and you press the button, the doors will lock but the horn will not beep and the hazard lights will not flash. ● Do not place the keyfob near equipment that produces a magnetic field, such as a TV, audio equipment and personal computers. If a keyfob is lost or stolen, NISSAN recommends erasing the ID code of that keyfob. This will prevent the keyfob from unauthorized use to unlock the vehicle. For information regarding the erasing procedure, please contact a NISSAN dealer. The horn may or may not beep once. Refer to “Silencing the horn beep feature” in this section for details. LPD0209 HOW TO USE REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY SYSTEM Locking doors 1. Close all windows. 2. Remove the key from the ignition switch. 3. Close the hood, trunk lid, and all doors. button on the keyfob. All 4. Press the the doors lock. The hazard lights flash twice and the horn beeps once to indicate all doors are locked. 3-8 Pre-driving checks and adjustments I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : button on the keyfob again Press the within 5 seconds. ● All doors unlock. ● The hazard warning lights flash once if all doors are completely closed. The interior lights can be turned off without waiting 30 seconds by inserting the key into the ignition and turning it to the ON or START position, locking the doors with the keyfob or pushing the interior light switch to the OFF position. Auto relock LPD0210 Unlocking doors Press the button on the keyfob once. ● Only the driver’s door unlocks. ● The hazard warning lights flash once if all doors are completely closed with the ignition switch in any position except the ON position. When the button on the keyfob is pressed, all doors will lock automatically within 1 minute unless one of the following operations is performed: ● Any door is opened. ● A key is inserted into the ignition switch and the switch is cycled from OFF to ON. WPD0319 Releasing the trunk lid (if so equipped) Press the button on the keyfob for longer than 0.5 seconds to open the trunk lid. The trunk release button on the keyfob will not operate when the ignition switch is in the ON position. ● The interior light turns on and the light timer activates for 30 seconds when the switch is in the center O position with the ignition switch in any position except the ON position. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-9 Using the interior light Press the button on the keyfob once to turn on the interior lights. For additional information, refer to “Interior light” in the “Instruments and controls” section in this manual. LPD0211 LPD0262 Using the panic alarm (if so equipped) Silencing the horn beep feature If you are near your vehicle and feel threatened, you may activate the panic alarm to call attention button on the by pressing and holding the keyfob for longer than 0.5 seconds. If desired, the horn beep feature can be deactivated using the keyfob. To deactivate: Press and hold the and buttons for at least 2 seconds. The panic alarm and headlights will stay on for 25 seconds. The hazard warning lights will flash three times to confirm that the horn beep feature has been deactivated. The panic alarm stops when: ● it has run for 25 seconds, or To activate: Press and hold the and buttons for at least 2 seconds once more. ● any button is pressed on the keyfob. 3-10 Pre-driving checks and adjustments I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY™ (if so equipped) The hazard warning lights will flash once and the horn will sound once to confirm that the horn beep feature has been reactivated. Deactivating the horn beep feature does not silence the horn if the alarm is triggered. WARNING ● Radio waves could adversely affect electric medical equipment. Those who use a pacemaker should contact the electric medical equipment manufacturer for the possible influences before use. ● The Intelligent Key transmits radio waves when the buttons are pressed. The FAA advises the radio waves may affect aircraft navigation and communication systems. Do not operate the Intelligent Key while on an airplane. Make sure the buttons are not operated unintentionally when the unit is stored for a flight. CAUTION ● Be sure to carry the Intelligent Key with you when operating the vehicle. ● Never leave the Intelligent Key in the vehicle when you leave the vehicle. The Intelligent Key is always communicating with the vehicle as it receives radio waves. The Intelligent Key transmits weak radio waves. Environmental conditions may interfere with the operation of the Intelligent Key under the following operating conditions: ● When operating near a location where strong radio waves are transmitted, such as a TV tower, power station and broadcasting station. The Intelligent Key can operate all the door locks using the remote controller function or pushing the request switch on the vehicle without taking the key out from a pocket or purse. The operating environment and/or conditions may affect the Intelligent Key operation. ● When in possession of wireless equipment, such as a cellular telephone, transceiver, and CB radio. Be sure to read the following before using the Intelligent Key. ● When any type of radio wave remote control is used nearby. ● When the Intelligent Key is in contact with or covered by metallic materials. ● When the Intelligent Key is placed near an electric appliance such as a personal computer. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-11 ● When the vehicle is parked near a parking meter. Intelligent Key port. Pay special attention that the vehicle battery is not completely discharged. ● Do not attach the Intelligent Key with a key holder that contains a magnet. In such cases, correct the operating conditions before using the Intelligent Key function or use the mechanical key. As many as 4 Intelligent Keys can be registered and used with one vehicle. For information about the purchase and use of additional Intelligent Keys, contact a NISSAN dealer. ● Do not place the Intelligent Key near equipment that produces a magnetic field, such as a TV, audio equipment and personal computers. Although the life of the battery varies depending on the operating conditions, the battery’s life is approximately 2 years. If the battery is discharged, replace it with a new one. When the Intelligent Key battery is low, the Intel) will blink ligent Key system warning light ( green for about 30 seconds after the ignition switch is placed in the ON position. Since the Intelligent Key is continuously receiving radio waves, if the key is left near equipment which transmits strong radio waves, such as signals from a TV and personal computer, the battery life may become shorter. For information regarding replacement of a battery, see “Battery replacement” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section. For models with a steering wheel lock mechanism: Because the steering wheel is locked electrically, unlocking the steering wheel with the ignition switch in the Lock position is impossible when the vehicle battery is completely discharged. Unlocking the steering wheel is impossible even if the Intelligent key is inserted into the 3-12 Pre-driving checks and adjustments CAUTION Listed below are conditions or occurrences which will damage the Intelligent Key: ● Do not allow the Intelligent Key, which contains electrical components, to come into contact with water or salt water. This could affect the system function. ● Do not drop the Intelligent Key. ● Do not strike the Intelligent Key sharply against another object. ● Do not change or modify the Intelligent Key. ● Wetting may damage the Intelligent Key. If the Intelligent Key gets wet, immediately wipe until it is completely dry. ● Do not place the Intelligent Key for an extended period in an area where temperatures exceed 140°F (60°C). I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : If an Intelligent Key is lost or stolen, NISSAN recommends erasing the ID code of that Intelligent Key from the vehicle. This may prevent the unauthorized use of the Intelligent Key to operate the vehicle. For information regarding the erasing procedure, contact a NISSAN dealer. SPA2038 OPERATING RANGE The Intelligent Key functions can only be used when the Intelligent Key is within the specified 1 . operating range from the request switch 䊊 When the Intelligent Key battery is discharged or strong radio waves are present near the operating location, the Intelligent Key operating range becomes narrower, and the Intelligent Key may not function properly. If the Intelligent Key is too close to the door glass, handle or rear bumper, the request switches may not function. When the Intelligent Key is within the operating range, it is possible for anyone, even someone who does not carry the Intelligent Key, to push the request switch to lock/unlock the doors. WPD0375 DOOR LOCKS/UNLOCKS PRECAUTION ● Do not push the door handle request switch with the Intelligent Key held in your hand as illustrated. The close distance to the door handle will cause the Intelligent Key system to have difficulty recognizing that the Intelligent Key is outside the vehicle. ● After locking with the door handle request switch, verify the doors are securely locked by testing them. The operating range is within 31.50 in (80 cm) 1 . from each request switch 䊊 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-13 ● To prevent the Intelligent Key from being left inside the vehicle, make sure you carry the Intelligent Key with you and then lock the doors. ● Do not pull the door handle before pushing the door handle request switch. The door will be unlocked but will not open. Release the door handle once and pull it again to open the door. WPD0376 NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY™ OPERATION You can lock or unlock the doors without taking the Intelligent Key out of your pocket or bag. When you carry the Intelligent Key with you, you can lock or unlock all doors by pushing the door handle request switch within the range of operation. WPD0377 Locking doors 1. Place the ignition switch in the LOCK position. (Remove the key if any key is in the ignition switch.) 2. Close all doors. 1 3. Push any door handle request switch 䊊 while carrying the Intelligent Key with you. 4. All doors and the trunk will lock. 5. The hazard warning lights flash twice and the outside buzzer sounds twice. 3-14 Pre-driving checks and adjustments I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ● Doors do not lock with the door handle request switch with the Intelligent Key inside the vehicle and a beep sounds to warn you. However, when an Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle, doors can be locked with another Intelligent Key. CAUTION ● After locking the doors using the request switch, make sure that the doors have been securely locked by operating the door handles or the trunk opener switch. WPD0369 NOTE: ● Doors lock with the door handle request switch while a mechanical key is in the ignition switch or the ignition switch is pushed in. ● Doors lock with the door handle request switch while the ignition switch is not in the LOCK position. ● Doors do not lock by pushing the door handle request switch while any door is open. However, doors lock with the mechanical key even if any door is open. ● When locking the doors using the request switch, make sure to have the Intelligent Key in your possession before operating the request switch to prevent the Intelligent Key from being left in the vehicle. ● The request switch is operational only when the Intelligent Key has been detected by the Intelligent Key system. Lockout protection To prevent the Intelligent Key from being accidentally locked in the vehicle, lockout protection is equipped with the Intelligent Key. When the driver’s side door is open, the doors are locked, and then the Intelligent Key is put I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : inside the vehicle and all the doors are closed; the lock will automatically unlock and the door buzzer sounds. NOTE: The doors may not lock when the Intelligent Key is in the same hand that is operating the request switch to lock the door. Put the Intelligent Key in a purse, pocket or your other hand. CAUTION The lockout protection may not function under the following conditions: ● When the Intelligent Key is placed on top of the instrument panel. ● When the Intelligent Key is placed on top of the rear parcel shelf. ● When the Intelligent Key is placed inside the glove box or a storage bin. ● When the Intelligent Key is placed inside the door pockets. ● When the Intelligent Key is placed on or under the spare tire area. ● When the Intelligent Key is placed inside or near metallic materials. Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-15 ● Placing the ignition switch in the ON position. ● Locking the doors with the remote controller. ● Switching the room light switch to the OFF position. WPD0377 Unlocking doors 1. Carry the Intelligent Key. 1 . 2. Push the door handle request switch 䊊 3. The hazard warning lights flash once and the outside buzzer sounds once. 1 4. Push the door handle request switch 䊊 again within 60 seconds to unlock all doors. If a door handle is pulled while unlocking the doors, that door may not be unlocked. Returning the door handle to its original position will unlock the door. If the door does not unlock after returning the door handle, push the door handle request switch to unlock the door. 3-16 Pre-driving checks and adjustments WPD0369 All doors will be locked automatically unless one of the following operations is performed within 60 seconds after pushing the request switch. ● Opening any door. ● Pushing the ignition switch. ● Inserting the mechanical key into the ignition switch. The interior light timer illuminates for a maximum of 30 seconds when a door is unlocked and the room light switch is in the DOOR position. The interior light can be turned off without waiting for 30 seconds by performing one of the following operations. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : When all doors are locked and the trunk lid is closed with the Intelligent Key inside the trunk, the outside buzzer will sound and the trunk will open. HOW TO USE THE REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY FUNCTION The remote keyless entry function can operate all door locks using the remote keyless function of the Intelligent Key. The remote keyless function can operate at a distance of 33 ft (10 m) away from the vehicle. The operating distance depends upon the conditions around the vehicle. LPD0478 Opening the trunk lid A for 1. Push the trunk opener request switch 䊊 more than 1 second while carrying the Intelligent Key with you. 2. The trunk will unlatch. A chime will sound 4 times. The remote keyless entry function will not function under the following conditions: ● When the Intelligent Key is not within the operational range. ● When the doors or the trunk are open or not closed securely. ● When the Intelligent Key battery is discharged. 3. Raise the trunk lid to open the trunk. Lockout protection To prevent the Intelligent Key from being accidentally locked in the trunk, lockout protection is equipped with the Intelligent Key. CAUTION When locking the doors using the Intelligent Key, be sure not to leave the key in the vehicle. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : WPD0359 Locking doors 1. Place the ignition switch in the LOCK position. 2. Close all doors. 3. Press the Key. button on the Intelligent 4. The hazard warning lights flash twice and the horn beeps once. 5. All doors will be locked. Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-17 ● Inserting the mechanical key into the ignition switch. CAUTION After locking the doors using the Intelligent Key, be sure that the doors have been securely locked by operating the door handles. The interior light illuminates for a maximum of 30 seconds when a door is unlocked and the room light switch is in the DOOR position. The light can be turned off without waiting for 30 seconds by performing one of the following operations. ● Placing the ignition switch in the ON position. ● Locking the doors with the remote controller. WPD0360 Unlocking doors 1. Press the Key. button on the Intelligent 2. The hazard warning lights flash once. button again within 60 sec3. Press the onds to unlock all doors. All doors will be locked automatically unless one of the following operations is performed within 1 button. minute after pressing the ● Opening any doors. ● Pushing the ignition switch. 3-18 Pre-driving checks and adjustments I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ● Switching the room light switch to the OFF position. ● Any button is pressed on the Intelligent Key. ● Pushing the request switch on the driver or passenger door with the Intelligent Key in range of the door handle. WPD0364 WPD0361 Releasing the trunk lid Using the panic alarm Press the button for longer than 0.5 seconds to open the trunk lid. The trunk release button will not operate when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position. If you are near your vehicle and feel threatened, you may activate the panic alarm to call attention button on the by pressing and holding the Intelligent Key for longer than 0.5 seconds. The panic alarm and headlights will stay on for 25 seconds. The panic alarm stops when: ● It has run for 25 seconds, or I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-19 The hazard warning lights will flash once and the horn will sound once to confirm that the horn beep feature has been reactivated. Deactivating the horn beep feature does not silence the horn if the alarm is triggered. WPD0362 WPD0382 Silencing the horn beep feature 1 䊊 If desired, the horn beep feature can be deactivated using the Intelligent Key. 2 䊊 WARNING LIGHTS AND AUDIBLE REMINDERS To deactivate: Press and hold the and buttons for at least 2 seconds. The Intelligent Key is equipped with a function that is designed to minimize improper operations and to help prevent the vehicle from being stolen. The warning buzzer sounds and the warning light illuminates when improper operations are detected. The hazard warning lights will flash 3 times to confirm that the horn beep feature has been deactivated. To activate: Press and hold the and buttons for at least 2 seconds once more. 3-20 Pre-driving checks and adjustments P (Park) position selecting warning light NISSAN Intelligent Key™ warning light I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : CAUTION When the buzzer sounds and the warning light illuminates, be sure to check both the vehicle and the Intelligent Key. WARNING SIGNALS To help prevent the vehicle from moving unexpectedly by erroneous operation of the Intelligent Key or to help prevent the vehicle from being stolen, a chime or buzzer sounds from inside and outside the vehicle and a warning light comes on in the instrument panel. When a chime or beep sounds or the warning light comes on, be sure to check the vehicle and the Intelligent Key. Audible reminder and warning when the engine stops Alarm and warning when the engine starts When the P position selecting warning light ) in the instrument panel blinks in red: ( When the Intelligent Key system warning light ( ) blinks red and the outside buzzer sounds, make sure the Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle. ● Make sure the shift selector is in the P (Park) position. When the chime sounds intermittently: ● Make sure the shift selector is in the P (Park) position and the ignition switch is placed in the LOCK position. If the chime sounds continuously when the driver’s door is opened, check the following: Audible reminder and warning when locking the doors ● The shift selector is placed in the P (Park) position and the ignition switch is placed in the LOCK position. When the chime or buzzer sounds from inside and outside the vehicle, check for the following: ● The mechanical key is not inserted into the ignition switch. ● The ignition switch is placed in the LOCK position. ● The warning chime may stop when one of the following is performed: ● The Intelligent Key is not left inside the vehicle. – Returning the ignition switch to the LOCK position. ● The shift selector is in the P (Park) position. – Removing the mechanical key. Warning for low battery power When the Intelligent Key battery is low, the Intelligent Key system warning light ( ) will blink green for about 30 seconds after the ignition switch is placed in the ON position. This warning is to let you know that the battery of the Intelligent Key will run down soon. Replace it with a new one. Refer to “Battery replacement” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section. NISSAN recommends replacing the battery at a NISSAN dealer. Preventing the Intelligent Key from being left in the vehicle If you lock all doors using the power door lock switch with the Intelligent Key in the vehicle, all of the doors unlock immediately and the buzzer will warn you when the door is closed. – Closing the doors. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-21 TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE When pushing the door handle request switch When closing the doors Symptom The front door beep sounds for approximately 2 seconds. The front door beep sounds for approximately 10 seconds. The key warning light in the instrument panel blinks in red and the front door warning beep sounds for approximately 3 seconds. The front door beep sounds for approximately 3 seconds and all doors unlock. Possible Cause The doors cannot be locked. The ignition knob is not placed in the LOCK position. The Intelligent Key is not in the vehicle. The Intelligent Key is left in the vehicle. When opening the driver’s door A warning chime sounds continuously. The ignition switch is not in the LOCK position, or the mechanical key is inserted into the ignition switch. When stopping the engine The P (Park) position warning light in the instrument panel blinks in red. The shift selector is not in the P (Park) position. When starting the engine The key warning light in the instrument panel blinks in green. The battery charge is low. When turning the ignition switch A warning chime sounds continuously. When pushing the ignition switch The Intelligent Key warning light in the instrument panel illuminates red. The ignition switch is not placed in the LOCK position. The Intelligent Key is not in the vehicle. 3-22 Pre-driving checks and adjustments I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Remedy Take out the Intelligent Key from the vehicle and push the door handle request switch. Place the ignition switch in the LOCK position. Be sure to carry the Intelligent Key with you. Take out the Intelligent Key from the vehicle and close the door. Place the ignition switch in the LOCK position. Remove the mechanical key from the ignition switch. Make sure that the shift selector is in the P (Park) position and place the ignition switch in the LOCK position. Replace the battery with a new one. See “Battery replacement” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section. Place the ignition switch in the LOCK position. If the Intelligent Key warning light illuminates red even while you are carrying the Intelligent Key, the battery is completely discharged. Replace the battery with a new one. See “Battery replacement” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section. HOOD TRUNK LID WARNING ● Do not drive with the trunk lid open. This could allow dangerous exhaust gases to be drawn into the vehicle. See “Exhaust gas” in the “Starting and driving” section of this manual. WPD0383 1 located 1. Pull the hood lock release handle 䊊 below the instrument panel until the hood springs up slightly. 2 in between the hood and 2. Locate the lever 䊊 grille and push the lever sideways with your fingertips. 3 . 3. Raise the hood 䊊 4 and insert it into 4. Remove the support rod 䊊 5 . the slot on the underside of the hood 䊊 When closing the hood, return the support rod to its original position, lower the hood to approxi- ● Closely supervise children when they are around cars to prevent them from playing and becoming locked in the trunk where they could be seriously injured. Keep the car locked, with the rear seatback and trunk lid securely latched when not in use, and prevent children’s access to car keys. mately 12 inches (30 cm) above the latch and release it. This allows proper engagement of the hood latch. WARNING ● Make sure the hood is completely closed and latched before driving. Failure to do so could cause the hood to fly open and result in an accident. ● If you see steam or smoke coming from the engine compartment, to avoid injury do not open the hood. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-23 WPD0390 Driver’s side TRUNK LID RELEASE The trunk lid release is located on the floor to the left of the driver’s seat. To open the trunk lid, pull the trunk lid release. WPD0384 KEY OPERATION (if so equipped) To open the trunk lid, turn the key clockwise. To close the trunk lid, lower and push the trunk lid down securely. To close the trunk lid, lower and push the trunk lid down securely. You can also open the trunk lid with the keyfob (if so equipped) or Intelligent Key (if so equipped). Refer to “Remote keyless entry system” or “NISSAN Intelligent Key™” in this section. 3-24 Pre-driving checks and adjustments WPD0385 INTERIOR TRUNK LID RELEASE WARNING Closely supervise children when they are around cars to prevent them from playing and becoming locked in the trunk where they could be seriously injured. Keep the car locked, with the rear seatback and trunk lid securely latched when not in use, and prevent children’s access to car keys. The interior trunk lid release mechanism provides a means of escape for children and adults in the event they become locked inside the trunk. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : FUEL-FILLER DOOR To open the trunk from the inside, pull the illuminated release handle until the lock releases and push up on the trunk lid. The release handle is made of a material that glows in the dark after a brief exposure to ambient light. The handle is located inside the trunk compartment on the interior of the trunk lid. LPD0386 LPD0387 OPENER OPERATION FUEL-FILLER CAP The fuel-filler door release is located on the floor to the left of the driver’s seat. To open the fuelfiller door, push the release. To lock, close the fuel-filler door securely. The fuel-filler cap is a ratcheting type. Turn the cap counterclockwise to remove. To tighten, turn the cap clockwise until ratcheting clicks are heard. 1 while Put the fuel-filler cap on the cap holder 䊊 refueling. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-25 WARNING ● Gasoline is extremely flammable and highly explosive under certain conditions. You could be burned or seriously injured if it is misused or mishandled. Always stop the engine and do not smoke or allow open flames or sparks near the vehicle when refueling. ● Do not attempt to top off the fuel tank after the fuel pump nozzle shuts off automatically. Continued refueling may cause fuel overflow, resulting in fuel spray and possibly a fire. ● Use only an original equipment type fuel-filler cap as a replacement. It has a built-in safety valve needed for proper operation of the fuel system and emission control system. An incorrect cap can result in a serious malfunction and possible injury. It could also cause the malfunction indicator light to come on. ● Do not fill a portable fuel container in the vehicle or trailer. Static electricity can cause an explosion of flammable liquid, vapor or gas in any vehicle or trailer. To reduce the risk of serious injury or death when filling portable fuel containers: – Always place the container on the ground when filling. – Do not use electronic devices when filling. – Keep the pump nozzle in contact with the container while you are filling it. – Use only approved portable fuel containers for flammable liquid. ● If fuel is spilled on the vehicle body, flush it away with water to avoid paint damage. ● Insert the fuel-filler cap straight into the fuel-filler tube, then tighten until the fuel-filler cap clicks. Failure to tighten the fuel-filler cap properly may cause Malfunction Indicator Light the (MIL) to illuminate. If the light illuminates because the fuel-filler cap is loose or missing, tighten or install the cap and continue to drive the vehicle. light should turn off after a The few driving trips. If the light does not turn off after a few driving trips, have the vehicle inspected by a NISSAN dealer ● For additional information, see the “Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)” in the “Instruments and Controls” section in this manual. ● Never pour fuel into the throttle body to attempt to start your vehicle. 3-26 Pre-driving checks and adjustments CAUTION I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : STEERING WHEEL SUN VISORS LPD0388 LPD0389 TILT OPERATION VANITY MIRRORS (if so equipped) 1 down and adjust the Push the lock lever 䊊 2 to the desired steering wheel up or down 䊊 position. To access the vanity mirror, pull the sun visor down and flip open the mirror cover. Some vanity mirrors are illuminated and turn on when the mirror cover is open. Pull the lock lever up to lock the steering wheel in place. WARNING Do not adjust the steering wheel while driving. You could lose control of your vehicle and cause an accident. SIC2872 To block out glare from the front, swing down the 1 . sun visor 䊊 To block glare from the side, disconnect the sun visor from the center mount and swing it to the 2 . side 䊊 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-27 MIRRORS OUTSIDE MIRRORS WARNING Objects viewed in the outside mirror on the passenger side are closer than they appear. Be careful when moving to the right. Using only this mirror could cause an accident. Use the inside mirror or glance over your shoulder to properly judge distances to other objects. WPD0126 LPD0029 REARVIEW MIRROR Manual control type (if so equipped) 1 reduces glare from the The night position 䊊 headlights of vehicles behind you at night. The outside mirror can be moved in any direction for a better rear view. 2 when driving in daylight Use the day position 䊊 hours. WARNING Use the night position only when necessary, because it reduces rear view clarity. 3-28 Pre-driving checks and adjustments I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Heated mirrors (Canada only) (if so equipped) Some outside mirrors can be heated to defrost, defog, or de-ice for improved visibility. Push the rear window defroster switch to activate the heating function. Push the switch again to deactivate, or the heating function will automatically turn off after approximately 15 minutes. WPD0274 Electric control type (if so equipped) The outside mirror remote control only operates when the ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position. Rotate the control lever to select the right or left mirror. Adjust the mirror to the desired position by moving the control lever. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-29 4 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems Control panel buttons — color screen with Navigation System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2 How to use the touch screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3 How to use the back button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5 How to use the SETUP button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5 button. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8 RearView Monitor (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8 How to read the displayed lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9 Difference between predicted and actual distances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9 Adjusting the screen (models without Navigation System) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12 Adjusting the screen (models with Navigation System) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12 Operating tips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13 Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14 Heater and air conditioner (manual). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14 Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16 Heater operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17 Air conditioner operation (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . 4-18 Air flow charts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19 Servicing air conditioner (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22 Audio system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23 Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23 FM radio reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23 AM radio reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23 Satellite radio reception (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . 4-24 Audio operation precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24 FM/AM radio with compact disc (CD) player (Type A) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31 FM/AM radio with compact disc (CD) player (Type B) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34 FM/AM/SAT radio with compact disc (CD) player (Type A) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38 FM/AM/SAT radio with compact disc (CD) player (Type B) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-44 USB interface (models without Navigation System) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-50 USB interface (models with Navigation System) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-52 iPod姞* Player Operation without Navigation System (Type A) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-54 iPod姞* Player Operation without Navigation System (Type B) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-55 iPod姞* Player Operation with Navigation System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-57 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : CD care and cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-59 Steering wheel switch for audio control (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-60 Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-61 Car phone or CB radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-62 Bluetooth姞 Hands-Free Phone System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-62 Regulatory Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-64 Using the system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-64 Control buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-66 Getting started . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-67 List of voice commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-69 Speaker adaptation (SA) mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-73 Manual Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-75 Troubleshooting guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-76 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : CONTROL PANEL BUTTONS — COLOR SCREEN WITH NAVIGATION SYSTEM (if so equipped) WARNING ● Do not disassemble or modify this system. If you do, it may result in accidents, fire, or electrical shock. ● In case you notice any foreign object in the system hardware, spill liquid on it, or notice smoke or smell coming from it, stop using the system immediately and contact your nearest NISSAN dealer. Ignoring such conditions may lead to accidents, fire or electrical shock. CAUTION Do not use this system if you notice any abnormality, such as a frozen screen or lack of sound. Continued use of the system may result in accident, fire or electric shock. LHA1474 1. (brightness control) button 5. TRAF button* 2. Display screen 6. SETUP button (P. 4-5) 3. MAP button* 7. 4. NAV button* 8. TUNE/SCROLL knob I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-2 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems BACK button 9. Power button/Volume control knob *For Navigation system control buttons, refer to the separate Navigation System Owner’s Manual. When you use this system, make sure the engine is running. If you use the system with the engine not running (ignition ON or ACC) for a long time, it will discharge the battery, and the engine will not start. Reference symbols: “Example” — Words marked in quotes refer to a key shown only on the display. These keys can be selected by touching the screen. HOW TO USE THE TOUCH SCREEN CAUTION ● The glass screen on the liquid crystal display may break if it is hit with a hard or sharp object. If the glass breaks, do not touch the liquid crystalline material, which contains a small amount of mercury. In case of contact with skin, wash immediately with soap and water. ● To clean the display, never use a rough cloth, alcohol, benzine, thinner or any kind of solvent or paper towel with a chemical cleaning agent. They will scratch or deteriorate the panel. ● Do not splash any liquid such as water or car fragrance on the display. Contact with liquid will cause the system to malfunction. To help ensure safe driving, some functions cannot be operated while driving. The on-screen functions that are not available while driving will be “grayed out” or muted. Park the vehicle in a safe location and then operate the navigation system. WARNING ● ALWAYS give your full attention to driving. LHA1476 Touch screen operation Selecting the item: Touch an item to select. For example, to select 1 on the the “Audio” key, touch the “Audio” key 䊊 screen. ● Avoid using vehicle features that could distract you. If distracted, you could lose control of your vehicle and cause an accident. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-3 LHA1477 LHA1478 For screens where an item can be adjusted incrementally, such as when adjusting the bass and 1 treble for the audio system, touch the “+” key 䊊 2 to adjust the settings of an item. or the “⫺” key 䊊 Other items are adjusted by selecting one of a set number of conditions. For example, the Display Mode can be set to “Automatic”, “Day” or “Night”. 1 . The To adjust this type of item, touch the item 䊊 item will cycle through the available settings and the red indicator lights to the left of the setting 2 will come on or turn off accordingly. condition 䊊 Adjusting the item: When there are more items than can be dis3 to played on one screen, touch the up arrow 䊊 4 to scroll up the page or touch the down arrow 䊊 scroll down the page. LHA1479 Inputting characters: 1 . Touch the letter key 䊊 There are some options available when inputting characters. ● 123 / ABC: Changes the available character set to numbers. ● Space: Inserts a space. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-4 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems ● Delete: Deletes the last inputted character with one touch. Touch and hold the “Delete” key to delete all of the characters. ● OK: Completes the character input. XM setup For XM setup, refer to “Audio System” in this section. Touch screen maintenance If you clean the display screen, use a dry, soft cloth. If additional cleaning is necessary, use a small amount of neutral detergent with a soft cloth. Never spray the screen with water or detergent. Dampen the cloth first and then wipe the screen. HOW TO USE THE BACK BUTTON Press the BACK button to return to the previous screen. LHA1480 HOW TO USE THE SETUP BUTTON When the SETUP button is pressed, the Setup screen will appear on the display. You can select and/or adjust several functions, features and modes that are available for your vehicle. Audio setup For audio setup, refer to “Audio System” in this section. Navigation setup Refer to the separate Navigation System Owner’s Manual for information regarding this item. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-5 Display Mode The display can be adjusted to fit the level of lighting in the vehicle. Touch the “Display Mode” key to cycle through the options. “Day” and “Night” modes are suited for the respective times of day, while “Automatic” controls the display automatically. Scroll Direction The direction that menus scroll can be adjusted. Choose either “up” or “down”. LHA1481 LHA1482 System setup Display: Select the “System” key to select and/or adjust various functions of the system. A screen with additional options will appear. Select the “Display” key to adjust the appearance of the display. The following settings can be adjusted: Brightness The brightness of the display can be set to Very Bright, Bright, Default, Dark or Very Dark. Touch the “Brightness” key to cycle through the options. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-6 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems LHA1483 Clock: Select the “Clock” key to adjust the time and the appearance of the clock on the display. The following settings can be adjusted: Time Format The clock can be set to 12 hours or 24 hours. Use GPS Clock When this setting is activated, the clock is set and continually updated via the GPS used by the Navigation System. LHA1484 Set Clock Manually When this setting is activated, the clock can be set manually. Touch the “+” or “-” key to adjust the hours and minutes up or down. Daylight Savings Time When this setting is activated, daylight savings time is on. Touch the “Daylight Savings Time” key to toggle the setting on or off. Time Zone Choose the applicable time zone from the list. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : LHA1485 Language: Select the “Language” key to adjust the language used by the system. The language can be set to English, Français or Español. Touch click: Select the “Touch Click” key to toggle the touch click feature on or off. When activated, a click sound will be heard every time a key on the screen is touched. Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-7 REARVIEW MONITOR (if so equipped) Beep tones: Select the “Beep Tones” key to toggle the beep tones feature on or off. When activated, a beep sound will be heard when a pop-up message appears on the screen or a button on the unit button) is pressed and held (such as the for two seconds. Reset all settings/memory: Select the “Reset All Settings/Memory” key to return all settings to default and to clear the memory. Traffic setup Refer to the separate Navigation System Owner’s Manual for information regarding this item. BUTTON To change the display brightness, press the button. Pressing the button again will change the display to the day or the night display. If no operation is performed within 5 seconds, the display will return to the previous display. button for more than Press and hold the two seconds to turn the display off. Press the button again to turn the display on. When the shift selector is shifted into the R (Reverse) position, the monitor display shows the view directly to the rear of the vehicle. WARNING ● The system is designed as an aid to the driver in detecting large stationary objects to help avoid damaging the vehicle. The system will not detect small objects below the bumper, and may not detect objects close to the bumper or on the ground. ● The RearView Monitor is a convenience but it is not a substitute for proper backing. Always turn and check that it is safe to do so before backing up. Always back up slowly. ● Objects viewed in the RearView Monitor differ from actual distance because a wide-angle lens is used. ● Make sure that the trunk is securely closed when backing up. ● Underneath the bumper and the corner areas of the bumper cannot be viewed on the RearView Monitor because of its monitoring range limitation. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-8 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems ● Do not put anything on the rearview camera. The rearview camera is installed beside the license plate light. ● When washing the vehicle with highpressure water, be sure not to spray it around the camera. Otherwise, water may enter the camera unit causing water condensation on the lens, a malfunction, fire or an electric shock. ● Do not strike the camera. It is a precision instrument. Otherwise, it may malfunction or cause damage resulting in a fire or an electric shock. CAUTION There is a plastic cover over the camera. Do not scratch the cover when cleaning dirt or snow from the cover. DIFFERENCE BETWEEN PREDICTED AND ACTUAL DISTANCES The distance guide line and the vehicle width guide line should be used as a reference only when the vehicle is on a level, paved surface. The distance viewed on the monitor is for reference only and may be different than the actual distance between the vehicle and displayed objects. LHA0437 Without Navigation System HOW TO READ THE DISPLAYED LINES Lines which indicate the vehicle clearance and distances to objects with reference to the A are displayed on the monitor. bumper line 䊊 They are indicated as reference distances to objects. The lines and colors in the display indiA in cate distances from the back bumper line 䊊 the illustration. WHA1531 1 䊊 2 䊊 3 䊊 4 䊊 With Navigation System 1.5 ft (0.5 m) red 3 ft (1 m) yellow 7 ft (2 m) green 10 ft (3 m) green (models without Navigation System only) The vehicle clearance lines are wider than the actual clearance. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-9 B . Note that any object on the hill is the place 䊊 the hill is viewed in the monitor farther than it appears. WHA1504 WHA1505 Backing up on a steep uphill Backing up on a steep downhill When backing up the vehicle up a hill, the distance guide lines and the vehicle width guide lines are shown closer than the actual distance. For example, the display shows 3 ft (1.0 m) to the A , but the actual 3 ft (1.0 m) distance on place 䊊 When backing up the vehicle down a hill, the distance guide lines and the vehicle width guide lines are shown farther than the actual distance. For example, the display shows 3 ft (1.0 m) to the A , but the actual 3 ft (1.0 m) distance on place 䊊 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-10 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems B . Note that any object on the hill is the place 䊊 the hill is viewed in the monitor closer than it appears. A if the object projects over the the position 䊊 actual backing up course. WHA1506 Backing up behind a projecting object C is shown farther than the position The position 䊊 B in the display. However, the position 䊊 C is 䊊 A. actually at the same distance as the position 䊊 The vehicle may hit the object when backing up to I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-11 LHA1272 LHA1480 ADJUSTING THE SCREEN (models without Navigation System) ADJUSTING THE SCREEN (models with Navigation System) To adjust the quality of the screen, press the setting control knob on the audio system. To adjust the quality of the screen, perform the following: ● To adjust the Brightness or Contrast, press the setting control knob repeatedly until the setting you wish to adjust is displayed. Use the TUNE/SCROLL knob to adjust the display to the desired level. 1. Press the SETUP button. 2. Touch “System”. LHA1482 3. Touch “Display”. 4. To adjust the brightness, touch the “Brightness” key repeatedly to set the display to Very Bright, Bright, Default, Dark or Very Dark. Touch “Display Mode” to cycle between day, night and automatic display modes. Do not adjust the screen settings of the RearView Monitor while the vehicle is moving. ● Do not adjust the Brightness or Contrast of the RearView Monitor while the vehicle is moving. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-12 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems OPERATING TIPS ● When the shift selector is shifted to R (Reverse), the monitor screen automatically changes to the RearView Monitor mode. However, the radio can be heard. ● It may take some time until the RearView Monitor is displayed after the shift selector has been shifted to R (Reverse). Objects may be distorted momentarily until the RearView Monitor screen is displayed completely. When the shift selector is returned to a position other than R (Reverse), it may take some time until the screen changes. Objects on the screen may be distorted until they are completely displayed. ● When the temperature is extremely high or low, the screen may not clearly display objects. This is not a malfunction. ● When strong light directly enters the camera, objects may not be displayed clearly. ● Vertical lines may be seen in objects on the screen. This is due to strong reflected light from the bumper. This is not a malfunction. ● The colors of objects on the RearView Monitor may differ somewhat from those of the actual object. ● When the contrast of objects is low at night, pressing the setting control knob or SETUP button may not change the brightness. ● Objects on the monitor may not be clear in a dark place or at night. ● If dirt, rain or snow attaches to the camera, the RearView Monitor may not display objects. Clean the camera. ● Do not use alcohol, benzine or thinner to clean the camera. This will cause discoloration. To clean the camera, wipe with a cloth dampened with a diluted mild cleaning agent and then wipe with a dry cloth. ● Do not damage the camera as the monitor screen may be adversely affected. ● Do not use body wax on the camera window. If body wax does get on the camera window, wipe off the wax with a clean cloth dampened with mild detergent diluted with water. ● The screen may flicker under fluorescent light. This is not a malfunction. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-13 VENTS HEATER AND AIR CONDITIONER (manual) WARNING ● The air conditioner cooling function operates only when the engine is running. WHA0772 ● Do not leave children or adults who would normally require the assistance of others alone in your vehicle. Pets should also not be left alone. They could accidentally injure themselves or others through inadvertent operation of the vehicle. Also, on hot, sunny days, temperatures in a closed vehicle could quickly become high enough to cause severe or possibly fatal injuries to people or animals. ● Do not use the recirculation mode for long periods as it may cause the interior air to become stale and the windows to fog up. Adjust air flow direction for the driver’s and pas1 , and center 䊊 2 ventilators by senger’s side 䊊 moving the ventilator slide and/or ventilator assemblies. 1 by using the dial. Open or close the ventilators 䊊 Move the dial toward the to open the ventilators or toward the to close them. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-14 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems WHA0470 Type A 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Fan control dial Air recirculation button Temperature control dial Air flow control dial Rear window defroster I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-15 — Air flows mainly from foot outlets. — Air flows from defroster outlets and foot outlets. — Air flows mainly from defroster outlets. ● You can also select the middle position and or between between and . LHA0440 Type B 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Fan control dial Air recirculation button Temperature control dial Air conditioner button Air flow control dial Rear window defroster CONTROLS Fan control dial The fan control dial turns the fan on and off, and controls fan speed. ● When the , or position is selected, the air recirculation mode cannot be turned on. This prevents the windows from fogging. Air flow control dial Temperature control dial The air flow control dial allows you to select the air flow outlets. The temperature control dial allows you to adjust the temperature of the outlet air. To lower the temperature, turn the dial to the left. To increase the temperature, turn the dial to the right. MAX A/C — Air flows from center and side vents with maximum cooling (air conditioning if so equipped). — Air flows from center and side vents. — Air flows from center and side vents and foot outlets. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-16 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems Air recirculation button NOTE: The air recirculation feature is available only on those vehicles equipped with air conditioning. On position (Indicator light on): Interior air is recirculated inside the vehicle. Press the button to the on position when: ● driving on a dusty road. ● to prevent traffic fumes from entering passenger compartment. ● for maximum cooling when using the air conditioner. button is pressed, the air conWhen the ditioner automatically turns on and the indicator button is pressed illuminates. When the again, the air recirculation mode turns off, but the air conditioner remains on. turn on the air conditioner. The indicator light comes on when the air conditioner is operating. To turn off the air conditioner, push the button again. The air conditioner cooling function operates only when the engine is running. Rear window defroster switch For more information about the rear window defroster switch, see “Rear window and outside mirror defroster switch” in the “Instruments and controls” section of this manual. HEATER OPERATION Heating Off position (Indicator light off): Outside air is drawn into the passenger compartment and distributed through the selected outlet. This mode is used to direct heated air to the foot outlets. Some air also flows from the defrost outlets and outboard vents. Use the off position for normal heater or air conditioner operation. button to the off position for 1. Push the normal heating. Air conditioner button (if so equipped) The button is provided only on vehicles equipped with an air conditioner. Start the engine, turn the fan control dial to the button to desired position and push the 2. Turn the air flow control dial to the position. 3. Turn the fan control dial to the desired position. Ventilation This mode directs outside air to the side and center vents. 1. Push the button to the off position. 2. Turn the air flow control dial to the position. 3. Turn the fan control dial to the desired position. 4. Turn the temperature control dial to the desired position. Defrosting or defogging This mode directs the air to the defrost outlets and outboard vents to defrost/defog the windows. 1. Turn the air flow control dial to the position. 2. Turn the fan control dial to the desired position. 3. Turn the temperature control dial to the desired position between the middle and the hot position. 4. Turn the temperature control dial to the desired position between the middle and the hot position. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-17 ● To quickly remove ice or fog from the windows, turn the fan control dial to HI and the temperature control lever to the full HOT position. or position is se● When the lected, the air conditioner automatically turns on (however, the indicator light will not illuminate). In this position, the A/C cannot be turned off. When the air flow control dial is turned to any position other than or , the A/C light will illuminate (the A/C will continue operating) and can be turned off using the A/C button. This dehumidifies the air which helps defog the windmode automatically turns shield. The off, allowing outside air to be drawn into the passenger compartment to further improve the defogging performance. Bi-level heating This mode directs air from the side, center and the foot outlets. 1. Push the button to the off position. 2. Turn the air flow control dial to the position. 3. Turn the fan control dial to the desired position. 4. Turn the temperature control dial to the desired position. Heating and defogging This mode heats the interior and defogs the windshield. 1. Turn the air flow control dial to the position. 2. Turn the fan control dial to the desired position. 3. Turn the temperature control dial to the desired position between the middle and the hot position. or position is se● When the lected, the air conditioner automatically turns on (however, the indicator light will not illuminate). In this position, the A/C cannot be turned off. When the air flow control dial is turned to any position other than the A/C light will illuminate (the or A/C will continue operating) and can be turned off using the A/C button. This dehumidifies the air which helps defog the windmode automatically turns shield. The off, allowing outside air to be drawn into the passenger compartment to further improve the defogging performance. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-18 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems Operating tips Clear snow and ice from the wiper blades and air inlet in front of the windshield. This improves heater operation. AIR CONDITIONER OPERATION (if so equipped) Start the engine, turn the fan control dial to the desired position, and push in the button to activate the air conditioner. When the air conditioner is on, cooling and dehumidifying functions are added to the heater operation. The air conditioner cooling function operates only when the engine is running. Cooling This mode is used to cool and dehumidify the air. 1. Push the button to the off position. 2. Turn the air flow control dial to the MAX A/C position. or 3. Turn the fan control dial to the desired position. 4. Push the comes on. button. The indicator light 5. Turn the temperature control dial to the desired position. ● For quick cooling when the outside tembutton to perature is high, push the the on position (indicator light on). Be sure button to the off position to return the for normal cooling. MAX A/C may be used for quick cooling. Dehumidified heating This mode is used to heat and dehumidify the air. 1. Push the button to the off position. 2. Turn the air flow control dial to the position. 3. Turn the fan control dial to the desired position. 4. Push the comes on. button. The indicator light 5. Turn the temperature control dial to the desired position. Dehumidified defogging This mode is used to defog the windows and dehumidify the air. 1. Turn the air flow control dial to the position. 2. Turn the fan control dial to the desired position. 3. Push the comes on. button. The indicator light or position is selected, When the the air conditioner automatically turns on (however, the indicator light will not illuminate). In this position, the A/C cannot be turned off. When the air flow control is turned to any position other or the A/C light will illuminate than (the A/C will continue operating) and can be turned off using the A/C button. This dehumidifies the air which helps defog the windshield. mode automatically turns off, allowing The outside air to be drawn into the passenger compartment to further improve the defogging performance. 4. Turn the temperature control dial to the desired position. Operating tips ● Keep the windows and moonroof closed while the air conditioner is in operation. ● The air conditioning system should be operated for approximately 10 minutes at least once a month. This helps prevent damage to the system due to lack of lubrication. ● A visible mist may be seen coming from the vents in hot, humid conditions as the air is cooled rapidly. This does not indicate a malfunction. ● If the engine coolant temperature gauge indicates engine coolant temperature over the normal range, turn the air conditioner off. See “If your vehicle overheats” in the “In case of emergency” section of this manual. AIR FLOW CHARTS The following charts show the button and dial positions for MAXIMUM AND QUICK heating, cooling or defrosting. The air recirculation button should always be in the OFF position for heating and defrosting. ● After parking in the sun, drive for 2 or 3 minutes with the windows open to vent hot air from the passenger compartment. Then, close the windows. This allows the air conditioner to cool the interior more quickly. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-19 WHA1116 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-20 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems WHA1117 WHA1118 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : WHA1119 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-21 SERVICING AIR CONDITIONER (if so equipped) The air conditioner system in your NISSAN vehicle is charged with a refrigerant designed with the environment in mind. This refrigerant does not harm the earth’s ozone layer. Special charging equipment and lubricant is required when servicing your NISSAN air conditioner. Using improper refrigerants or lubricants will cause severe damage to your air conditioner system. See “Air conditioner system refrigerant and oil recommendations” in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual. A NISSAN dealer is able to service your “environmentally friendly” air conditioning system. WARNING The air conditioner system contains refrigerant under high pressure. To avoid personal injury, any air conditioner service should be done only by an experienced technician with proper equipment. WHA1121 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-22 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems AUDIO SYSTEM RADIO Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position and press the POWER/VOLUME control knob to turn the radio on. If you listen to the radio with the engine not running, the ignition switch should be placed in the ACC position. Radio reception is affected by station signal strength, distance from radio transmitter, buildings, bridges, mountains and other external influences. Intermittent changes in reception quality normally are caused by these external influences. Using a cellular phone in or near the vehicle may influence radio reception quality. Radio reception Your NISSAN radio system is equipped with state-of-the-art electronic circuits to enhance radio reception. These circuits are designed to extend reception range, and to enhance the quality of that reception. However, there are some general characteristics of both FM and AM radio signals that can affect radio reception quality in a moving vehicle, even when the finest equipment is used. These characteristics are completely normal in a given reception area and do not indicate any malfunction in your NISSAN radio system. Reception conditions will constantly change because of vehicle movement. Buildings, terrain, signal distance and interference from other vehicles can work against ideal reception. Described below are some of the factors that can affect your radio reception. Static and flutter: During signal interference from buildings, large hills or due to antenna position (usually in conjunction with increased distance from the station transmitter), static or flutter can be heard. This can be reduced by adjusting the treble control to reduce treble response. Some cellular phones or other devices may cause interference or a buzzing noise to come from the audio system speakers. Storing the device in a different location may reduce or eliminate the noise. Multipath reception: Because of the reflective characteristics of FM signals, direct and reflected signals reach the receiver at the same time. The signals may cancel each other, resulting in momentary flutter or loss of sound. FM RADIO RECEPTION AM RADIO RECEPTION Range: FM range is normally limited to 25 – 30 mi (40 – 48 km), with monaural (single channel) FM having slightly more range than stereo FM. External influences may sometimes interfere with FM station reception even if the FM station is within 25 mi (40 km). The strength of the FM signal is directly related to the distance between the transmitter and receiver. FM signals follow a lineof-sight path, exhibiting many of the same characteristics as light. For example, they will reflect off objects. AM signals, because of their low frequency, can bend around objects and skip along the ground. In addition, the signals can be bounced off the ionosphere and bent back to earth. Because of these characteristics, AM signals are also subject to interference as they travel from transmitter to receiver. Fade and drift: As your vehicle moves away from a station transmitter, the signals will tend to fade and/or drift. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Fading: Occurs while the vehicle is passing through freeway underpasses or in areas with many tall buildings. It can also occur for several seconds during ionospheric turbulence even in areas where no obstacles exist. Static: Caused by thunderstorms, electrical power lines, electric signs and even traffic lights. Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-23 Compact disc (CD) player SATELLITE RADIO RECEPTION (if so equipped) CAUTION When the satellite radio is used for the first time or the battery has been replaced, the satellite radio may not work properly. This is not a malfunction. Wait more than 10 minutes with satellite radio ON and the vehicle outside of any metal or large building for satellite radio to receive all of the necessary data. ● Do not force a compact disc into the CD insert slot. This could damage the CD and/or CD player. ● Trying to load a CD with the CD door closed could damage the CD and/or CD player. No satellite radio reception is available when the RADIO button is pressed to access satellite radio stations unless optional satellite receiver and antenna are installed and an XM姞 satellite radio service subscription is active. Satellite radio is not available in Alaska, Hawaii and Guam. ● Only one CD can be loaded into the CD player at a time. ● Only use high quality 4.7 in (12 cm) round discs that have the “COMPACT disc DIGITAL AUDIO” logo on the disc or packaging. Satellite radio performance may be affected if cargo carried on the roof blocks the satellite radio signal. ● During cold weather or rainy days, the player may malfunction due to the humidity. If this occurs, remove the CD and dehumidify or ventilate the player completely. If possible, do not put cargo over the satellite antenna. A build up of ice on the satellite radio antenna can affect satellite radio performance. Remove the ice to restore satellite radio reception. LHA0099 AUDIO OPERATION PRECAUTIONS ● The player may skip while driving on rough roads. ● The CD player sometimes cannot function when the compartment temperature is extremely high or low. Decrease/increase the temperature before use. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-24 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems ● Do not expose the CD to direct sunlight. ● CDs that are in poor condition or are dirty, scratched or covered with fingerprints may not work properly. ● The following CDs may not work properly: ● Copy control compact discs (CCCD) ● Recordable compact discs (CD-R) ● Rewritable compact discs (CD-RW) ● Do not use the following CDs as they may cause the CD player to malfunction: CHECK DISC: ● Confirm that the CD is inserted correctly (the label side is facing up, etc.). ● Confirm that the CD is not bent or warped and it is free of scratches. PRESS EJECT: This is an error due to excessive temperature inside the player. Remove the CD by pressing the EJECT button. After a short time, reinsert the CD. The CD can be played when the temperature of the player returns to normal. ● 3.1 in (8 cm) discs with an adapter UNPLAYABLE: ● CDs that are not round The file is unplayable in this audio system (only MP3 or WMA (if so equipped) CD). ● CDs with a paper label ● CDs that are warped, scratched, or have abnormal edges ● This audio system can only play prerecorded CDs. It has no capability to record or burn CDs. ● If the CD cannot be played, one of the following messages will be displayed. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Compact Disc with MP3 or WMA (if so equipped) Terms: ● MP3 — MP3 is short for Moving Pictures Experts Group Audio Layer 3. MP3 is the most well-known compressed digital audio file format. This format allows for near “CD quality” sound, but at a fraction of the size of normal audio files. MP3 conversion of an audio track from CD-ROM can reduce the file size by approximately a 10:1 ratio with virtually no perceptible loss in quality. MP3 compression removes the redundant and irrelevant parts of a sound signal that the human ear doesn’t hear. ● WMA — Windows Media Audio (WMA)* is a compressed audio format created by Microsoft as an alternative to MP3. The WMA codec offers greater file compression than the MP3 codec, enabling storage of more digital audio tracks in the same amount of space when compared to MP3s at the same level of quality. ● Bit rate — Bit rate denotes the number of bits per second used by a digital music file. The size and quality of a compressed digital audio file is determined by the bit rate used when encoding the file. Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-25 ● Sampling frequency — Sampling frequency is the rate at which the samples of a signal are converted from analog to digital (A/D conversion) per second. Playback order: Music playback order of a CD with MP3 or WMA files is as illustrated. ● The names of folders not containing MP3 or WMA files are not shown in the display. ● Multisession — Multisession is one of the methods for writing data to media. Writing data once to the media is called a single session, and writing more than once is called a multisession. ● If there is a file in the top level of the disc, “Root Folder” is displayed. ● The playback order is the order in which the files were written by the writing software. Therefore, the files might not play in the desired order. ● ID3/WMA Tag — The ID3/WMA tag is the part of the encoded MP3 or WMA file that contains information about the digital music file such as song title, artist, encoding bit rate, track time duration, etc. ID3 tag information is displayed on the Artist/song title line on the display. * Windows姞 and Windows Media姞 are registered trademarks and trademarks in the United States of America and other countries of Microsoft Corporation of the USA. WHA1078 Playback order chart I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-26 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems Specification chart: Supported media Supported file systems MP3 Supported versions*1 WMA Version Sampling frequency Bit rate Version Sampling frequency Bit rate Tag information Folder levels Text character number limitation Displayable character codes*2 CD, CD-R, CD-RW ISO9660 LEVEL1, ISO9660 LEVEL2, Apple ISO, Romeo, Joliet * ISO9660 Level 3 (packet writing) is not supported. MPEG1, MPEG2, MPEG2.5 8 kHz - 48 kHz 8 kbps - 320 kbps, VBR WMA7, WMA8, WMA9 32 kHz - 48 kHz 48 kbps - 192 kbps, VBR ID3 tag VER1.0, VER1.1, VER2.2, VER2.3 (MP3 only) Folder levels: 8, Max folders: 255 (including root folder), Files: 512 (Max. 255 files for one folder) 128 characters 01: ASCII, 02: ISO-8859-1, 03: UNICODE (UTF-16 BOM Big Endian), 04: UNICODE (UTF-16 Non-BOM Big Endian), 05: UNICODE (UTF-8), 06: UNICODE (Non-UTF-16 BOM Little Endian) *1 Files created with a combination of 48 kHz sampling frequency and 64 kbps bit rate cannot be played. *2 Available codes depend on what kind of media, versions and information are going to be displayed. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-27 Troubleshooting guide: Symptom Cannot play Poor sound quality It takes a relatively long time before the music starts playing. Music cuts off or skips Skipping with high bit rate files Moves immediately to the next song when playing Songs do not play back in the desired order Cause and Countermeasure Check if the disc was inserted correctly. Check if the disc is scratched or dirty. Check if there is condensation inside the player. If there is, wait until the condensation is gone (about 1 hour) before using the player. If there is a temperature increase error, the CD player will play correctly after it returns to the normal temperature. If there is a mixture of music CD files (CD-DA data) and MP3/WMA files on a CD, only the music CD files (CD-DA data) will be played. Files with extensions other than “.MP3”,“.WMA”, “.mp3” or “.wma” cannot be played. In addition, the character codes and number of characters for folder names and file names should be in compliance with the specifications. Check if the finalization process, such as session close and disc close, is done for the disc. Check if the disc is protected by copyright. Check if the disc is scratched or dirty. Bit rate may be too low. If there are many folders or file levels on the MP3/WMA disc, or if it is a multisession disc, some time may be required before the music starts playing. The writing software and hardware combination might not match, or the writing speed, writing depth, writing width, etc., might not match the specifications. Try using the slowest writing speed. Skipping may occur with large quantities of data, such as for high bit rate data. When a non-MP3/WMA file has been given an extension of “.MP3”, “.WMA”, .“mp3”or “.wma”, or when play is prohibited by copyright protection, there will be approximately 5 seconds of no sound and then the player will skip to the next song. The playback order is the order in which the files were written by the writing software. Therefore, the files might not play in the desired order. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-28 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems Universal Serial Bus (USB) memory (if so equipped) ● The USB device cannot be formatted with this system. If you want to format the USB memory, use your personal computer. This system supports various USB memory sticks, USB hard drives and iPod姞 players. There are some USB devices which may not be supported with this system. ● Partitioned USB devices may not be played correctly. ● Make sure that the USB device is connected correctly into the USB connector. ● Do not force the memory stick or USB cable into the USB connector. ● During cold weather or rainy days, the player may malfunction due to the humidity. If this occurs, remove the USB memory stick and dehumidify or ventilate the player completely. ● The player sometimes cannot function when the passenger compartment temperature is extremely high. Decrease the temperature before use. ● Do not leave the USB memory in a place prone to static electricity or where the air conditioner blows directly. The data in the USB memory may be damaged. ● Prepare the USB device by yourself because it is not equipped with the vehicle. ● Some characters used in other languages (Chinese, Japanese, etc.) are not displayed properly on the vehicle center screen. NISSAN recommends using English language characters with USB devices. ● The iPod姞 nano (1st Generation) may remain in fast forward or rewind mode if it is connected during a seek operation. In this case, please manually reset the iPod姞. ● The iPod姞 nano (2nd Generation) will continue to fast forward or rewind if it is disconnected during a seek operation. ● An incorrect song title may appear when the Play Mode is changed while using the iPod姞 nano (2nd generation). ● Do not connect the USB device if the connector or cable is wet. Allow the cable and/or connectors to dry completely before connecting the USB device. ● If you are using an iPod姞 (3rd Generation with Dock connector), do not use very long names for the song title, album name or artist name to avoid the iPod姞 resetting itself. ● Large video podcast files cause slow responses in the iPod姞. The vehicle center display may momentarily black out, but it will soon recover. iPod姞 is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. ● If the iPod姞 automatically selects large video podcast files while in the shuffle mode, the vehicle center display may momentarily black out, but it will soon recover. ● Some characters used in other languages (Chinese, Japanese, etc.) are not displayed properly on the vehicle center screen. We recommend using English language characters with an iPod姞. ● Audiobooks may not play in the same order as they appear on the iPod姞. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : iPod姞* player (if so equipped) ● Large video podcast files cause slow responses in the iPod姞. The vehicle center display may momentarily black out, but it will soon recover. Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-29 ● If the iPod姞 automatically selects large video podcast files while in the shuffle mode, the vehicle center display may momentarily black out, but it will soon recover. ● Improperly plugging in the iPod姞 may cause a checkmark to be displayed on and off (flickering). Always make sure that the iPod姞 is connected properly. ● The iPod姞 nano (2nd Generation) will continue to fast forward or rewind if it is disconnected during a seek operation. ● An incorrect song title may appear when the Play Mode is changed while using the iPod姞 nano (2nd Generation). ● Audiobooks may not play in the same order as they appear on the iPod姞. ● The iPod姞 nano (1st Generation) may remain in fast forward or rewind mode if it is connected during a seek operation. In this case, please manually reset the iPod姞. ● If you are using an iPod姞 (3rd Generation with Dock connector), do not use very long names for the song title, album name or artist name to prevent the iPod姞 from resetting itself. ● Be careful not to do the following, or the cable could be damaged and a loss of function may occur: ● Bend the cable excessively (1.6 in (40 mm) radius maximum). ● Twist the cable excessively (more than 180 degrees). ● Pull or drop the cable. ● Close the center console lid on the cable or connectors. ● Store objects with sharp edges in the storage where the cable is stored. ● Spill liquids on the cable and connectors. ● Do not connect the cable to the iPod姞 if the cable and/or connectors are wet. It may damage the iPod姞. ● If the cable and connectors are exposed to water, allow the cable and/or connectors to dry completely before connecting the cable to the iPod姞 (wait 24 hours for it to dry). ● If the connector is exposed to fluids other than water, evaporative residue may cause a short between the connector pins. In this case, replace the cable, otherwise damage to the iPod姞 and a loss of function may occur. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-30 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems ● If the cable is damaged (insulation cut, connectors cracked, contamination such as liquids, dust, dirt, etc. in the connectors), do not use the cable and contact a NISSAN dealer to replace the cable with a new one. ● When not in use for extended periods of time, store the cable in a clean, dust free environment at room temperature and without direct sun exposure. ● Do not use the cable for any other purposes other than its intended use in the vehicle. *iPod姞 is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. VOLUME control knob PWR button SCAN button RDM button Station select (1 - 6) buttons FM/AM RADIO WITH COMPACT DISC (CD) PLAYER (Type A) (if so equipped) For all operation precautions, see ⬙Audio operation precautions⬙ in this section. Audio main operation POWER/VOLUME control: Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position. Press the PWR button while the system is off to call up the mode (radio, CD or AUX) that was playing immediately before the system was turned off. While the system is on, pressing the PWR button turns the system off. LHA1224 Type A 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. FM-AM button CD eject button SEEK button CD button CD insert slot 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. AUX button TUNE button MENU button RPT button AUX IN jack I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Turn the VOL control knob to adjust the volume. MENU button (Bass, Treble, Fade, Balance and Clock): Press the MENU button to change the mode as follows: BAS (Bass) → TRE (Treble) → FAD (Fade) → BAL (Balance) → Clock → Normal mode Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-31 Press the SEEK or or TUNE or button to adjust the Bass, Treble, Fade and Balance to the desired level. Fade adjusts the sound level between the front and rear speakers and Balance adjusts the sound between the right and left speakers. Once you have adjusted the sound quality to the desired level, press the MENU button repeatedly until the radio or CD display reappears. If no action is taken, the radio or CD display will automatically reappear after approximately 10 seconds. Clock set If the clock is not displayed with the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position, you need to select the CLK-ON mode. Press the MENU button repeatedly until CLK-OFF mode is displayed. Use the TUNE/FF-REW/FOLDER button to enable CLK-ON mode. 1. Press the MENU button repeatedly until “Clock:” appears. The hours will begin flashing. 2. Press the SEEK button or the TUNE button the hours. or or to adjust 3. Press the MENU button again. The minutes will begin flashing. 4. Press the SEEK button or the TUNE button the minutes. or or to adjust 5. Press the MENU button again to exit the clock set mode. If no action is taken, the display will return to the regular clock display after 10 seconds. SEEK tuning: or to tune Press the SEEK button from low to high or high to low frequencies and to stop at the next broadcasting station. SCAN tuning: Press the FM·AM button to change the band as follows: Press the SCAN button to stop at each broadcasting station for 5 seconds. Pressing the button again during this 5 second period will stop SCAN tuning and the radio will remain tuned to that station. If the SCAN button is not pressed within 5 seconds, SCAN tuning moves to the next station. AM → FM1 → FM2 → AM 1 to 6 Station memory operations: If another audio source is playing when the FM·AM button is pressed, the audio source playing will automatically be turned off and the last radio station played will begin playing. Twelve stations can be set for the FM band (6 for FM1, 6 for FM2) and six stations can be set for the AM band. FM/AM radio operation FM·AM button: The FM stereo indicator (ST) illuminates during FM stereo reception. When the stereo broadcast signal is weak, the radio automatically changes from stereo to monaural reception. TUNE button (Tuning): Press the TUNE button manual tuning. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-32 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems or for 1. Choose the radio band AM, FM1 or FM2 using the AM·FM select button. 2. Tune to the desired station using manual, SEEK or SCAN tuning. Press and hold any of the desired station memory buttons (1 – 6) until a beep sound is heard. 3. The channel indicator will then come on and the sound will resume. Programming is now complete. 4. Other buttons can be set in the same manner. If the battery cable is disconnected or if the fuse opens, the radio memory will be canceled. In that case, reset the desired stations. reversing or fast forwarding. When the button is released, the compact disc returns to normal play speed. SEEK button: Compact disc (CD) player operation Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position and carefully insert the compact disc into the slot with the label side up. The compact disc is automatically pulled into the slot and starts to play. If the radio is already operating, it automatically turns off and the compact disc begins to play. CD button: When the CD button is pressed with the system off and the compact disc loaded, the system will turn on and the compact disc will start to play. When the CD button is pressed with a compact disc loaded and the radio playing, the radio will automatically be turned off and the compact disc will start to play. TUNE (Rewind or Fast Forward) button: When the SEEK button is pressed while the compact disc is playing, the next track following the present one starts to play from the beginseveral times ning. Press the SEEK button to skip several tracks. Each time the button is pressed, the CD advances one additional track. The track number appears in the display window. (When the last track on the compact disc is skipped, the first track is played.) is pressed, the When the SEEK button track being played returns to the beginning. several times to Press the SEEK button skip back several tracks. Each time the button is pressed the CD moves back one track. RDM button: When the RDM button is pressed while a compact disc is playing, the play pattern can be changed as follows: 1 CD RDM ←→ 1 CD RPT or is When the TUNE button pressed while the compact disc is playing, the compact disc plays at an increased speed while 1 CD RDM: all tracks on the disc will be played randomly. RPT button: When the RPT button is pressed while a compact disc is playing, the play pattern can be changed as follows: 1 TR RPT ←→ 1 CD RPT 1 TR RPT: the current track will be repeated. 1 CD RPT: play pattern returns to normal. AUX (Auxiliary) button: The AUX IN jack is located on the front of the radio. The AUX IN audio input jack accepts any standard analog audio input such as from a portable cassette tape/CD player, MP3 player or a laptop computer. Press the AUX button to play a compatible device when it is plugged into the AUX IN jack. EJECT button: button is pressed with a comWhen the pact disc loaded, the compact disc will eject and the last source will be played. button is pressed twice with a When the compact disc loaded, the compact disc will be ejected further for easier CD removal. If the disc is not removed within 15 seconds, the disc will reload. 1 CD RPT: play pattern returns to normal. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-33 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20. SCAN/RPT button AUDIO button AUX IN jack Station select (1 - 6) buttons VOLUME control knob PWR button iPod MENU button BACK button ENTER button SEEK/TRACK button FM/AM RADIO WITH COMPACT DISC (CD) PLAYER (Type B) (if so equipped) For all operation precautions, see ⬙Audio operation precautions⬙ in this section. Audio main operation POWER/VOLUME control: LHA1225 Type B 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. MUTE button DISP/TEXT button FM-AM button CD button CD insert slot 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. iPod button AUX button CLOCK button CD eject button TUNE/FF-REW/FOLDER button I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-34 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position. Press the PWR button while the system is off to call up the mode (radio, CD or AUX) that was playing immediately before the system was turned off. While the system is on, pressing the PWR button turns the system off. Turn the VOL control knob to adjust the volume. MUTE button: Press the button to mute the audio sound. Press the button again to resume playing the audio at its previous volume. AUDIO button (Bass, Treble, Fade, Balance, SSV, Beep): Press the AUDIO button to change the mode as follows: Bass → Treble → Fade → Balance → Speed Sensitive Volume (SSV) → Beep ON/OFF → Normal mode To adjust Bass, Treble, Fade and Balance, press the AUDIO button until the desired mode appears in the display. Press the TUNE To change the Speed Sensitive Volume (SSV) mode to OFF, LOW, MID or HIGH, press the If no action is taken, the display will return to the regular clock display after 10 seconds. or TUNE button setting is displayed. DISP (display) button until the desired Once you have adjusted the sound quality to the desired level, press the AUDIO button repeatedly until the radio or CD display reappears. If no action is taken, the radio or CD display will automatically reappear after approximately 5 seconds. Clock set If the clock is not displayed with the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position, you need to select the CLK-ON mode. Press the MENU button repeatedly until CLK-OFF mode is displayed. Use the TUNE/FF-REW/FOLDER button to enable CLK-ON mode. or or SEEK or button to adjust the selected mode to the desired level. Fade adjusts the sound level between the front and rear speakers and Balance adjusts the sound between the right and left speakers. 1. Press and hold the CLOCK button until the clock display starts to flash. To change the Beep to ON or OFF, press the TUNE button up or down until the desired mode is displayed. This will enable or disable the beep sound heard during menu selection. 3. Press 2. Press or button the SEEK/TRACK button to adjust the hours. the TUNE/FF-REW/FOLDER or to adjust the minutes. 4. Press the CLOCK button again to exit the clock set mode. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : This button works during FM, CD and iPod姞 operation. See the detailed function for this button in the section for each mode. iPOD姞 MENU, ENTER and BACK buttons These buttons can only be used for iPod姞 operations. See “iPod姞 Player Operation without Navigation System (Type A)” in this section for details about the functions of these buttons. FM/AM radio operation FM·AM button: Press the FM·AM button to change the band as follows: AM → FM1 → FM2 → AM If another audio source is playing when the FM·AM button is pressed, the audio source playing will automatically be turned off and the last radio station played will begin playing. The FM stereo indicator (ST) illuminates during FM stereo reception. When the stereo broadcast signal is weak, the radio automatically changes from stereo to monaural reception. Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-35 TUNE button (Tuning): Press the button or TUNE/FF-REW/FOLDER for manual tuning. SEEK tuning: or Press the SEEK/TRACK button to tune from low to high or high to low frequencies and to stop at the next broadcasting station. 3. The channel indicator will then come on and the sound will resume. Programming is now complete. 4. Other buttons can be set in the same manner. 1 to 6 Station memory operations: Twelve stations can be set for the FM band (6 for FM1, 6 for FM2) and six stations can be set for the AM band. 1. Choose the radio band AM, FM1 or FM2 using the AM·FM select button. 2. Tune to the desired station using manual, SEEK or SCAN tuning. Press and hold any of the desired station memory buttons (1 – 6) until a beep sound is heard. DISP/TEXT button: If the battery cable is disconnected or if the fuse opens, the radio memory will be canceled. In that case, reset the desired stations. When the DISP/TEXT button is pressed while a CD is playing, the display will change as follows: DISP/TEXT button: Track number → Disc title → Song title → Track number SCAN tuning: Press the SCAN/RPT button to stop at each broadcasting station for 5 seconds. Pressing the button again during this 5 second period will stop SCAN tuning and the radio will remain tuned to that station. If the SCAN/RPT button is not pressed within 5 seconds, SCAN tuning moves to the next station. When the CD button is pressed with a compact disc loaded and the radio playing, the radio will automatically be turned off and the compact disc will start to play. When the DISP/TEXT button is pressed while in FM radio mode, the radio display will change as follows: Frequency → PTY → PS → Frequency CD: CD with MP3 or WMA: Track number → Folder title → Album title → Artist → Song title → Track number Compact disc (CD) player operation Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position and carefully insert the compact disc into the slot with the label side up. The compact disc is automatically pulled into the slot and starts to play. If the radio is already operating, it automatically turns off and the compact disc begins to play. CD button: When the CD button is pressed with the system off and the compact disc loaded, the system will turn on and the compact disc will start to play. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-36 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems TUNE/FF-REW/FOLDER (Reverse or Fast Forward) button: CD: When the TUNE/FF-REW/FOLDER button (fast forward) or (reverse) is pressed while the compact disc is playing, the compact disc plays at an increased speed while reversing or fast forwarding. When the button is released, the compact disc returns to normal play speed. CD with MP3 or WMA: When the TUNE/FF-REW/FOLDER button (fast forward) or (reverse) is pressed for less than 1.5 seconds while the compact disc is playing, the folders in the CD will change. When the TUNE/FF-REW/FOLDER button (fast forward) or (reverse) is pressed for more than 1.5 seconds while the compact disc is playing, the compact disc plays at an increased speed while reversing or fast forwarding. When the button is released, the compact disc returns to normal play speed. SEEK/TRACK button: is When the SEEK/TRACK button pressed while the compact disc is playing, the next track following the present one starts to play from the beginning. Press the SEEK/TRACK several times to skip several tracks. button Each time the button is pressed, the CD advances one additional track. The track number appears in the display window. (When the last track on the compact disc is skipped, the first track is played.) is When the SEEK/TRACK button pressed, the track being played returns to the beginning. Press the SEEK/TRACK several times to skip back several button tracks. Each time the button is pressed the CD moves back one track. SCAN/RPT button: When the SCAN/RPT button is pressed while a compact disc is playing, the play pattern can be changed as follows: AUX (Auxiliary) button: The AUX IN jack is located on the front of the radio. The AUX IN audio input jack accepts any standard analog audio input such as from a portable cassette tape/CD player, MP3 player or a laptop computer. Press the AUX button to play a compatible device when it is plugged into the AUX IN jack. EJECT button: CD: REPEAT TRACK → RANDOM TRACK → REPEAT DISC CD with MP3 or WMA: REPEAT FOLDER → REPEAT TRACK → RANDOM TRACK → RANDOM FOLDER → REPEAT DISC REPEAT TRACK: the current track will be repeated. button is pressed with a comWhen the pact disc loaded, the compact disc will eject and the last source will be played. button is pressed twice with a When the compact disc loaded, the compact disc will be ejected further for easier CD removal. If the disc is not removed within 15 seconds, the disc will reload. RANDOM TRACK: all tracks on the disc will be played randomly. REPEAT DISC: play pattern returns to normal. REPEAT FOLDER: the current folder will be repeated. RANDOM FOLDER: all tracks in the current folder will be played randomly. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-37 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. CD button FM-AM button RPT button POWER/VOLUME control knob RDM button *No satellite radio reception is available when the AUX button is pressed to access satellite radio stations unless optional satellite receiver and antenna are installed and an XM姞 satellite radio service subscription is active. Satellite radio is not available in Alaska, Hawaii and Guam. FM/AM/SAT RADIO WITH COMPACT DISC (CD) PLAYER (Type A) (if so equipped) For all operation precautions, see ⬙Audio operation precautions⬙ in this section. LHA1269 Type A 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. SCAN button Station select (1 - 6) buttons CD insert slot iPod MENU button CD eject button 6. 7. 8. 9. TUNE/FOLDER knob/Setting control button SEEK/TRACK buttons AUX IN jack AUX button* I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-38 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems Audio main operation VOL/ON·OFF control: Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position and push the VOL/ON·OFF control knob while the system is off to call up the mode (radio or CD) that was playing immediately before the system was turned off. To turn the system off, press the VOL/ON·OFF control knob. Turn the VOL/ON·OFF control knob to adjust the volume. This vehicle may be equipped with Speed Sensitive Volume (SSV) for audio. When this feature is active, the audio volume changes as the driving speed changes. Setting control knob (Audio, Display and Clock): Press the ENTER button to adjust the audio, display and clock settings as follows: Bass → Treble → Fade → Balance → Speed Sensitive Volume (SSV) (if so equipped) → Brightness → Contrast → On-screen Clock → Clock Adjust → Bass Once the desired setting is displayed on the screen, turn the TUNE/SCROLL knob left or right to adjust the chosen setting. Press the ENTER button to move to the next setting or wait approximately five seconds to exit the setting adjustment mode. LHA1270 LHA1271 Audio settings: Speed Sensitive Volume (if so equipped): Adjust the bass, treble, fade and balance by selecting the desired setting with the ENTER button and then adjusting the level with the TUNE/SCROLL knob. Balance adjusts the sound between the left and right speakers. Fade adjusts the sound between the front and rear speakers. To change the Speed Sensitive Volume (SSV) level from 1 to 5, or to turn the feature off entirely, choose the Speed Sensitive Volume (SSV) setting with the ENTER button and then adjust the level with the TUNE/SCROLL knob. Speed Sensitive Volume (SSV) adjusts the volume of the audio system as the vehicle’s driving speed changes. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-39 LHA1272 LHA1273 LHA1274 Display settings: On-screen Clock: Clock adjust: To adjust the brightness or contrast of the display screen, press the ENTER button until the chosen setting is displayed. Use the TUNE/SCROLL knob to adjust the display to the desired level. The clock is shown in the upper right corner of the screen. To turn this feature off or to re-enable the clock display after it has been turned off, press the ENTER button until the On-screen Clock mode is displayed. Use the TUNE/SCROLL knob to toggle the feature on or off. To adjust the time, perform the following steps: 1. Press the ENTER button repeatedly until the Clock Adjust mode is displayed on the screen. 2. The hours will begin blinking. Adjust the hours by turning the TUNE/SCROLL knob left or right and press the ENTER button. 3. The minutes will begin blinking. Adjust the minutes by turning the TUNE/SCROLL knob left or right and press the ENTER button. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-40 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems iPod姞 MENU button This button can only be used for iPod姞 operations. See “iPod姞 Player Operation without Navigation System (Type B)” in this section for details about the function of this button. FM/AM/SAT radio operation When the AUX button is pressed while the ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position, the radio will come on at the station last played. The last station played will also come on when the VOL/ON-OFF control knob is pressed to turn the radio on. AM → FM1 → FM2 → AM *When the AUX button is pressed, the satellite radio mode will be skipped unless an optional satellite receiver and antenna are installed and an XM姞 satellite radio service subscription is active. Satellite radio is not available in Alaska, Hawaii and Guam. If another audio source is playing when the FM·AM button is pressed, the audio source playing will automatically be turned off and the last radio station played will begin playing. If a compact disc is playing when the AUX button is pressed, the compact disc will automatically be turned off and the last radio station played will come on. The FM stereo indicator (STEREO) is shown on the screen during FM stereo reception. When the stereo broadcast signal is weak, the radio automatically changes from stereo to monaural reception. TUNE/SCROLL knob (Tuning): FM·AM button: Press the FM·AM button to change the band as follows: Turn the TUNE/SCROLL knob to the left or right for manual tuning. SEEK tuning: SAT band select: Pressing the AUX button will change the band as follows: or to tune Press the SEEK buttons from low to high or high to low frequencies and to stop at the next broadcasting station. AUX → XM1* → XM2* → AUX (satellite, if so equipped) I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : SCAN tuning: Press the SCAN button to stop at each broadcasting station for 5 seconds. SCAN will appear on the screen while the radio is scan tuning. Pressing the button again during this 5 second period will stop SCAN tuning and the radio will remain tuned to that station. If the SCAN button is not pressed within 5 seconds, SCAN tuning moves to the next station. 1 to 6 Station memory operations: Twelve stations can be set for the FM band (6 for FM1, 6 for FM2) and six stations can be set for the AM band. 1. Choose the radio band AM, FM1 or FM2 using the FM·AM select button. 2. Tune to the desired station using manual, SEEK or SCAN tuning. Press and hold any of the desired station memory buttons (1 – 6) until a beep sound is heard. 3. The channel indicator will then come on and the sound will resume. Programming is now complete. 4. Other buttons can be set in the same manner. Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-41 If the battery cable is disconnected or if the fuse opens, the radio memory will be canceled. In that case, reset the desired stations. SEEK/CAT (Reverse or Fast Forward) buttons: Press and hold the SEEK/CAT buttons or for 1.5 seconds while the compact disc is playing to reverse or fast forward the track being played. The compact disc plays at an increased speed while reversing or fast forwarding. When the button is released, the compact disc returns to normal play speed. Compact disc (CD) player operation Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position and carefully insert the compact disc into the slot with the label side up. The compact disc is automatically pulled into the slot and starts to play. If the radio is already operating, it automatically turns off and the compact disc begins to play. SEEK/CAT buttons: CD button: When the CD button is pressed with the system off and the compact disc loaded, the system will turn on and the compact disc will start to play. When the CD button is pressed with a compact disc loaded and the radio playing, the radio will automatically be turned off and the compact disc will start to play. LHA1275 CD/MP3 display mode: While listening to an MP3/WMA CD, certain text may be displayed on the screen if the CD has been encoded with text information. Depending on how the MP3/WMA CD is encoded, information such as Artist, Song and Folder will be displayed. The track number and the total number of tracks in the current folder or on the current disc are displayed on the screen as well. For example, the first track out of fourteen total is currently playing. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-42 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems Press the SEEK/CAT button while a CD or MP3/WMA CD is playing to return to the beginning of the current track. Press the SEEK/CAT several times to skip backward sevbutton eral tracks. while a CD or Press the SEEK/CAT button MP3/WMA CD is playing to advance one track. several times Press the SEEK/CAT button to skip forward several tracks. If the last track on a CD is skipped, the first track on the disc is played. If the last track in a folder of an MP3/WMA CD is skipped, the first track of the next folder is played. TUNE/SCROLL knob (MP3/WMA CD only): If an MP3/WMA CD with multiple folders is playing, turn the TUNE/SCROLL knob to change folders. Turn the knob to the left to skip back a folder. Turn the knob to the right to skip ahead a folder. RPT button: When the RPT button is pressed while a compact disc is playing, the play pattern can be changed as follows: CD: 1 TRK RPT ←→ OFF CD with MP3 or WMA: 1 FOLDER RPT → 1 TRK RPT → OFF 1 TRK RPT: the current track will be repeated. 1 FOLDER RPT: the current folder will be repeated. OFF: No repeat play pattern is applied. The indicator on the display will turn off. The current play pattern of the CD is displayed on the screen unless no pattern is applied. RDM button: When the RDM button is pressed while a compact disc is playing, the play pattern can be changed as follows: CD: 1 DISC RDM ←→ OFF CD with MP3 or WMA: 1 DISC RDM → 1 FOLDER RDM → OFF 1 DISC RDM: all tracks on the disc will be played randomly. 1 FOLDER RDM: all tracks in the current folder will be played randomly. OFF: No random play pattern is applied. The indicator on the display will turn off. The current play pattern of the CD is displayed on the screen unless no pattern is applied. AUX button: The AUX IN jack is located on the CD player. The AUX IN audio input jack accepts any standard analog audio input such as from a portable cassette tape/CD player, MP3 player or a laptop computer. Press the AUX button to play a compatible device plugged into the AUX IN jack. The AUX button is also used to switch the audio system to a source I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : plugged into the USB input jack in the center console. When a device is plugged into the AUX IN jack while another device is plugged into the USB input jack, the AUX button is used to toggle between the two functions. For more information about the USB input jack, see “USB interface” in this section. EJECT button: button is pressed with a comWhen the pact disc loaded, the compact disc will eject and the last source will be played. button is pressed twice with a When the compact disc loaded, the compact disc will be ejected further for easier CD removal. If the disc is not removed within 20 seconds, the disc will reload. Additional features For more information about the iPod姞 player available with this system, see “iPod姞 player operation without Navigation System (Type B)” in this section. For more information about the USB interface available with this system, see “USB interface (models without Navigation System)” in this section. Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-43 11. SEEK/CATEGORY button 12. CD button 13. FM-AM button *No satellite radio reception is available when the XM button is pressed to access satellite radio stations unless optional satellite receiver and antenna are installed and an XM姞 satellite radio service subscription is active. Satellite radio is not available in Alaska, Hawaii and Guam. FM/AM/SAT RADIO WITH COMPACT DISC (CD) PLAYER (Type B) (if so equipped) For all operation precautions, see “Audio operation precautions” in this section. Audio main operation VOL/ON·OFF control: LHA1473 Type B 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. XM button CD insert slot Display screen CD eject button SETUP button 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. BACK button TUNE/SCROLL knob, AUDIO button Station select (1 - 6) buttons AUX button VOL/ON-OFF control knob I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-44 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position and push the VOL/ON·OFF control knob while the system is off to call up the mode (radio, CD, AUX, USB or iPod姞) that was playing immediately before the system was turned off. To turn the system off, press the VOL/ON·OFF control knob. Turn the VOL/ON·OFF control knob to adjust the volume. This vehicle may be equipped with Speed Volume for audio. When this feature is active, the audio volume changes as the driving speed changes. LHA1486 Audio settings: Press the SETUP button to display the audio settings on the screen. These settings can also be displayed by pressing the AUDIO button (TUNE/SCROLL knob). Use the touchscreen to adjust the following items to the desired setting: Bass, Treble, Balance and Fade: Controls the sound of the audio system. Balance adjusts the sound between the left and right speakers. Fade adjusts the sound between the front and rear speakers. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : LHA1487 Speed Volume: Controls the level to which the volume is adjusted as the vehicle’s driving speed changes. Choose a setting between 1 and 5 or choose 0 to disable the feature entirely. AUX Level: Controls the volume level of incoming sound when an auxiliary device is connected to the system. Available options are Quiet, Medium and Loud. Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-45 FM/AM/SAT radio operation FM·AM button: Press the FM·AM button to change the band as follows: AM → FM1 → FM2 → AM If another audio source is playing when the FM·AM button is pressed, the audio source playing will automatically be turned off and the last radio station played will begin playing. *When the XM button is pressed, the satellite radio mode will be skipped unless an optional satellite receiver and antenna are installed and an XM姞 satellite radio service subscription is active. Satellite radio is not available in Alaska, Hawaii and Guam. If a compact disc is playing when the XM button is pressed, the compact disc will automatically be turned off and the last radio station played will come on. The FM stereo indicator (ST) is shown on the screen during FM stereo reception. When the stereo broadcast signal is weak, the radio automatically changes from stereo to monaural reception. LHA1492 While the radio is in XM mode, the operation can be controlled through the touchscreen. Touch the “Channels” key to display a list of channels. Touch a channel displayed on the list to change to that channel. Touch the “Categories” key to display a list of categories. Touch a category displayed on the list to display options within that category. XM band select: Pressing the XM button will change the band as follows: XM1* → XM2* → XM3* → XM1* (satellite, if so equipped) When the XM button is pressed while the ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position, the radio will come on at the last station played. The last station played will also come on when the VOL/ON-OFF control knob is pressed to turn the radio on. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-46 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems Tuning with the TUNE/SCROLL knob: The radio can also be manually tuned using the TUNE/SCROLL knob. When in FM or AM mode, turn the TUNE/SCROLL knob to the left for lower frequencies or to the right for higher frequencies. When in XM mode, turn the TUNE/SCROLL knob to change the channel. LHA1489 Tuning with the touchscreen: When in AM or FM mode, the radio can be tuned using the touchscreen. To bring up the visual tuner, touch the “Tune” key on the lower right corner of the screen. A screen appears with a bar running from low frequencies on the left to high frequencies on the right. Touch the screen at the location of the frequency you wish to tune and the station will change to that frequency. To return to the regular radio display screen, touch the “OK” key. in FM or AM mode, press the or to SEEK/CATEGORY button tune from low to high or high to low frequencies and to stop at the next broadcasting station. When in XM mode, press the SEEK/CATEGORY button or to change the category. 1 to 6 Station memory operations: Twelve stations can be set for the FM band (6 for FM1, 6 for FM2) and six stations can be set for the AM band. Eighteen stations can be set for the XM band (6 for XM1, 6 for XM2, 6 for XM3). 1. Choose the radio band AM, FM1 or FM2 using the FM·AM select button or choose the radio band XM1, XM2 or XM3 using the XM button. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 3. The channel indicator will then come on and the sound will resume. Programming is now complete. 4. Other buttons can be set in the same manner. SEEK tuning: When 2. Tune to the desired station using manual or seek tuning. Press and hold any of the desired station memory buttons (1 – 6) until a beep sound is heard. If the battery cable is disconnected or if the fuse opens, the radio memory will be canceled. In that case, reset the desired stations. Compact disc (CD) player operation Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position and carefully insert the compact disc into the slot with the label side up. The compact disc is automatically pulled into the slot and starts to play. If the radio is already operating, it automatically turns off and the compact disc begins to play. CD button: When the CD button is pressed with the system off and the compact disc loaded, the system will turn on and the compact disc will start to play. When the CD button is pressed with a compact disc loaded and the radio playing, the radio will automatically be turned off and the compact disc will start to play. Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-47 LHA1488 CD/MP3 display mode While listening to a CD or an MP3/WMA CD, certain text may be displayed (when a CD encoded with text is being used). Depending on how the CD or MP3/WMA CD is encoded, the text is displayed listing the artist, album and song title. There are other keys displayed on the screen when a CD is playing: LHA1490 LHA1491 Random: Touch the “Random” key to apply a random play pattern to the CD. When the random mode is icon will be displayed to the left active, the of the song title. If an MP3 CD is playing, touching “Random” alternates between randomly playing songs within the current folder and songs icon is disfrom the CD as a whole. The played to the left of the song title or folder name to denote which pattern is applied. To cancel Random mode, touch the “Random” key until icon is displayed. no Repeat: Touch the “Repeat” key to apply a repeat play pattern to the CD. When the repeat mode is icon will be displayed to the left active, the of the song title. If an MP3 CD is playing, touching “Repeat” alternates between repeating the current song and repeating the current folder. icon is displayed to the left of the song The title or folder name to denote which pattern is applied. To cancel Repeat mode, touch the “Reicon is displayed. peat” key until no I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-48 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems Browse: Touch the “Browse” key to display the titles on the CD in list format. Touch the title of a song in the list to begin playing that song. If an MP3 CD is playing, touching the “Browse” key will also list the folders on the disc. Follow the procedure for selecting a song with the touchscreen to choose a folder. while Press the SEEK/CATEGORY button a CD or MP3/WMA CD is playing to advance one track. Press the SEEK/CATEGORY several times to skip forward sevbutton eral tracks. If the last track on a CD is skipped, the first track on the disc is played. If the last track in a folder of an MP3/WMA CD is skipped, the first track of the next folder is played. SEEK/CATEGORY (Reverse or Fast Forward) button: Press and hold the SEEK/CATEGORY or for 1.5 seconds while the button compact disc is playing to reverse or fast forward the track being played. The compact disc plays at an increased speed while reversing or fast forwarding. When the button is released, the compact disc returns to normal play speed. LHA1493 AUX button: The AUX IN jack is located in the storage area above the audio system. The AUX IN audio input jack accepts any standard analog audio input such as from a portable cassette tape/CD player, MP3 player or a laptop computer. SEEK/CATEGORY button: Press the AUX button to play a compatible device plugged into the AUX IN jack. The AUX button is also used to switch the audio system to a source plugged into the USB input jack in the center console. When a device is plugged into the AUX IN jack while another device is plugged into the USB input jack, the AUX button is used to toggle between the two functions. Press the SEEK/CATEGORY button while a CD or MP3/WMA CD is playing to return to the beginning of the current track. Press the several times SEEK/CATEGORY button to skip backward several tracks. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-49 For more information about the USB input jack, see “USB interface” in this section. Audio file operation AUX button: EJECT button: Place the ignition switch in the ON or ACC position and press the AUX button to switch to the USB input mode. If another audio source is plugged in through the AUX IN jack on the radio, the AUX button toggles between the two sources. button is pressed with a comWhen the pact disc loaded, the compact disc will eject and the last source will be played. button is pressed twice with a When the compact disc loaded, the compact disc will be ejected further for easier CD removal. If the disc is not removed within 10 seconds, the disc will reload. Additional features For more information about the iPod姞 player available with this system, see “iPod姞 player operation with Navigation System” in this section. For more information about the USB interface available with this system, see “USB interface (models with Navigation System)” in this section. WHA1358 USB INTERFACE (models without Navigation System) (if so equipped) Connecting a device to the USB input jack The USB input jack is located in the center con1 on the USB sole. Open the protective cover 䊊 2 . jack, then insert the USB device into the jack 䊊 When a compatible storage device is plugged into the jack, compatible audio files on the storage device can be played through the vehicle’s audio system. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-50 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems SEEK/CAT (Reverse or Fast Forward) buttons: Press and hold the SEEK/CAT buttons or for 1.5 seconds while an audio file on the USB device is playing to reverse or fast forward the track being played. The track plays at an increased speed while reversing or fast forwarding. When the button is released, the audio file returns to normal play speed. SEEK/CAT buttons: LHA1280 Play information Information about the audio files being played can be displayed on the display screen of the vehicle’s audio system. Depending on how the audio files are encoded, information such as Folder, Song and Artist will be displayed. The track number and number of total tracks in the folder are displayed on the screen as well. For example, the fourth track out of twelve total is currently playing. Press the SEEK/CAT button while an audio file on the USB device is playing to return to the beginning of the current track. Press the several times to skip SEEK/CAT button backward several tracks. while an auPress the SEEK/CAT button dio file on the USB device is playing to advance one track. Press the SEEK/CAT button several times to skip forward several tracks. If the last track in a folder on the USB device is skipped, the first track of the next folder is played. RDM button: When the RDM button is pressed while an audio file on the USB device is playing, the play pattern can be changed as follows: ALL RDM → 1 FOLDER RDM → OFF ALL RDM: all tracks on the USB device will be played randomly. 1 FOLDER RDM: all tracks in the current folder will be played randomly. OFF: No random play pattern is applied. The indicator on the display will turn off. The current play pattern of the USB device is displayed on the screen unless no pattern is applied. RPT button: When the RPT button is pressed while an audio file on the USB device is playing, the play pattern can be changed as follows: 1 FOLDER RPT → 1 TRACK RPT → OFF 1 TRACK RPT: the current track will be repeated. 1 FOLDER RPT: the current folder will be repeated. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : OFF: No repeat play pattern is applied. The indicator on the display will turn off. Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-51 The current play pattern of the USB device is displayed on the screen unless no pattern is applied. Audio file operation TUNE/SCROLL knob: Place the ignition switch in the ON or ACC position and press the AUX button to switch to the USB input mode. If another audio source is playing and a USB memory device is inserted, press the AUX button repeatedly until the center display changes to the USB memory mode. AUX button: If there are multiple folders with audio files on the USB device, turn the TUNE/SCROLL knob to change folders. Turn the knob to the left to skip back a folder. Turn the knob to the right to skip ahead a folder. If there is only one folder of audio files on the USB device, turning the TUNE/SCROLL knob in either direction will return to the first track on the USB device. If the system has been turned off while the USB memory was playing, push the ON-OFF/VOL control knob to restart the USB memory. LHA1500 USB INTERFACE (models with Navigation System) Connecting a device to the USB input jack The USB input jack is located in the center con1 on the USB sole. Open the protective cover 䊊 jack, then insert the USB device into the jack. When a compatible storage device is plugged into the jack, compatible audio files on the storage device can be played through the vehicle’s audio system. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-52 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems while Press the SEEK/CATEGORY button an audio file on the USB device is playing to advance one track. Press the SEEK/CATEGORY several times to skip forward sevbutton eral tracks. If the last track in a folder on the USB device is skipped, the first track of the next folder is played. Press LHA1496 Play information Information about the audio files being played is shown on the display screen of the vehicle’s audio system. Touch “Browse” to display the list of folders and files on the USB device. Touch the name of a song on the screen to begin playing that song. SEEK/CATEGORY button: Press the SEEK/CATEGORY button while an audio file on the USB device is playing to return to the beginning of the current track. Press several the SEEK/CATEGORY button times to skip backward several tracks. and hold the Repeat: Touch the “Repeat” key to apply a repeat play pattern to the USB device. When the repeat mode is active, the icon is displayed to the left of the song title or album name to denote which repeat pattern is applied. To cancel Repeat icon mode, touch the “Repeat” key until no is displayed. SEEK/CATEGORY or for 1.5 seconds while an button audio file on the USB device is playing to reverse or fast forward the track being played. The track plays at an increased speed while reversing or fast forwarding. When the button is released, the audio file returns to normal play speed. Random and repeat play mode: While files on a USB device are playing, the play pattern can be altered so that songs are repeated or played randomly. Random: Touch the “Random” key to apply a random play pattern to the USB device. When the random icon is displayed to the mode is active, the left of the song title or album name to denote which random pattern is applied. To cancel Random mode, touch the “Random” key until icon is displayed. no I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-53 While connected to the vehicle, the iPod姞 can only be operated by the vehicle audio controls. To disconnect the cable from the vehicle outlet, fully depress the center connector button to unlatch the connector and pull the connector straight out of the outlet. To disconnect the cable from the iPod姞, fully depress the side connector buttons and pull the iPod姞 connector straight out of the iPod姞. * iPod姞 is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. Compatibility WHA1355 iPod姞* PLAYER OPERATION WITHOUT NAVIGATION SYSTEM (Type A) (if so equipped) The following models are compatible: ● iPod姞 Classic - 1st through 6th generation ● iPod姞 Mini - 1st and 2nd generation Connecting iPod姞 ● iPod姞 Nano - 1st through 3rd generation The iPod姞 outlet connector is located on the center console. Your vehicle is equipped with the specialized cable for connecting the iPod姞 to your vehicle audio unit. To connect the iPod姞, first open the protective cover from the connector in 1 . Next, connect one end of the center console 䊊 the iPod姞 cable to the iPod姞 and the other end of the cable to the connector in the center console 2 . If compatible, the battery of your iPod姞 is 䊊 charged during the connection to the vehicle. ● iPod姞 Touch - 1st generation ● iPhone姞 - 1st generation Make sure that your iPod姞 firmware is updated to the version indicated above. Audio main operation iPod姞 button: Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position and press the iPod姞 button to switch to the iPod姞 mode. If another audio source is playing and the iPod姞 is connected, press the iPod姞 button to switch to the iPod姞 mode. If the system is turned off while the iPod姞 is playing, the iPod姞 will start when the PWR button is pressed. Top menu item selecting: Press the iPod姞 MENU button while the iPod姞 is connected to show the interface for iPod姞 operation on the audio display. The items can be chosen from the menu list screen by pressing the or while the iPod姞 is SEEK button operational. The display pattern can be changed as follows: Playlists → Artists → Albums → Songs → Podcasts → Genres → Composers → Audiobooks For more information about each item, see the iPod姞 owner’s manual. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-54 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems ENTER and BACK buttons: Press the ENTER button while the top menu is displayed to show program details on the audio or to display. Use the SEEK buttons scroll through the choices and press the ENTER button to make a selection. Press the BACK button to return to the previous display. iPod姞 play information: When the TUNE/FF-REW/FOLDER button is or for less than 1.5 secpressed onds while the iPod姞 is playing, the next track or the beginning of the current track on the iPod姞 will be played. SCAN/RPT button: Press the SCAN/RPT button while a track is playing to change the play pattern as follows: Press the DISP TEXT button for less than 1.5 seconds while a program is playing to change the displayed program information as follows: Excluding Podcast and Audiobook: Excluding Podcast: Podcast: Album Title → Artist Name → Song Title → Normal Mode ALL RPT ←→ TRK RPT ALL RPT → TRK RPT → ALL RDM → ALBUM RDM WHA1358 Podcast: For more information about Podcasts, see the iPod姞 owner’s manual. Album Title → Song Title → Normal Mode Audiobook: For more information about Podcasts, see the iPod姞 owner’s manual. NORMAL → FAST → SLOW TUNE/FF-REW/FOLDER button: When the TUNE/FF-REW/FOLDER button is or for more than 1.5 secpressed onds while the iPod姞 is playing, the iPod姞 will play while fast forwarding or reversing. When the button is released, the iPod姞 will return to the normal play speed. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : iPod姞* PLAYER OPERATION WITHOUT NAVIGATION SYSTEM (Type B) (if so equipped) Connecting iPod姞 To connect an iPod姞 to the vehicle so that the iPod姞 can be controlled with the audio system controls and display screen, use the USB jack located in the center console. Open the protec1 on the USB jack in the center tive cover 䊊 console. Then connect the iPod姞-specific end of the cable to the iPod姞 and the USB end of the 2 on the vehicle. When cable to the USB jack 䊊 the ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position, Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-55 the battery of your iPod姞 (if compatible) is charged during the connection to the vehicle. While connected to the vehicle, the iPod姞 can only be operated by the vehicle audio controls. To disconnect the iPod姞 from the vehicle, remove the USB end of the cable from the USB jack on the vehicle, then remove the cable from the iPod姞. * iPod姞 is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. Compatibility The following models are compatible: ● iPod姞 Classic - 1st through 6th generation ● iPod姞 Mini - 1st and 2nd generation ● iPod姞 Nano - 1st through 3rd generation ● iPod姞 Touch - 1st generation ● iPhone姞 - 1st generation Make sure that your iPod姞 firmware is updated to the version indicated above. Audio main operation ● Songs AUX button: ● Podcasts Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position and press the AUX button repeatedly until the iPod姞 mode is displayed on the screen. ● Genres If another audio source is playing and the iPod姞 is connected, press the AUX button repeatedly to switch to the iPod姞 mode. If the vehicle audio system is turned off while the iPod姞 is playing, the iPod姞 will start when the VOL/ON-OFF control knob is pressed. Interface: The interface for iPod姞 operation shown on the vehicle’s audio system display screen is similar to the iPod姞 interface. Use the TUNE/SCROLL knob and ENTER button to navigate the menus on the screen. The iPod姞 MENU button on the vehicle audio system is used to move up one level in the iPod姞 menus. Depending on the iPod姞 model, the following items may be available on the menu list screen. For further information about each item, see the iPod姞 Owner’s Manual. ● Playlists ● Artists ● Albums I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-56 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems ● Composers ● Audiobooks ● ShuffleSongs SEEK/CAT buttons: or Press the SEEK/CAT buttons skip backward or forward one track. to Press and hold the SEEK/CAT buttons or for 1.5 seconds while a track is playing to reverse or fast forward the track being played. The track plays at an increased speed while reversing or fast forwarding. When the button is released, the track returns to normal play speed. RPT button: Press the RPT button while a track is playing to change the play pattern as follows: 1 TRK RPT → ALL RPT → RPT OFF 1 TRK RPT: the current track will be repeated. ALL RPT: all songs in the current list are repeated. RPT OFF: no repeat play pattern is applied. tery will be charged while connected to the vehicle with the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position. RDM button: Press the RDM button while a track is playing to change the play pattern as follows: While connected to the vehicle, the iPod姞 can only be operated by the vehicle audio controls. TRK SHUFFLE → ALBUM SHUFFLE → SHUFFLE OFF To disconnect the iPod姞 from the vehicle, remove the USB end of the cable from the USB jack on the vehicle, then remove the cable from the iPod姞. TRK SHUFFLE: the tracks in the current list will be played randomly. ALBUM SHUFFLE: the albums in the current list will be played randomly. * iPod姞 is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. SHUFFLE OFF: no random play pattern is applied. Compatibility LHA1500 iPod姞* PLAYER OPERATION WITH NAVIGATION SYSTEM (if so equipped) Connecting iPod姞 The following models are compatible: ● iPod姞 Classic - 5th generation ● iPod姞 Nano - 1st through 2nd generation Make sure that your iPod姞 firmware is updated to the version indicated above. To connect an iPod姞 to the vehicle so that the iPod姞 can be controlled with the audio system controls and display screen, use the USB jack located in the center console. Open the protective cover on the USB jack in the center console and then connect the iPod姞-specific end of the cable to the iPod姞 and the USB end of the cable 1 . If your iPod姞 to the USB jack on the vehicle 䊊 supports charging via a USB connection, its batI nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-57 ● Artists ● Albums ● Genres ● Songs ● Composers ● Audiobooks ● Podcasts SEEK/CATEGORY button: LHA1495 Press the SEEK/CATEGORY button or to skip backward or forward one track. Audio main operation Interface: AUX button: The interface for iPod姞 operation shown on the vehicle’s audio system display screen is similar to the iPod姞 interface. Use the touchscreen, BACK button or the TUNE/SCROLL knob to navigate the menus on the screen. Press and hold the SEEK/CATEGORY or for 1.5 seconds while a button track is playing to reverse or fast forward the track being played. The track plays at an increased speed while reversing or fast forwarding. When the button is released, the track returns to normal play speed. LHA1494 Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position and press the AUX button repeatedly until the iPod姞 mode is displayed on the screen. If another audio source is playing and the iPod姞 is connected, press the AUX button repeatedly to switch to the iPod姞 mode. If the vehicle audio system is turned off while the iPod姞 is playing, the iPod姞 will start when the VOL/ON-OFF control knob is pressed. When the iPod姞 is playing, touch the “Menu” key to bring up the iPod姞 interface. Depending on the iPod姞 model, the following items may be available on the menu list screen. For further information about each item, see the iPod姞 Owner’s Manual. ● Playlists I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-58 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems Random and repeat play mode: While the iPod姞 is playing, the play pattern can be altered so that songs are repeated or played randomly. ● A new disc may be rough on the inner and outer edges. Remove the rough edges by rubbing the inner and outer edges with the side of a pen or pencil as illustrated. Random: Touch the “Random” key to apply a random play pattern to the iPod姞. When the random mode is icon is displayed to the left of active, the the song title or album name to denote which random pattern is applied. To cancel Random mode, touch the “Random” key until no icon is displayed. Repeat: Touch the “Repeat” key to apply a repeat play pattern to the iPod姞. When the repeat mode is icon is displayed to the left of active, the the song title or album name to denote which repeat pattern is applied. To cancel Repeat icon mode, touch the “Repeat” key until no is displayed. LHA0049 CD CARE AND CLEANING ● Handle a CD by its edges. Do not bend the disc. Never touch the surface of the disc. ● Always place the discs in the storage case when they are not being used. ● To clean a disc, wipe the surface from the center to the outer edge using a clean, soft cloth. Do not wipe the disc using a circular motion. ● Do not use a conventional record cleaner or alcohol intended for industrial use. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-59 POWER on/off switch If you have the Type A switch, with the ignition switch placed in the ACC or ON position, push the POWER switch to turn the audio system on or off. If you have the Type B switch, with the ignition switch placed in the ACC or ON position, push the MODE switch to turn the audio system on. MODE select switch (models without Navigation System) LHA0692 WHA0693 Type A 1. 2. 3. 4. Tuning switch MODE select switch POWER on/off switch Volume control switch Type B 1. 2. 3. 4. Tuning switch Phone operation switch POWER on and MODE select switch Volume control switch STEERING WHEEL SWITCH FOR AUDIO CONTROL (if so equipped) The audio system can be operated using the controls on the steering wheel. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-60 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems Push the MODE select switch to change the mode in the following sequence: AM → FM* → SAT** (if so equipped) → CD*** → USB/iPod*** (if so equipped) → AUX*** → AM * When using the MODE switch, the audio mode switches to the FM preset bank (FM1 or FM2) that was last active. To switch between the FM1 and FM2 preset banks, use the controls on the audio system. ** When using the MODE switch, the audio mode switches to the XM preset bank (XM1 or XM2) that was last active. To switch between the XM1 and XM2 preset banks, use the controls on the audio system. *** These modes are only available when compatible media is connected to the system. MODE select switch (models with Navigation System) Push the MODE select switch to change the mode in the following sequence: AM/FM* → XM** → CD*** → USB/AUX*** → AM/FM* * When using the MODE switch, the audio mode switches to the preset bank (AM, FM1 or FM2) that was last active. To switch between the AM, FM1 and FM2 preset banks, use the controls on the audio system. ** When using the MODE switch, the audio mode switches to the XM preset bank (XM1, XM2 or XM3) that was last active. To switch between the XM preset banks, use the controls on the audio system. Tuning Memory change (radio): or Push the tuning switch ( than 1.5 seconds to change presets. ) for less Seek tuning (radio): or ) for more Push the tuning switch ( than 1.5 seconds to seek the next or previous radio station. Next/Previous track (CD): or for less Push the tuning switch than 1.5 seconds to return to the beginning of the present track or skip to the next track. Push several times to skip back or skip through tracks. *** These modes are only available when compatible media is connected to the system. LHA0709 ANTENNA The antenna cannot be shortened, but can be removed. When you need to remove the antenna, B. turn the antenna rod counterclockwise 䊊 To install the antenna rod, turn the antenna rod A and hand tighten. clockwise 䊊 Volume control switch CAUTION Push the volume control switch up or down to increase or decrease the volume. Always properly tighten the antenna rod during installation or the antenna rod may break during vehicle operation. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-61 CAR PHONE OR CB RADIO When installing a CB, ham radio or car phone in your NISSAN, be sure to observe the following precautions; otherwise, the new equipment may adversely affect the engine control system and other electronic parts. WARNING ● A cellular telephone should not be used while driving so full attention may be given to vehicle operation. Some jurisdictions prohibit the use of cellular telephones while driving. ● If you must make a call while your vehicle is in motion, the hands free cellular phone operational mode (if so equipped) is highly recommended. Exercise extreme caution at all times so full attention may be given to vehicle operation. BLUETOOTH姞 HANDS-FREE PHONE SYSTEM (if so equipped) CAUTION ● Keep the antenna as far away as possible from the electronic control modules. ● Keep the antenna wire more than 8 in (20 cm) away from the electronic control system harnesses. Do not route the antenna wire next to any harness. ● Adjust the antenna standing-wave ratio as recommended by the manufacturer. ● Connect the ground wire from the CB radio chassis to the body. ● For details, consult a NISSAN dealer. ● If you are unable to devote full attention to vehicle operation while talking on the phone, pull off the road to a safe location and stop your vehicle. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-62 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems WARNING ● Use a phone after stopping your vehicle in a safe location. If you have to use a phone while driving, exercise extreme caution at all times so full attention may be given to vehicle operation. ● If you are unable to devote full attention to vehicle operation while talking on the phone, pull off the road to a safe location and stop your vehicle. CAUTION To avoid discharging the vehicle battery, use a phone after starting the engine. the ignition switch is placed in the ON position with the previously connected cellular phone turned on and carried in the vehicle. You can connect up to 5 different Bluetooth姞 cellular phones to the in-vehicle phone module. However, you can talk on only one cellular phone at a time. Before using the Bluetooth姞 Hands-Free Phone System, refer to the following notes. ● Set up the wireless connection between a cellular phone and the in-vehicle phone module before using the hands-free phone system. ● Some Bluetooth姞 enabled cellular phones may not be recognized by the in-vehicle phone module. Please visit www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for a recommended phone list and connecting instructions. ● You will not be able to use a hands-free phone under the following conditions: WHA1356 Your NISSAN is equipped with the Bluetooth姞 Hands-Free Phone System. If you have a compatible Bluetooth姞 enabled cellular phone, you can set up the wireless connection between your cellular phone and the in-vehicle phone module. With Bluetooth姞 wireless technology, you can make or receive a hands-free telephone call with your cellular phone in the vehicle. Once your cellular phone is connected to the invehicle phone module, no other phone connecting procedure is required. Your phone is automatically connected with the in-vehicle phone module when I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : – Your vehicle is outside of the cellular service area. – Your vehicle is in an area where it is difficult to receive a cellular signal; such as in a tunnel, in an underground parking garage, near a tall building or in a mountainous area. Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-63 – Your cellular phone is locked to prevent it from being dialed. ● Refer to the cellular phone Owner’s Manual regarding the telephone charges, cellular phone antenna and body, etc. ● When the radio wave condition is not ideal or ambient sound is too loud, it may be difficult to hear the other person’s voice during a call. REGULATORY INFORMATION ● Do not place the cellular phone in an area surrounded by metal or far away from the in-vehicle phone module to prevent tone quality degradation and wireless connection disruption. – CAUTION: To maintain compliance with FCC’s RF exposure guidelines, use only the supplied antenna. Unauthorized antenna, modification, or attachments could damage the transmitter and may violate FCC regulations. ● While a cellular phone is connected through the Bluetooth姞 wireless connection, the battery power of the cellular phone may discharge quicker than usual. The Bluetooth姞 Hands-Free Phone System cannot charge cellular phones. ● If the hands-free phone system seems to be malfunctioning, see “Troubleshooting guide” later in this section. You can also visit www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for troubleshooting help. ● Some cellular phones or other devices may cause interference or a buzzing noise to come from the audio system speakers. Storing the device in a different location may reduce or eliminate the noise. BLUETOOTH威 is a trademark owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc., U.S.A. and licensed to Visteon. FCC Regulatory information – Operation is subject to the following two conditions: USING THE SYSTEM The NISSAN Voice Recognition system allows hands-free operation of the Bluetooth姞 Phone System. If the vehicle is in motion, some commands may not be available so full attention may be given to vehicle operation. 1. This device may not cause interference and Initialization 2. this device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, NISSAN Voice Recognition is initialized, button is which takes a few seconds. If the pressed before the initialization completes, the system will announce “Hands-free phone system not ready” and will not react to voice commands. IC Regulatory information – Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. – This Class B digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian InterferenceCausing Equipment Regulations. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-64 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems Operating tips To get the best performance out of the NISSAN Voice Recognition system, observe the following: ● If a command is not recognized, the system announces, “Command not recognized. Please try again.” Repeat the command in a clear voice. ● Keep the interior of the vehicle as quiet as possible. Close the windows to eliminate surrounding noises (traffic noises, vibration sounds, etc.), which may prevent the system from recognizing voice commands correctly. ● If you want to go back to the previous command, you can say “Go back” or “Correction” any time the system is waiting for a response. ● Wait until the tone sounds before speaking a command. Otherwise, the command will not be received properly. ● You can cancel a command when the system is waiting for a response by saying, “Cancel” or “Quit.” The system announces “Cancel” and ends the VR session. You can button on the also press and hold the steering wheel for 5 seconds at any time to end the VR session. Whenever the VR session is cancelled, a double beep is played to indicate you have exited the system. ● Start speaking a command within 5 seconds after the tone sounds. ● Speak in a natural voice without pausing between words. Giving voice commands To operate NISSAN Voice Recognition, press and release the button located on the steering wheel. After the tone sounds, speak a command. The command given is picked up by the microphone, and voice feedback is given when the command is accepted. ● If you need to hear the available commands for the current menu again, say “Help” and the system will repeat them. ● If you want to adjust the volume of the voice feedback, press the volume control switches (+ or -) on the steering wheel while being provided with feedback. You can also use the radio volume control knob. ● In most cases you can interrupt the voice feedback to speak the next command by button on the steering pressing the wheel. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ● To use the system faster, you may speak the second level commands with the main menu command on the main menu. For example, button and after the tone press the say, “Call Redial.” NOTE: The combined command of Call and (a Name) cannot be used. How to say numbers NISSAN Voice Recognition requires a certain way to speak numbers in voice commands. Refer to the following rules and examples. ● Either “zero” or “oh” can be used for “0”. Example: 1-800-662-6200 – “One eight oh oh six six two six two oh oh”, or – “One eight zero zero six six two six two oh oh” ● Words can be used for the first 4 digits places only. Example: 1-800-662-6200 – “One eight hundred six six two six two oh oh”, Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-65 – NOT “One eight hundred six six two sixty two hundred,” and – NOT “One eight oh oh six six two sixty two hundred” ● Numbers can be spoken in small groups. The system will prompt you to continue entering digits, if desired. Example: 1-555-1212 *123 – “One five five five one two one two star one two three” ● Say “plus” for “+” (available only when using the “Special Dialing” command). ● Say “pause” for a 2-second pause (available only when storing a phone book number). Example: 1-800-662-6200 – “One eight zero zero” The system repeats the numbers and prompts you to enter more. – “six six two” The system repeats the numbers and prompts you to enter more. NOTE: For best results, say phone numbers as single digits. The voice command “Help” is available at any time. Please use the “Help” command to get information on how to use the system. LHA0707 CONTROL BUTTONS The control buttons for the Bluetooth姞 HandsFree Phone System are located on the steering wheel. – “six two zero zero” ● Say “pound” for “#”. Say “star” for “*” (available when using the “Special Dialing” command and the “Send” command during a call). PHONE/SEND Press the button to initiate a VR session or answer an incoming call. See “List of voice commands” and “Special Dialing” in this section for more information. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-66 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems You can also use the button to interrupt the system feedback and give a command at once. See “List of voice commands” and “During a call” in this section for more information. PHONE/END While the voice recognition system is active, press and hold the button for 5 seconds to quit the voice recognition system at any time. TUNING SWITCH While using the voice recognition system, tilt the tuning switch up or down to manually control the phone system. GETTING STARTED The following procedures will help you get started using the Bluetooth姞 Hands-Free Phone System with NISSAN Voice Recognition. For additional command options, refer to “List of voice commands” in this section. Choosing a language NOTE: You can interact with the Bluetooth姞 Hands-Free Phone System using English, Spanish or French. You must press the button within 5 seconds to change the language. To change the language, perform the following. 5. If you decide not to change the language, do not press either button. After 5 seconds, the VR session will end, and the language will not be changed. button for more 1. Press and hold the than 5 seconds. 2. The system announces: “Press the ) button for the PHONE/SEND ( hands-free phone system to enter the speaker adaptation mode or press the ) button to select a difPHONE/END ( ferent language.” button. 3. Press the For information on speaker adaptation, see “Speaker adaptation (SA) mode” in this section. 4. The system announces the current language and gives you the option to change the language to Spanish (in Spanish) or French (in French). To select the current language, ) button. To press the PHONE/SEND ( select a different language, tilt the tuning switch ( or ) up or down. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Connecting procedure NOTE: The connecting procedure must be performed when the vehicle is stationary. If the vehicle starts moving during the procedure, the procedure will be cancelled. Main Menu A “Connect phone” 䊊 B “Add phone” 䊊 C Initiate from handset 䊊 D Name phone 䊊 1. Press the button on the steering wheel. The system announces the available commands. A . The system ac2. Say: “Connect phone” 䊊 knowledges the command and announces the next set of available commands. Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-67 B . The system acknowl3. Say: “Add phone” 䊊 edges the command and asks you to initiate C. connecting from the phone handset 䊊 The connecting procedure of the cellular phone varies according to each cellular phone model. See the cellular phone Owner’s Manual for details. You can also visit www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for instructions on connecting NISSAN recommended cellular phones. When prompted for a Passkey code, enter “1234” from the handset. The Passkey code “1234” has been assigned by NISSAN and cannot be changed. 4. The system asks you to say a name for the D. phone 䊊 If the name is too long or too short, the system tells you, then prompts you for a name again. Also, if more than one phone is connected and the name sounds too much like a name already used, the system tells you, then prompts you for a name again. Making a call by entering a phone number Main Menu A “Call” 䊊 four” as the 3rd group. For dialing more than 10 digits or any special characters, say “Special Dialing”. See “How to say numbers” in this section for more information. B “Phone Number” 䊊 5. When you have finished speaking the phone number, the system repeats it back and announces the available commands. D “Dial” 䊊 D . The system acknowledges 6. Say: “Dial” 䊊 the command and makes the call. C Speak the digits 䊊 1. Press the button on the steering wheel. A tone will sound. A . The system acknowledges 2. Say: “Call” 䊊 the command and announces the next set of available commands. Say: “Special Dialing” to dial more than 10 digits or any special characters. B . The system ac3. Say “Phone Number” 䊊 knowledges the command and announces the next set of available commands. 4. Say the number you wish to call starting with C . If the the area code in single digit format 䊊 system has trouble recognizing the correct phone number, try entering the number in the following groups: 3-digit area code, 3-digit prefix and the last 4-digits. For example, 555-121-3354 can be said as “five five five” as the 1st group, then “one two one” as the 2nd group, and “three three five I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-68 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems For additional command options, see “List of voice commands” in this section. Receiving a call When you hear the ring tone, press the button on the steering wheel. Once the call has ended, press the on the steering wheel. button NOTE: If you do not wish to take the call when you button hear the ring tone, press the on the steering wheel. For additional command options, see “List of voice commands” later in this section. LIST OF VOICE COMMANDS Main Menu “Call” B (Speak Digits) 䊊 “Call” Main Menu “Call” “Phonebook” A (Speak name) 䊊 “Recent Calls” “Phone Number” “Connect Phone” When you press and release the button on the steering wheel, you can choose from the commands on the Main Menu. The following pages describe these commands and the commands in each sub-menu. Remember to wait for the tone before speaking. After the main menu, you can say “Help” to hear the list of commands currently available any time the system is waiting for a response. B (Speak Digits) 䊊 C “Special Number” 䊊 D “Redial” 䊊 E “Call Back” 䊊 A (Speak Name) 䊊 If you have stored entries in the phonebook, you can dial a number associated with a name and location. See “Phonebook” in this section to learn how to store entries. If you want to end an action without completing it, you can say “Cancel” or “Quit” at any time the system is waiting for a response. The system will end the VR session. Whenever the VR session is cancelled, a double beep is played to indicate you have exited the system. When prompted by the system, say the name of the phone book entry you wish to call. The system acknowledges the name. If you want to go back to the previous command, you can say “Go back” or “Correction” any time the system is waiting for a response. Once you have confirmed the name and location, the system begins the call. If there are multiple locations associated with the name, the system asks you to choose the location. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : When prompted by the system, say the number you wish to call. Refer to “How to say numbers” and “Making a call by entering a phone number” in this section for more details. C “Special Number” 䊊 For dialing more than 10 digits or any special characters, say “Special Number”. When the system acknowledges the command, the system will prompt you to speak the number. D “Redial” 䊊 Use the Redial command to call the last number that was dialed. The system acknowledges the command, repeats the number and begins dialing. If a redial number does not exist, the system announces, “There is no number to redial” and ends the VR session. E “Call back” 䊊 Use the Call Back command to dial the number of the last incoming call within the vehicle. The system acknowledges the command, repeats the number and begins dialing. Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-69 If a call back number does not exist, the system announces, “There is no number to call back” and ends the VR session. During a call During a call there are several command options button on the steering available. Press the wheel to mute the receiving voice and enter commands. ● “Help” — The system announces the available commands. ● “Go back/Correction” — The system announces “Go back,” ends the VR session and returns to the call. ● “Cancel/Quit” — The system announces “Cancel,” ends the VR session and returns to the call. ● “Send/Enter/Call/Dial” — Use the Send command to enter numbers, “*” or “#” during a call. For example, if you were directed to dial an extension by an automated system: ● “Transfer call” — Use the Transfer Call command to transfer the call from the Bluetooth姞 Hands-Free Phone System to the cellular phone when privacy is desired. The system announces, “Transfer call. Call transferred to privacy mode.” The system then ends the VR session. To reconnect the call from the cellular phone to the Bluetooth姞 Hands-Free System, button. press the NOTE: The “Transfer Entry” command is not available when the vehicle is moving. Main Menu “Phonebook” A “Transfer Entry” 䊊 ● “Mute” — Use the Mute command to mute your voice so the other party cannot hear it. Use the mute command again to unmute your voice. NOTE: If a call is ended or the cellular phone network connection is lost while the Mute feature is on, the Mute feature will be reset to “off” for the next call so the other party can hear your voice. B “Delete Entry” 䊊 C “List Names” 䊊 For phones that do not support automatic download of the phonebook (PBAP Bluetooth姞 profile), the “Phonebook” command is used to manually add entries to the vehicle phonebook. The phonebook stores up to 40 names for each phone connected to the system. NOTE: Each phone has its own separate phonebook. You cannot access Phone A’s phonebook if you are currently connected with Phone B. Say: “Send one two three four.” The system acknowledges the command and sends the tones associated with the numbers. The system then ends the VR session and returns to the call. Say “star” for “*”, Say “pound” for “#”. “Phonebook” (phones without automatic phonebook download function) I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-70 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems A “Transfer entry” 䊊 Use the Transfer Entry command to store a new name in the system. When prompted by the system, say the name you would like to give the new entry. For example, say: “Mary.” If the name is too long or too short, the system tells you, then prompts you for a name again. Also, if the name sounds too much like a name already stored, the system tells you, then prompts you for a name again. The system will ask you to transfer a phone number stored in the cellular phone’s memory. Enter a phone number by voice command: For example, say: “five five five one two one two.” See “How to say numbers” in this section for more information. To transfer a phone number stored in the cellular phone’s memory: Say “Transfer entry.” The system acknowledges the command and asks you to initiate the transfer from the phone handset. The new contact phone number will be transferred from the cellular phone via the Bluetooth姞 communication link. The transfer procedure varies according to each cellular phone. See the cellular phone Owner’s Manual for details. You can also visit www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for instructions on transferring phone numbers from NISSAN recommended cellular phones. “Phonebook” (phones with automatic phonebook download function) The system repeats the number and prompts you for the next command. When you have finished entering numbers or transferring an entry, choose “Store.” The “Transfer Entry” command is not available when the vehicle is moving. The system confirms the name, location and number. B “Delete Entry” 䊊 Use the Delete Entry command to erase one entry from the phonebook. After the system recognizes the command, speak the name to delete or say “List Names” to choose an entry. C “List names” 䊊 Use the List Names command to hear all the names in the phonebook. The system recites the phonebook entries but does not include the actual phone numbers. When the playback of the list is complete, the system goes back to the main menu. You can stop the playback of the list at any time button on the steering by pressing the wheel. The system ends the VR session. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : NOTE: Main Menu “Phonebook” A “List Names” 䊊 B “Transfer Entry” 䊊 C “Delete Entry” 䊊 D “Record Name” 䊊 For phones that support automatic download of the phonebook (PBAP Bluetooth姞 profile), the “Phonebook” command is used to manage entries in the vehicle phonebook. You can say the name of an entry at this menu to initiate dialing of that entry. The phonebook stores up to 1000 names for each phone connected to the system. When a phone is connected to the system, the phonebook is automatically downloaded to the vehicle. This feature allows you to access your phonebook from the Bluetooth姞 system and call contacts by name. You can record a custom voice tag for contact names that the system has difficulty recognizing. For more information see “Record Name” in this section. Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-71 NOTE: Each phone has its own separate phonebook. You cannot access Phone A’s phonebook if you are currently connected with Phone B. A “List names” 䊊 Use the List Names command to hear all the names and locations in the phone book. The system recites the phone book entries but does not include the actual phone numbers. When the playback of the list is complete, the system goes back to the main menu. You can stop the playback of the list at any time button on the steering by pressing the wheel. The system ends the VR session. See the “Record Name” command in this section for information about recording custom voice tags for list entries that the system has difficulty pronouncing. B “Transfer entry” 䊊 Use the Transfer Entry command to store a new name in the system. When prompted by the system, say the name you would like to give the new entry. If the name is too long or too short, the system tells you, then prompts you for a name again. Also, if the name sounds too much like a name already stored, the system tells you, then prompts you for a name again. The system will ask you to transfer a phone number stored in the cellular phone’s memory. Enter a phone number by voice command: For example, say: “five five five one two one two.” See “How to say numbers” in this section for more information. To transfer a phone number stored in the cellular phone’s memory: Say “Transfer entry.” The system acknowledges the command and asks you to initiate the transfer from the phone handset. The new contact phone number will be transferred from the cellular phone via the Bluetooth姞 communication link. The transfer procedure varies according to each cellular phone. See the cellular phone Owner’s Manual for details. You can also visit www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for instructions on transferring phone numbers from NISSAN recommended cellular phones. The system repeats the number and prompts you for the next command. When you have finished entering numbers or transferring an entry, choose “Store.” The system confirms the name, location and number. C “Delete Entry” 䊊 Use the Delete Entry command to erase one entry from the phonebook. After the system recognizes the command, speak the name to delete or say “List Names” to choose an entry. D “Record name” 䊊 The system allows you to record custom voice tags for contact names in the phonebook that the vehicle has difficulty recognizing. This feature can also be used to record voice tags to directly dial an entry with multiple numbers. Up to 40 voice tags can be recorded to the system. “Recent Calls” Main Menu “Recent Calls” A “Outgoing” 䊊 B “Incoming” 䊊 C “Missed” 䊊 For example, say: “Mary.” I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-72 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems Use the Recent Calls command to access outgoing, incoming or missed calls. A “Outgoing” 䊊 Use the Outgoing command to list the outgoing calls made from the vehicle. B “Incoming” 䊊 Use the Incoming command to list the incoming calls made to the vehicle. C “Missed” 䊊 Use the Missed command to list the calls made to the vehicle that were not answered. Use the Connect Phone commands to manage the phones connecting to the vehicle or to enable the Bluetooth姞 function on the vehicle. A “Add Phone” 䊊 Use the Add Phone command to add a phone to the vehicle. See “Connecting procedure” in this section for more information. B “Select Phone” 䊊 Use the Select Phone command to select from a list of phones connected to the vehicle. The system will list the names assigned to each phone and then prompt you for the phone you wish to select. Only one phone can be active at a time. “Connect Phone” C “Delete Phone” 䊊 NOTE: Use the Delete Phone command to delete a phone that is connected to the vehicle. The system will list the names assigned to each phone and then prompt you for the phone you wish to delete. Deleting a phone from the vehicle will also delete that phonebook for that phone. The Add Phone command is not available when the vehicle is moving. Main Menu “Connect Phone” A “Add Phone” 䊊 B “Select Phone” 䊊 C “Delete Phone” 䊊 D “Turn Bluetooth OFF” 䊊 Use the Turn Bluetooth OFF command to prevent a wireless connection to your phone. SPEAKER ADAPTATION (SA) MODE Speaker Adaptation allows up to two out-ofdialect users to train the system to improve recognition accuracy. By repeating a number of commands, the users can create a voice model of their own voice that is stored in the system. The system is capable of storing a different speaker adaptation model for each connected phone. Training procedure The procedure for training a voice is as follows. 1. Position the vehicle in a reasonably quiet outdoor location. 2. Sit in the driver’s seat with the engine running, the parking brake on, and the transmission in P (Park). 3. Press and hold the than 5 seconds. button for more 4. The system announces: “Press the ) button for the PHONE/SEND ( hands-free phone system to enter the speaker adaptation mode or press the ) button to select a difPHONE/END ( ferent language.” D “Turn Bluetooth OFF” 䊊 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-73 5. Press the button. For information on selecting a different language, see “Choosing a language” in this section. Training phrases During the SA mode, the system instructs the trainer to say the following phrases. (The system will prompt you for each phrase.) ● call three one nine oh two ● nine seven pause pause three oh eight ● cancel ● call back number 6. Voice memory A or memory B is selected automatically. If both memory locations are already in use, the system will prompt you to overwrite one. Follow the instructions provided by the system. ● phonebook transfer entry ● call star two zero nine five ● dial three oh four two nine ● delete phone ● delete call back number ● dial eight three zero five one ● incoming 7. When preparation is complete and you are button. ready to begin, press the ● record name ● transfer entry ● four three pause two nine pause zero 8. The SA mode will be explained. Follow the instructions provided by the system. ● eight pause nine three two pause seven ● delete redial number ● delete all entries ● phonebook list names ● call seven two four zero nine ● call eight oh five four one ● phonebook delete entry ● correction ● next entry ● connect phone 9. When training is finished, the system will tell you an adequate number of phrases have been recorded. 10. The system will announce that speaker adaptation has been completed and the system is ready. The SA mode will stop if: ● dial star two one seven oh ● yes ● dial seven four oh one eight ● previous entry ● delete ● no ● dial nine seven two six six button is pressed for more than 5 ● The seconds in SA mode. ● select ● The vehicle begins moving during SA mode. ● dial eight five six nine two ● The ignition switch is placed in the OFF or LOCK position. ● Bluetooth on ● call seven six three oh one ● missed ● outgoing I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-74 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems ● go back ● call five six two eight zero ● dial six six four three seven MANUAL CONTROL While using the voice recognition system, it is possible to select menu options by using the steering wheel controls instead of speaking voice commands. The manual control mode does not allow dialing a phone number by digits. The user may select an entry from the Phonebook or Recent Calls lists. To re-activate voice recognition, exit the manual control mode by pressing and ) button. At that holding the PHONE/END ( time, pressing the PHONE/SEND ( ) button will start the Hands Free Phone System. Operating tips ● To enter manual control mode, start the voice recognition system and tilt the tuning ) switch up or down. The system will ( speak ⬙Showing Manual Options⬙ when manual controls are initially activated. ● To browse the menu options, tilt the tuning ) switch up or down. The system will ( always speak the current menu option. Depending on the audio display, it will also show the current menu option. ● To select the current menu option, press the ) button. PHONE/SEND ( ● To go back to the previous menu, press the ) button. If the current PHONE/END ( menu is the Main Menu, pressing the ) button will exit the PHONE/END ( Phone system. ● To exit the manual control mode, press and ) button for 5 hold the PHONE/END ( seconds. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 4-75 TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE The system should respond correctly to all voice commands without difficulty. If problems are encountered, try the following solutions. Where the solutions are listed by number, try each solution in turn, starting with number 1, until the problem is resolved. Symptom System fails to interpret the command correctly. The system consistently selects the wrong entry from the phone book. Solution 1. Ensure that the command is valid. See “List of voice commands” in this section. 2. Ensure that the command is spoken after the tone. 3. Speak clearly without pausing between words and at a level appropriate to the ambient noise level in the vehicle. 4. Ensure that the ambient noise level is not excessive (for example, windows open or defroster on). NOTE: If it is too noisy to use the phone, it is likely that the voice commands will not be recognized. 5. If more than one command was said at a time, try saying the commands separately. 6. If the system consistently fails to recognize commands, the voice training procedure should be carried out to improve the recognition response for the speaker. See “Speaker adaptation (SA) mode” in this section. 1. Ensure that the phone book entry name requested matches what was originally stored. This can be confirmed by using the “List Names” command. See “Phonebook” in this section. 2. Replace one of the names being confused with a new name. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4-76 Display screen, heater, air conditioner, audio and phone systems 5 Starting and driving Precautions when starting and driving. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2 Exhaust gas (carbon monoxide) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2 Three-way catalyst. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3 Avoiding collision and rollover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5 Off-road recovery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5 Rapid air pressure loss . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6 Drinking alcohol/drugs and driving. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6 Ignition switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7 NISSAN Intelligent Key™ (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . 5-7 Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8 Manual transmission (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9 Ignition switch positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10 NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10 Before starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11 Starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11 Driving the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12 Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12 Manual transmission (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-17 Parking brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19 Cruise control (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20 Precautions on cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20 Cruise control operations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21 Break-in schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-22 Increasing fuel economy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-22 Parking/parking on hills. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23 Power steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24 Brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24 Brake precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24 Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-25 Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-26 Cold weather driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-28 Freeing a frozen door lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-28 Anti-freeze . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-28 Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-28 Draining of coolant water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-28 Tire equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-28 Special winter equipment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-28 Driving on snow or ice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-28 Engine block heater (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-29 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : PRECAUTIONS WHEN STARTING AND DRIVING WARNING ● Do not leave children or adults who would normally require the assistance of others alone in your vehicle. Pets should also not be left alone. They could accidentally injure themselves or others through inadvertent operation of the vehicle. Also, on hot, sunny days, temperatures in a closed vehicle could quickly become high enough to cause severe or possibly fatal injuries to people or animals. ● Closely supervise children when they are around cars to prevent them from playing and becoming locked in the trunk where they could be seriously injured. Keep the car locked, with the rear seatback and trunk lid securely latched when not in use, and prevent children’s access to car keys. EXHAUST GAS (carbon monoxide) WARNING ● Do not breathe exhaust gases; they contain colorless and odorless carbon monoxide. Carbon monoxide is dangerous. It can cause unconsciousness or death. 5-2 Starting and driving ● If you suspect that exhaust fumes are entering the vehicle, drive with all windows fully open, and have the vehicle inspected immediately. ● Do not run the engine in closed spaces such as a garage. ● Do not park the vehicle with the engine running for any extended length of time. ● Keep the trunk lid closed while driving, otherwise exhaust gases could be drawn into the passenger compartment. If you must drive with the trunk lid open, follow these precautions: 1. Open all the windows. air recirculation but2. Set the ton to off and the fan control dial to HI to circulate the air. ● If electrical wiring or other cable connections must pass to a trailer through the seal on the trunk lid or the body, follow the manufacturer’s recommendation to prevent carbon monoxide entry into the vehicle. ● The exhaust system and body should be inspected by a qualified mechanic whenever: I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : a. The vehicle is raised for service. b. You suspect that exhaust fumes are entering into the passenger compartment. c. You notice a change in the sound of the exhaust system. d. You have had an accident involving damage to the exhaust system, underbody, or rear of the vehicle. THREE-WAY CATALYST The three-way catalyst is an emission control device installed in the exhaust system. Exhaust gases in the three-way catalyst are burned at high temperatures to help reduce pollutants. WARNING ● The exhaust gas and the exhaust system are very hot. Keep people, animals or flammable materials away from the exhaust system components. ● Do not stop or park the vehicle over flammable materials such as dry grass, waste paper or rags. They may ignite and cause a fire. CAUTION ● Do not use leaded gasoline. Deposits from leaded gasoline will seriously reduce the three-way catalyst’s ability to help reduce exhaust pollutants. ● Keep your engine tuned up. Malfunctions in the ignition, fuel injection, or electrical systems can cause overrich fuel flow into the three-way catalyst, causing it to overheat. Do not keep driving if the engine misfires, or if noticeable loss of performance or other unusual operating conditions are detected. Have the vehicle inspected promptly by a NISSAN dealer. ● Avoid driving with an extremely low fuel level. Running out of fuel could cause the engine to misfire, damaging the three-way catalyst. ● Do not race the engine while warming it up. ● Do not push or tow your vehicle to start the engine. TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS) (if so equipped) Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.) As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should stop and check all 4 tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s handling and stopping ability. Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : even if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale. Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists. When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly. Additional information: ● The TPMS does not monitor the tire pressure of the spare tire. Starting and driving 5-3 ● The TPMS will activate only when the vehicle is driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h). Also, this system may not detect a sudden drop in tire pressure (for example a flat tire while driving). ● The low tire pressure warning light does not automatically turn off when the tire pressure is adjusted for all 4 tires. After the tires are inflated to the recommended pressure, the vehicle must be driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h) to activate the TPMS and turn off the low tire pressure warning light. Use a tire pressure gauge to check the tire pressure. ● Tire pressure rises and falls depending on the heat caused by the vehicle’s operation and the outside temperature. Low outside temperature can lower the temperature of the air inside the tire which can cause a lower tire inflation pressure. This may cause the low tire pressure warning light to illuminate. If the warning light illuminates in low ambient temperature, check the tire pressure for all four tires. ● The Tire and Loading Information label (also referred to as the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label) is located in the driver’s door opening. 5-4 Starting and driving For additional information, see “Low tire pressure warning light” in the “Instruments and controls” section and “Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)” in the “In case of emergency” section. WARNING ● If the low tire pressure warning light illuminates while driving, avoid sudden steering maneuvers or abrupt braking, reduce vehicle speed, pull off the road to a safe location and stop the vehicle as soon as possible. Driving with underinflated tires may permanently damage the tires and increase the likelihood of tire failure. Serious vehicle damage could occur and may lead to an accident and could result in serious personal injury. Check the tire pressure for all four tires. Adjust the tire pressure to the recommended COLD tire pressure shown on the Tire and Loading Information label, located on the driver’s door opening, to turn the low tire pressure warning light OFF. If you have a flat tire, replace it with a spare tire as soon as possible. (See “Flat tire” in the “In case of emergency” section for changing a flat tire.) I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ● When a spare tire is mounted or a wheel is replaced, the TPMS will not function and the low tire pressure warning light will flash for approximately 1 minute. The light will remain on after 1 minute. Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon as possible for tire replacement and/or system resetting. ● Replacing tires with those not originally specified by NISSAN could affect the proper operation of the TPMS. ● Do not inject any tire liquid or aerosol tire sealant into the tires, as this may cause a malfunction of the tire pressure sensors. CAUTION Do not place metalized film or any metal parts (antenna, etc.) on the windows. This may cause poor reception of the signals from the tire pressure sensors, and the TPMS will not function properly. Some devices and transmitters may temporarily interfere with the operation of the TPMS and cause the low tire pressure warning light to illuminate. Some examples are: – Facilities or electric devices using similar radio frequencies are near the vehicle. – If a transmitter set to similar frequencies is being used in or near the vehicle. – If a computer (or similar equipment) or a DC/AC converter is being used in or near the vehicle. FCC Notice: Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules and RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. AVOIDING COLLISION AND ROLLOVER WARNING Failure to operate this vehicle in a safe and prudent manner may result in loss of control or an accident. Be alert and drive defensively at all times. Obey all traffic regulations. Avoid excessive speed, high speed cornering, or sudden steering maneuvers, because these driving practices could cause you to lose control of your vehicle. As with any vehicle, loss of control could result in a collision with other vehicles or objects or cause the vehicle to roll over, particularly if the loss of control causes the vehicle to slide sideways. Be attentive at all times, and avoid driving when tired. Never drive when under the influence of alcohol or drugs (including prescription or over-the-counter drugs which may cause drowsiness). Always wear your seat belt as outlined in the “Safety – Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system” section of this manual, and also instruct your passengers to do so. Seat belts help reduce the risk of injury in collisions and rollovers. In a rollover crash, an unbelted or improperly belted person is significantly more likely to be injured or killed than a person properly wearing a seat belt. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : OFF-ROAD RECOVERY While driving, the right side or left side wheels may unintentionally leave the road surface. If this occurs, maintain control of the vehicle by following the procedure below. Please note that this procedure is only a general guide. The vehicle must be driven as appropriate based on the conditions of the vehicle, road and traffic. 1. Remain calm and do not overreact. 2. Do not apply the brakes. 3. Maintain a firm grip on the steering wheel with both hands and try to hold a straight course. 4. When appropriate , slowly release the accelerator pedal to gradually slow the vehicle. 5. If there is nothing in the way, steer the vehicle to follow the road while vehicle speed is reduced. Do not attempt to drive the vehicle back onto the road surface until vehicle speed is reduced. 6. When it is safe to do so, gradually turn the steering wheel until both tires return to the road surface. When all tires are on the road surface, steer the vehicle to stay in the appropriate driving lane. Starting and driving 5-5 ● If you decide that it is not safe to return the vehicle to the road surface based on vehicle, road or traffic conditions, gradually slow the vehicle to a stop in a safe place off the road. RAPID AIR PRESSURE LOSS Rapid air pressure loss or a “blow-out” can occur if the tire is punctured or is damaged due to hitting a curb or pothole. Rapid air pressure loss can also be caused by driving on under-inflated tires. Rapid air pressure loss can affect the handling and stability of the vehicle, especially at highway speeds. Help prevent rapid air pressure loss by maintaining the correct air pressure and visually inspect the tires for wear and damage. See “Wheels and tires” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual. If a tire rapidly loses air pressure or “blows-out” while driving, maintain control of the vehicle by following the procedure below. Please note that this procedure is only a general guide. The vehicle must be driven as appropriate based on the conditions of the vehicle, road and traffic. 5-6 Starting and driving WARNING The following actions can increase the chance of losing control of the vehicle if there is a sudden loss of tire air pressure. Losing control of the vehicle may cause a collision and result in personal injury. ● The vehicle generally moves or pulls in the direction of the flat tire. ● Do not rapidly apply the brakes. ● Do not rapidly release the accelerator pedal. ● Do not rapidly turn the steering wheel. 1. Remain calm and do not over react. 2. Maintain a firm grip on the steering wheel with both hands and try to hold a straight course. 3. When appropriate, slowly release the accelerator pedal to gradually slow the vehicle. 4. Gradually steer the vehicle to a safe location off the road and away from traffic if possible. 5. Lightly apply the brake pedal to gradually stop the vehicle. 6. Turn on the hazard warning flashers and either contact a roadside emergency service to change the tire or see “Changing a flat tire” in the “In case of emergency” section of this manual. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : DRINKING ALCOHOL/DRUGS AND DRIVING WARNING Never drive under the influence of alcohol or drugs. Alcohol in the bloodstream reduces coordination, delays reaction time and impairs judgement. Driving after drinking alcohol increases the likelihood of being involved in an accident injuring yourself and others. Additionally, if you are injured in an accident, alcohol can increase the severity of the injury. NISSAN is committed to safe driving. However, you must choose not to drive under the influence of alcohol. Every year thousands of people are injured or killed in alcohol-related accidents. Although the local laws vary on what is considered to be legally intoxicated, the fact is that alcohol affects all people differently and most people underestimate the effects of alcohol. Remember, drinking and driving don’t mix! And that is true for drugs, too (over-the-counter, prescription, and illegal drugs). Don’t drive if your ability to operate your vehicle is impaired by alcohol, drugs, or some other physical condition. IGNITION SWITCH WARNING CAUTION ● Never remove or turn the key to the LOCK position while driving. The steering wheel will lock (for models with a steering lock mechanism). This may cause the driver to lose control of the vehicle and could result in serious vehicle damage or personal injury. ● Never place the ignition switch in the LOCK position while driving. The steering wheel will lock (for models with a steering lock mechanism). This may cause the driver to lose control of the vehicle and could result in serious vehicle damage or personal injury. ● Be sure to carry the Intelligent Key with you when operating the vehicle. ● Never leave the Intelligent Key inside the vehicle when you leave the vehicle. LSD0175 ● If the vehicle battery is discharged the ignition switch cannot be moved from the “LOCK” position and if the steering lock is engaged, the steering wheel may not be able to be moved. Charge the battery as soon as possible. (See “JUMP STARTING” in the “In case of emergency” section of this manual.) NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY™ (if so equipped) The Intelligent Key can operate the ignition switch without taking the key out from your pocket or purse. The operating environment and/or conditions may affect the Intelligent Key operation. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Starting and driving 5-7 The operating range of the engine start function 1 . is inside of the vehicle 䊊 ● If the Intelligent Key is placed on the instrument panel, rear parcel shelf, inside the glove box, storage bin or door pocket, the Intelligent Key may not function. ● If the Intelligent Key is placed near the door or window outside the vehicle, the Intelligent Key may function. WSD0041 WSD0191 Without Intelligent Key Operating range CONTINUOUSLY VARIABLE TRANSMISSION (CVT) (if so equipped) The Intelligent Key functions can only be used when the Intelligent Key is within the specified operating range. The ignition lock is designed so that the ignition switch cannot be turned to the LOCK position until the shift selector is moved to the P (Park) position. When the Intelligent Key battery is almost discharged or strong radio waves are present near the operating location, the Intelligent Key system’s operating range becomes narrower and may not function properly. ● When moving the ignition switch to the LOCK position, make sure the shift selector is in the P (Park) position. If the Intelligent Key is within the operating range, it is possible for anyone, even someone who does not carry the Intelligent Key, to turn the ignition switch to start the engine. 5-8 Starting and driving I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4. Remove the key if it is inserted in the ignition switch. If the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK position, the shift selector cannot be moved from the P (Park) position. The shift selector can be moved if the ignition switch is placed in the ON position and the foot brake pedal is depressed. There is an OFF position between the LOCK and ACC positions. The OFF position is indicated by a “1” on the key cylinder. LSD0175 WSD0052 With Intelligent Key ● When removing the key from the ignition switch, make sure the shift selector is in the P (Park) position. MANUAL TRANSMISSION (if so equipped) The ignition switch includes a device that helps prevent accidental removal of the key while driving. When the ignition switch cannot be turned to the LOCK position: The key can only be removed when the ignition switch is in the LOCK position. 1. Shift the shift selector to the P (Park) position. On manual transmission models, to turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position from the ACC or ON position, place the ignition switch in the OFF position, push the key in, then place the ignition switch in LOCK position. 2. Turn the ignition switch slightly in the ON direction. 3. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Starting and driving 5-9 In order for the steering wheel to be locked, it must be turned about 1/8 of a turn clockwise from the straight up position. To lock the steering wheel (for models with steering lock mechanism), place the ignition switch in the LOCK position. Remove the key. To unlock the steering wheel, insert the key and turn it gently while rotating the steering wheel slightly right and left. IGNITION SWITCH POSITIONS LOCK: Normal parking position (0) ● Intelligent Key : ● PUSH OFF- The steering lock can only be locked at this position (for vehicles equipped with a steering lock mechanism). OFF: (1) The engine can be turned off without locking the steering wheel (for vehicles equipped with a steering lock mechanism). ACC: (Accessories) (2) This position activates electrical accessories such as the radio when the engine is not running. ON: Normal operating position (3) ● Intelligent Key : ● PUSH ON- The ignition switch will be unlocked while carrying the Intelligent Key. This position turns on the ignition system and the electrical accessories. START: (4) This position starts the engine. As soon as the engine has started, release the key. It automatically returns to the ON position. NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM The NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer system will not allow the engine to start without the use of the registered key. If the engine fails to start using a registered key (for example, when interference is caused by another registered key, an automated toll road device or automatic payment device on the key ring), restart the engine using the following procedure: 1. Leave the ignition switch in the ON position for approximately 5 seconds. 5-10 Starting and driving I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 2. Place the ignition switch in the OFF or LOCK position, and wait approximately 10 seconds. 3. Repeat steps 1 and 2. 4. Restart the engine while holding the device (which may have caused the interference) separate from the registered key. If the no start condition re-occurs, NISSAN recommends placing the registered key on a separate key ring to avoid interference from other devices. BEFORE STARTING THE ENGINE ● Make sure the area around the vehicle is clear. ● Check fluid levels such as engine oil, coolant, brake and clutch fluid, and windshieldwasher fluid as frequently as possible, or at least whenever you refuel. ● Check that all windows and lights are clean. ● Visually inspect tires for their appearance and condition. Also check tires for proper inflation. ● Lock all doors. ● Position seat and adjust head restraints and headrests (if so equipped). ● Adjust inside and outside mirrors. ● Fasten seat belts and ask all passengers to do likewise. ● Check the operation of warning lights when the key is turned to the ON (3) position. See “Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders” in the “Instruments and controls” section of this manual. STARTING THE ENGINE 1. Apply the parking brake. 2. CVT model: Move the shift selector to P (Park) or N (Neutral). P (Park) is recommended. The shift selector cannot be moved out of P (Park) and into any of the other gear positions if the ignition switch is turned to the OFF position or if the key is removed from the ignition switch. The starter is designed not to operate if the shift selector is in any of the driving positions. Manual transmission model: Move the shift selector to N (Neutral). Depress the clutch pedal to the floor while cranking the engine. The starter is designed not to operate unless the clutch pedal is fully depressed. Models with Intelligent Key: Slowly “PUSH ON” the ignition switch. When the in the Intelligent Key warning light meter illuminates in green, the ignition switch can be turned. The Intelligent Key must be carried when operating the ignition switch. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : When the Intelligent Key warning in the meter blinks in red and the light inside warning buzzer emits a short beep, be sure that the shift selector is in the P (Park) position and the ignition switch is securely returned to the LOCK position. blinkThe Intelligent Key warning light ing in red, turns off by performing the following operations: ● Return the ignition switch to the LOCK position. ● Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position. When the buzzer beeps 4 times continuously, check for the following: ● The ignition switch is returned to the LOCK position. ● The mechanical key is not inserted into the ignition switch. The inside warning buzzer stops when one of the following is performed: ● Return the ignition switch to the LOCK position. ● Remove the mechanical key from the ignition switch. ● Close the doors. Starting and driving 5-11 DRIVING THE VEHICLE 3. Crank the engine with your foot off the accelerator pedal by turning the ignition switch to START. Release the switch when the engine starts. If the engine starts, but fails to run, repeat the above procedure. ● If the engine is very hard to start in extremely cold weather or when restarting, depress the accelerator pedal a little (approximately 1/3 to the floor) and hold it and then crank the engine. Release the switch and the accelerator pedal when the engine starts. ● If the engine is very hard to start because it is flooded, depress the accelerator pedal all the way to the floor and hold it. Crank the engine for 5-6 seconds. After cranking the engine, release the accelerator pedal. Crank the engine with your foot off the accelerator pedal by turning the ignition switch to START. Release the key when the engine starts. If the engine starts, but fails to run, repeat the above procedure. CAUTION Do not operate the starter for more than 15 seconds at a time. If the engine does not start, turn the ignition switch to off and wait 10 seconds before cranking again, otherwise the starter could be damaged. 4. Warm-up Allow the engine to idle for at least 30 seconds after starting. Do not race the engine while warming it up. Drive at moderate speed for a short distance first, especially in cold weather. CONTINUOUSLY VARIABLE TRANSMISSION (CVT) (if so equipped) WARNING ● Do not depress the accelerator pedal while shifting from P (Park) or N (Neutral) to R (Reverse), D (Drive) or L (Low). Always depress the brake pedal until shifting is completed. Failure to do so could cause you to lose control and have an accident. ● Cold engine idle speed is high, so use caution when shifting into a forward or reverse gear before the engine has warmed up. ● Do not downshift abruptly on slippery roads. This may cause a loss of control. ● Never shift to P (Park) or R (Reverse) while the vehicle is moving. This could cause an accident. CAUTION When stopping the vehicle on an uphill grade, do not hold the vehicle by depressing the accelerator pedal. The foot brake should be used for this purpose. 5-12 Starting and driving I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : The CVT in your vehicle is electronically controlled to produce maximum power and smooth operation. The recommended operating procedures for this transmission are shown on the following pages. Follow these procedures for maximum vehicle performance and driving enjoyment. NOTE: The CVT is designed so the foot brake pedal MUST be depressed before shifting from P (Park) to any drive position while the ignition switch is in the ON position. The shift selector cannot be moved out of P (Park) and into any of the other gear positions if the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK or OFF position or if the key is removed. Engine power may be automatically reduced to protect the CVT if the engine speed increases quickly when driving on slippery roads or while being tested on some dynamometers. LSD0177 Starting the vehicle To move the shift selector: A while depressing the Push the button 䊊 brake pedal 1. After starting the engine, fully depress the foot brake pedal before moving the shift selector out of the P (Park) position. A to shift Push the button 䊊 2. Keep the foot brake pedal depressed and move the shift selector into a driving gear. A Shift without pushing button 䊊 3. Release the foot brake, then gradually start the vehicle in motion. Shifting 4. Stop the vehicle completely before shifting the shift selector to the P (Park) position. After starting the engine, fully depress the brake pedal and move the shift selector from P (Park) to any of the desired shift positions. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Starting and driving 5-13 WARNING Apply the parking brake if the shift selector is in any position while the engine is not running. Failure to do so could cause the vehicle to move unexpectedly or roll away and result in serious personal injury or property damage. If the key is turned to the OFF or ACC position for any reason while the vehicle is in N (Neutral), or any drive position, the key cannot be turned to the LOCK position and be removed from the ignition switch. If this occurs, perform the following steps: 1. Apply the parking brake when the vehicle is stopped. 2. Move the shift selector to P (Park) to park the vehicle and turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position to remove the key. P (Park): CAUTION To prevent transmission damage, use the P (Park) or R (Reverse) position only when the vehicle is completely stopped. 5-14 Starting and driving Use the P (Park) selector position when the vehicle is parked or when starting the engine. Make sure the vehicle is completely stopped. The brake pedal must be depressed and the shift selector button pushed in to move the shift selector from N (Neutral) or any drive position to P (Park). Apply the parking brake. When parking on a hill, apply the parking brake first, then place the shift selector into the P (Park) position. N (Neutral): R (Reverse): Use this position for maximum engine braking on steep downhill gradients/climbing steep slopes and whenever approaching sharp bends. Do not use the L (Low) position in any other circumstances. CAUTION To prevent transmission damage, use the P (Park) or R (Reverse) position only when the vehicle is completely stopped. Use the R (Reverse) position to back up. Make sure the vehicle is completely stopped before selecting R (Reverse) position. R (Reverse) speed is limited to 25 MPH (40 km/h). Do not exceed 25 MPH (40 km/h) in the R (Reverse) position. The brake pedal must be depressed and the shift selector button pushed in to move the shift selector from P (Park), N (Neutral) or any drive position to R (Reverse). I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Neither forward nor reverse gear is engaged. The engine can be started in this position. You may shift to N (Neutral) and restart a stalled engine while the vehicle is moving. D (Drive): Use this position for all normal forward driving. L (Low): M1 (1st): Use this position when climbing steep hills slowly or driving slowly through deep snow, sand or mud, or for maximum engine braking on steep downhill grades. ● Remember not to drive at high speeds for extended periods of time in lower than M6 range. This reduces fuel economy. When shifting up: C paddle on the steering wheel Pull the + 䊊 towards you. (Shifts to higher range.) WSD0192 LSD0193 Manual shift mode (if so equipped) M6 (6th): A is When the manual shift mode button 䊊 pressed with the vehicle stopped or while driving, the transmission enters the manual shift mode. Shift ranges can be selected manually using the B and 䊊 C. paddles on the steering wheel 䊊 Use this position for all normal forward driving at highway speeds. In the manual shift mode, the shift range is displayed on the position indicator in the meter. Shift ranges up or down one by one as follows: M1←→ M2 ←→ M3 ←→ M4 ←→ M5 ←→ M6 M5 (5th): Use this position when driving up long slopes, or for engine braking when driving down long slopes. M4 (4th), M3 (3rd) and M2 (2nd): Use for hill climbing or engine braking on downhill grades. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : When shifting down: B paddle on the steering wheel Pull the ⫺ 䊊 towards you. (Shifts to lower range.) ● Pulling the same paddle twice will shift the ranges in succession. However, if this motion is rapidly done, the second shifting may not be completed properly. When canceling the manual shift mode: A to return Press the manual shift mode button 䊊 the transmission to the normal driving mode. ● In the manual shift mode, the transmission may not shift to the selected gear. This helps maintain driving performance and reduces the chance of vehicle damage or loss of control. Starting and driving 5-15 ● In the manual shift mode, the transmission may shift up automatically to a higher range than selected if the engine speed is too high. When the vehicle speed decreases, the transmission automatically shifts down. The transmission shifts to M1 (1st) gear before the vehicle comes to a complete stop. When accelerating again, it is necessary to shift up to the desired range. 3. Remove the shift lock release cover as shown. ● When the CVT fluid temperature is extremely low, the manual shift mode may not work and automatically shift as a drive mode. This is not a malfunction. In this case, press A off and drive for a the manual shift button 䊊 while and then reactivate the manual shift mode. If the shift selector cannot be moved out of P (Park), have a NISSAN dealer check the transmission as soon as possible. ● When the CVT fluid temperature is high, the shift range may upshift in lower rpm than usual. This is not a malfunction. 4. Insert a small screwdriver in the shift lock release slot and push down. 5. Move the shift selector to the N (Neutral) position while holding down the shift lock release. 6. Now the vehicle may be moved to the desired location. LSD0178 Shift lock release If the battery is discharged, the shift selector may not be moved from the P (Park) position even with the brake pedal depressed. To move the shift selector, release the shift lock. The shift selector can be moved to N (Neutral). To push the shift lock release, complete the following procedure: 1. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position and remove the key 2. Apply the parking brake. 5-16 Starting and driving I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : WARNING If the shift selector cannot be moved from the P (Park) position while the engine is running and the brake pedal is depressed, the stop lights may not work. Malfunctioning stop lights could cause an accident injuring yourself and others. (Drive), the Overdrive off mode will be automatically turned off. Accelerator downshift — in D position — For passing or hill climbing, depress the accelerator pedal to the floor. This shifts the transmission down into a lower gear, depending on the vehicle speed. Fail-safe When the fail-safe operation occurs, the CVT will not be shifted into the selected driving position. LSD0179 Overdrive (O/D) OFF switch When the O/D OFF switch is pushed with the shift selector in the D (Drive) position, the light in the instrument panel illuminates. See “Overdrive off indicator light (CVT models)” in the “Instruments and controls” section of this manual. Use the Overdrive off mode when you need improved engine braking. To turn off the Overdrive off mode, push the O/D indicator light will OFF switch again. The turn off. Each time the engine is started, or when the shift selector is shifted to any position other than D If the vehicle is driven under extreme conditions, such as excessive wheel spinning and subsequent hard braking, the fail-safe system may be activated. The MIL may come on to indicate the fail-safe mode is activated, see “Malfunction indicator light (MIL)” in the “Instruments and controls” section. This will occur even if all electrical circuits are functioning properly. In this case, place the ignition switch in the OFF position and wait for 10 seconds. Then place the ignition switch back in the ON position. The vehicle should return to its normal operating condition. If it does not return to its normal operating condition, have a NISSAN dealer check the transmission and repair if necessary. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : WARNING When the high fluid temperature protection mode or fail-safe operation occurs, vehicle speed may be gradually reduced. The reduced speed may be lower than other traffic, which could increase the chance of a collision. Be especially careful when driving. If necessary, pull to the side of the road at a safe place and allow the transmission to return to normal operation, or have it repaired if necessary. MANUAL TRANSMISSION (if so equipped) WARNING ● Do not downshift abruptly on slippery roads. This may cause a loss of control. ● Do not over-rev the engine when shifting to a lower gear. This may cause a loss of control or engine damage. Starting and driving 5-17 1 and To back up, lift up on the shift selector ring 䊊 then move it to the R (Reverse) position after stopping the vehicle completely. CAUTION ● Do not rest your foot on the clutch pedal while driving. This may cause clutch damage. 1 returns to its original The shift selector ring 䊊 position when the shift selector is moved to the N (Neutral) position. ● Fully depress the clutch pedal before shifting to help prevent transmission damage. If it is difficult to move the shift selector into R (Reverse) or 1 (1st), shift into N (Neutral), then release the clutch pedal. Depress the clutch pedal again and shift into R (Reverse) or 1 (1st). ● Stop your vehicle completely before shifting into R (Reverse). ● When the vehicle is stopped with the engine running (for example, at a stop light), shift to N (Neutral) and release the clutch pedal with the foot brake applied. Suggested upshift speeds LSD0180 Shifting To change gears or when upshifting or downshifting, depress the clutch pedal fully, shift into the appropriate gear, then release the clutch slowly and smoothly. To ensure smooth gear changes, fully depress the clutch pedal before operating the shift selector. If the clutch pedal is not fully depressed before the transmission is shifted, a gear noise may be heard. Transmission damage may occur. Start the vehicle in 1st gear and shift to 2nd, 3rd, 4th and 5th up to 6th gear in sequence according to vehicle speed. 5-18 Starting and driving I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : The following are suggested vehicle speeds for shifting into a higher gear. These suggestions relate to fuel economy and vehicle performance. Actual upshift speeds will vary according to road conditions, the weather and individual driving habits. GEAR CHANGE 1st to 2nd 2nd to 3rd 3rd to 4th 4th to 5th 5th to 6th MPH (km/h) 8 (13) 17 (27) 25 (40) 36 (58) 51 (82) PARKING BRAKE Suggested maximum speed in each gear Downshift to a lower gear if the engine is not running smoothly, or if you need to accelerate. Do not exceed the maximum suggested speed (shown below) in any gear. For level road driving, use the highest gear suggested for that speed. Always observe posted speed limits, and drive according to the road conditions, which will ensure safe operation. Do not over-rev the engine when shifting to a lower gear as it may cause engine damage or loss of vehicle control. QR25DE engine models: GEAR 1st 2nd 3rd 4th 5th 6th ● Be sure the parking brake is fully released before driving. Failure to do so can cause brake failure and lead to an accident. ● Do not release the parking brake from outside the vehicle. ● Do not use the shift selector in place of the parking brake. When parking, be sure the parking brake is fully engaged. ● Do not leave children unattended in a vehicle. They could release the parking brake and cause an accident. MR20DE engine models: GEAR 1st 2nd 3rd 4th 5th 6th WARNING MPH (km/h) 33 (53) 53 (86) 75 (121) — — — MPH (km/h) 27 (44) 49 (79) 68 (109) — — — I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Starting and driving 5-19 CRUISE CONTROL (if so equipped) ● The SET indicator light may blink when the cruise control switch is turned ON while pushing the ACCEL/RES, COAST/SET, or CANCEL switch. To properly set the cruise control system, use the following procedures. WARNING Do not use the cruise control when driving under the following conditions: ● When it is not possible to keep the vehicle at a set speed. WSD0169 A. To engage: Pull the lever up 䊊 To release: 1. Firmly apply the foot brake. 2. Manual transmission models: Place the shift selector in the N (Neutral) position. CVT models: Move the shift selector to the P (Park) position. 3. While pulling up on the parking brake lever slightly, push the button and lower comB. pletely 䊊 4. Before driving, be sure the brake warning light goes out. 5-20 Starting and driving LSD0176 1. 2. 3. 4. ACCEL/RES switch COAST/SET switch CANCEL switch ON/OFF switch PRECAUTIONS ON CRUISE CONTROL ● If the cruise control system malfunctions, it cancels automatically. The SET indicator light in the instrument panel then blinks to warn the driver. ● If the SET indicator light blinks, turn the cruise control switch off and have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ● In heavy traffic or in traffic that varies in speed. ● On winding or hilly roads. ● On slippery roads (rain, snow, ice, etc.). ● In very windy areas. Doing so could cause a loss of vehicle control and result in an accident. CAUTION On manual transmission models, do not shift into N (Neutral) without depressing the clutch pedal when the cruise control is set. Should this occur, depress the clutch pedal and turn the main switch off immediately. Failure to do so may cause engine damage. ● The vehicle may not maintain the set speed when going up or down steep hills. If this happens, drive without the cruise control. To cancel the preset speed, use one of the following three methods. ● Push the CANCEL button; the SET indicator light in the instrument panel goes out. CRUISE CONTROL OPERATIONS ● Tap the brake pedal; the SET indicator light goes out. The cruise control allows driving at a speed between 25 - 89 MPH (40 - 144 km/h) without keeping your foot on the accelerator pedal. ● Push the ON·OFF switch off. Both the CRUISE indicator light and SET indicator light in the instrument panel go out. To turn on the cruise control, push the ON·OFF switch. The CRUISE indicator light in the instrument panel comes on. To set cruising speed, accelerate the vehicle to the desired speed, push the COAST/SET switch and release it. The SET indicator light in the instrument panel comes on. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal. Your vehicle maintains the set speed. ● To pass another vehicle, depress the accelerator pedal. When you release the pedal, the vehicle returns to the previously set speed. The cruise control is automatically canceled and the SET light in the instrument panel goes out if: ● you depress the brake or clutch pedal while pushing the ACCEL/RES or SET/COAST switch. The preset speed is deleted from memory. ● the vehicle slows down more than 8 MPH (13 km/h) below the set speed. ● you depress the clutch pedal (manual transmission), or move the shift selector to N (Neutral) (CVT). I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : To reset at a faster cruising speed, use one of the following three methods. ● Depress the accelerator pedal. When the vehicle attains the desired speed, push and release the COAST/SET switch. ● Push and hold the ACCEL/RES switch. When the vehicle attains the speed you desire, release the switch. ● Push and release the ACCEL/RES switch. Each time you do this, the set speed increases by about 1 MPH (1.6 km/h). To reset at a slower cruising speed, use one of the following three methods. ● Lightly tap the brake pedal. When the vehicle attains the desired speed, push the COAST/SET switch and release it. ● Push and hold the COAST/SET switch. Release the switch when the vehicle slows to the desired speed. ● Push and release the COAST/SET switch. Each time you do this, the set speed decreases by about 1 MPH (1.6 km/h). To resume the preset speed, push and release the ACCEL/RES switch. The vehicle returns to the last set cruising speed when the vehicle speed is over 25 MPH (40 km/h). Starting and driving 5-21 BREAK-IN SCHEDULE CAUTION During the first 1,200 miles (2,000 km), follow these recommendations to obtain maximum engine performance and ensure the future reliability and economy of your new vehicle. Failure to follow these recommendations may result in shortened engine life and reduced engine performance. INCREASING FUEL ECONOMY ● Accelerate slowly and smoothly. Maintain cruising speeds with a constant accelerator position. ● When cruising at highway speeds, it is more economical to use the air conditioner and leave the windows closed to reduce drag. ● Drive at moderate speeds on the highway. Driving at high speed lowers fuel economy. ● Use the recommended viscosity engine oil. See “Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants” in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual. ● Avoid unnecessary stopping and braking. Maintain a safe distance behind other vehicles. ● Avoid driving for long periods at constant speed, either fast or slow, and do not run the engine over 4,000 rpm. ● Use a proper gear range which suits road conditions. On level roads, shift into high gear as soon as possible. ● Do not accelerate at full throttle in any gear. ● Avoid unnecessary engine idling. ● Avoid quick starts. ● Keep your engine tuned up. ● Avoid hard braking as much as possible. ● Follow the recommended periodic maintenance schedule. ● Do not tow a trailer for the first 500 miles (800 km). Your engine, axle or other parts could be damaged. ● Keep the tires inflated to the correct pressure. Low tire pressure increases tire wear and lowers fuel economy. ● Keep the wheels in correct alignment. Improper alignment increases tire wear and lowers fuel economy. ● Air conditioner operation lowers fuel economy. Use the air conditioner only when necessary. 5-22 Starting and driving I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : PARKING/PARKING ON HILLS 2. Manual transmission models: Place the shift selector in the R (Reverse) position. When parking on an uphill grade, place the shift selector in 1st gear. Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) models: Move the shift selector to the P (Park) position. 3. To help prevent the vehicle from rolling into traffic when parked on an incline, it is a good practice to turn the wheels as illustrated. 1 ● HEADED DOWNHILL WITH CURB: 䊊 SSD0488 WARNING ● Do not stop or park the vehicle over flammable materials such as dry grass, waste paper or rags. They may ignite and cause a fire. ● Safe parking procedures require that both the parking brake be set and the transmission placed into P (Park) for CVT models or in an appropriate gear for manual transmission models. Failure to do so could cause the vehicle to move unexpectedly or roll away and result in an accident. Make sure the shift selector has been pushed as far forward as it can go and cannot be moved without depressing the foot brake pedal. ● Never leave the engine running while the vehicle is unattended. ● Do not leave children unattended inside the vehicle. They could unknowingly activate switches or controls. Unattended children could become involved in serious accidents. 1. Firmly apply the parking brake. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Turn the wheels into the curb and move the vehicle forward until the curb side wheel gently touches the curb. 2 ● HEADED UPHILL WITH CURB: 䊊 Turn the wheels away from the curb and move the vehicle back until the curb side wheel gently touches the curb. ● HEADED UPHILL OR DOWNHILL, NO 3 CURB: 䊊 Turn the wheels toward the side of the road so the vehicle will move away from the center of the road if it moves. 4. Place the ignition switch in the LOCK position and remove the key. Starting and driving 5-23 POWER STEERING WARNING ● If the engine is not running or is turned off while driving, the power assist for the steering will not work. Steering will be harder to operate. ● When the power steering warning light illuminates with the engine running, there will be no power assist for the steering. You will still have control of the vehicle but the steering will be harder to operate. Have the power steering system checked by a NISSAN dealer. The power steering system is designed to provide power assist while driving to operate the steering wheel with light force. When the steering wheel is operated repeatedly or continuously while parking or driving at a very low speed, the power assist for the steering wheel will be reduced. This is to prevent overheating of the power steering system and protect it from getting damaged. While the power assist is reduced, steering wheel operation will become heavy. When the temperature of the power steering system goes down, the power assist level will return to normal. Avoid repeating such steering wheel operations that could cause the power steering system to overheat. 5-24 Starting and driving BRAKE SYSTEM You may hear a sound when the steering wheel is operated quickly. However, this is not a malfunction. The brake system has two separate hydraulic circuits. If one circuit malfunctions, you will still have braking at 2 wheels. If the electric power steering warning light PS illuminates while the engine is running, it may indicate the power steering system is not functioning properly and may need servicing. Have the power steering system checked by a NISSAN dealer. BRAKE PRECAUTIONS When the electric power steering warning light illuminates with the engine running, there will be no power assist for the steering but you will still have control of the vehicle. At this time, greater steering effort is required to operate the steering wheel, especially in sharp turns and at low speeds. For additional information see “Electric power steering warning light” in the “Instruments and controls” section. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Vacuum assisted brakes The brake booster aids braking by using engine vacuum. If the engine stops, you can stop the vehicle by depressing the brake pedal. However, greater foot pressure on the brake pedal will be required to stop the vehicle and stopping distance will be longer. Using the brakes Avoid resting your foot on the brake pedal while driving. This will overheat the brakes, wear out the brake pads faster, and reduce gas mileage. To help reduce brake wear and to prevent the brakes from overheating, reduce speed and downshift to a lower gear before going down a slope or long grade. Overheated brakes may reduce braking performance and could result in loss of vehicle control. WARNING ● While driving on a slippery surface, be careful when braking, accelerating or downshifting. Abrupt braking or accelerating could cause the wheels to skid and result in an accident. ● If the engine is not running or is turned off while driving, the power assist for the brakes will not work. Braking will be harder. Wet brakes When the vehicle is washed or driven through water, the brakes may get wet. As a result, your braking distance will be longer and the vehicle may pull to one side during braking. To dry the brakes, drive the vehicle at a safe speed while lightly pressing the brake pedal to heat up the brakes. Do this until the brakes return to normal. Avoid driving the vehicle at high speeds until the brakes function correctly. Parking brake break-in Break-in the parking brake shoes whenever the stopping effect of the parking brake is weakened or whenever the parking brake shoes and/or drum/rotors are replaced, in order to assure the best brake performance. This procedure is described in the vehicle service manual and can be performed by a NISSAN dealer. ANTI-LOCK BRAKING SYSTEM (ABS) (if so equipped) WARNING ● The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) is a sophisticated device, but it cannot prevent accidents resulting from careless or dangerous driving techniques. It can help maintain vehicle control during braking on slippery surfaces. Remember that stopping distances on slippery surfaces will be longer than on normal surfaces even with ABS. Stopping distances may also be longer on rough, gravel or snow covered roads, or if you are using tire chains. Always maintain a safe distance from the vehicle in front of you. Ultimately, the driver is responsible for safety. ● Tire type and condition may also affect braking effectiveness. – When replacing tires, install the specified size of tires on all four wheels. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : – When installing a spare tire, make sure that it is the proper size and type as specified on the Tire and Loading Information label. See “Tire and Loading Information label” in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual. – For detailed information, see “Wheels and tires” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual. The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) controls the brakes so the wheels do not lock during hard braking or when braking on slippery surfaces. The system detects the rotation speed at each wheel and varies the brake fluid pressure to prevent each wheel from locking and sliding. By preventing each wheel from locking, the system helps the driver maintain steering control and helps to minimize swerving and spinning on slippery surfaces. Using the system Depress the brake pedal and hold it down. Depress the brake pedal with firm steady pressure, but do not pump the brakes. The ABS will operate to prevent the wheels from locking up. Steer the vehicle to avoid obstacles. Starting and driving 5-25 VEHICLE DYNAMIC CONTROL (VDC) SYSTEM (if so equipped) WARNING Normal operation Do not pump the brake pedal. Doing so may result in increased stopping distances. The ABS operates at speeds above 3 - 6 MPH (5 - 10 km/h). The speed varies according to road conditions. Self-test feature When the ABS senses that 1 or more wheels are close to locking up, the actuator rapidly applies and releases hydraulic pressure. This action is similar to pumping the brakes very quickly. You may feel a pulsation in the brake pedal and hear a noise from under the hood or feel a vibration from the actuator when it is operating. This is normal and indicates that the ABS is operating properly. However, the pulsation may indicate that road conditions are hazardous and extra care is required while driving. The ABS includes electronic sensors, electric pumps, hydraulic solenoids and a computer. The computer has a built-in diagnostic feature that tests the system each time you start the engine and move the vehicle at a low speed in forward or reverse. When the self-test occurs, you may hear a “clunk” noise and/or feel a pulsation in the brake pedal. This is normal and does not indicate a malfunction. If the computer senses a malfunction, it switches the ABS off and illuminates the ABS warning light on the instrument panel. The brake system then operates normally, but without anti-lock assistance. The Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system uses various sensors to monitor driver inputs and vehicle motion. Under certain driving situations, the system will control braking and engine output to help keep the vehicle on its steered path. ● When the Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system is operating, the slip indicator in the instrument panel blinks. indicator blinks, the road condi● If the tions may be slippery. Be sure to adjust your speed and driving to these conditions. See “Slip indicator light” and “Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF indicator light” in the “Instruments and controls” section. ● Indicator light – If a malfunction occurs in the system, and indicator lights the come on in the instrument panel. If the ABS warning light illuminates during the self-test or while driving, have the vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer. – As long as these indicator lights are on, the traction control function is canceled. If the vehicle is operated with the Vehicle Dynamic Control system off using the VDC OFF switch, VDC and Traction Control System (TCS) indicator functions will be turned off. The will flash if wheel spin is detected. The ABS will still operate with the VDC system off. 5-26 Starting and driving I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : When the VDC system is operating, you may feel a pulsation in the brake pedal and hear a noise or vibration from under the hood. This is normal and indicates that the VDC system is working properly. The computer has a built in diagnostic feature that tests the system each time you start the engine and move the vehicle forward or in reverse at a slow speed. When the self-test occurs, you may hear a clunk noise and/or feel a pulsation in the brake pedal. This is normal and is not an indication of a malfunction. WARNING ● The Vehicle Dynamic Control system is designed to help improve driving stability but does not prevent accidents due to abrupt steering operation at high speeds or by careless or dangerous driving techniques. Reduce vehicle speed and be especially careful when driving and cornering on slippery surfaces and always drive carefully. ● Do not modify the vehicle’s suspension. If suspension parts such as shock absorbers, struts, springs, stabilizer bars, bushings and wheels are not NISSAN approved for your vehicle or are extremely deteriorated the Vehicle Dynamic Control system may not operate properly. This could adversely affect vehicle handling performance, and the VDC OFF indicator light may come on. ● If wheels or tires other then the recommended ones are used, the Vehicle Dynamic Control system may not operate properly and the Vehicle Dynamic Control OFF indicator light may come on. ● The Vehicle Dynamic Control system is not a substitute for winter tires or tire chains on a snow covered road. ● If brake related parts suck as brake pads, rotors and calipers are not standard equipment or are extremely deteriorated, the Vehicle Dynamic Control system may not operate properly and the Vehicle Dynamic Control OFF indicator light may come on. ● When driving on extremely inclined surfaces such as higher banked corners, the Vehicle Dynamic Control system may not operate properly and the VDC OFF indicator light may come on. Do not drive on these types of roads. ● When driving on an unstable surface suck as a turntable, ferry, elevator or ramp, the Vehicle Dynamic Control OFF indicator light may illuminate. This is not a malfunction. Restart the engine after driving onto a stable surface. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Starting and driving 5-27 COLD WEATHER DRIVING FREEING A FROZEN DOOR LOCK DRAINING OF COOLANT WATER To prevent a door lock from freezing, apply deicer through the key hole. If the lock becomes frozen, heat the key before inserting it into the key hole, the remote keyless entry keyfob (if so equipped) or the NISSAN Intelligent Key™ (if so equipped). If the vehicle is to be left outside without antifreeze, drain the cooling system, including the engine block. Refill before operating the vehicle. For details, see “Changing engine coolant” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual. ANTI-FREEZE TIRE EQUIPMENT In the winter when it is anticipated that the temperature will drop below 32°F (0°C), check the anti-freeze to assure proper winter protection. For details, see “Engine cooling system” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual. BATTERY If the battery is not fully charged during extremely cold weather conditions, the battery fluid may freeze and damage the battery. To maintain maximum efficiency, the battery should be checked regularly. For details, see “Battery” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual. 1. SUMMER tires have a tread designed to provide superior performance on dry pavement. However, the performance of these tires will be substantially reduced in snowy and icy conditions. If you operate your vehicle on snowy or icy roads, NISSAN recommends the use of MUD & SNOW or ALL SEASON TIRES on all four wheels. Please consult a NISSAN dealer for the tire type, size, speed rating and availability information. 2. For additional traction on icy roads, studded tires may be used. However, some U.S. states and Canadian provinces prohibit their use. Check local, state and provincial laws before installing studded tires. Skid and traction capabilities of studded snow tires on wet or dry surfaces may be poorer than that of non-studded snow tires. 5-28 Starting and driving I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 3. Tire chains may be used. For details see “Tire chains” in the “Maintenance and do-ityourself” section of this manual. SPECIAL WINTER EQUIPMENT It is recommended that the following items be carried in the vehicle during winter: ● A scraper and stiff-bristled brush to remove ice and snow from the windows and wiper blades. ● A sturdy, flat board to be placed under the jack to give it firm support. ● A shovel to dig the vehicle out of snowdrifts. ● Extra windshield-washer fluid to refill the reservoir tank. DRIVING ON SNOW OR ICE WARNING ● Wet ice (32°F, 0°C and freezing rain), very cold snow or ice can be slick and very hard to drive on. The vehicle will have much less traction or “grip” under these conditions. Try to avoid driving on wet ice until the road is salted or sanded. ● Whatever the condition, drive with caution. Accelerate and slow down with care. If accelerating or downshifting too fast, the drive wheels will lose even more traction. ● Allow more stopping distance under these conditions. Braking should be started sooner than on dry pavement. ● Allow greater following distances on slippery roads. ● Watch for slippery spots (glare ice). These may appear on an otherwise clear road in shaded areas. If a patch of ice is seen ahead, brake before reaching it. Try not to brake while on the ice, and avoid any sudden steering maneuvers. ● Do not use the cruise control (if so equipped) on slippery roads. ● Snow can trap dangerous exhaust gases under your vehicle. Keep snow clear of the exhaust pipe and from around your vehicle. ENGINE BLOCK HEATER (if so equipped) WARNING ● Do not use your engine block heater with an ungrounded electrical system or a 2-pronged adapter. You can be seriously injured by an electrical shock if you use an ungrounded connection. ● Disconnect and properly store the engine block heater cord before starting the engine. Damage to the cord could result in an electrical shock and can cause serious injury. ● Use a heavy-duty 3-wire, 3-pronged extension cord rated for at least 10 A. Plug the extension cord into a Ground Fault Interrupt (GFI) protected, grounded 110-VAC outlet. Failure to use the proper extension cord or a grounded outlet can result in a fire or electrical shock and cause serious personal injury. To use the engine block heater: 1. Turn the engine off. 2. Open the hood and unwrap the engine block heater cord. 3. Plug the engine block heater cord into a grounded 3 wire, 3 pronged extension cord. 4. Plug the extension cord into a Ground Fault Interrupt (GFI) protected, grounded 110volt AC (VAC) outlet. 5. The engine block heater must be plugged in for at least 2 - 4 hours, depending on outside temperatures, to properly warm the engine coolant. Use an appropriate timer to turn the engine block heater on. 6. Before starting the engine, unplug and properly store the cord to keep it away from moving parts. Engine block heaters are available through NISSAN dealers to assist in cold temperature starting. The engine block heater should be used when the outside temperature is 20° F (-7° C) or lower. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Starting and driving 5-29 MEMO 5-30 Starting and driving I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 6 In case of emergency Flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2 Changing a flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2 Jump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8 Push starting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10 If your vehicle overheats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11 Towing your vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12 Towing recommended by NISSAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13 Vehicle recovery (freeing a stuck vehicle) . . . . . . . . . 6-14 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : FLAT TIRE TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS) (if so equipped) This vehicle is equipped with the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). It monitors tire pressure of all tires except the spare. When the low tire pressure warning light is lit, one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. If the vehicle is being driven with low tire pressure, the TPMS will activate and warn you of it by the low tire pressure warning light. This system will activate only when the vehicle is driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h). For more details, refer to “Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders” in the “Instruments and controls” section, and “Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)” in the “Starting and driving” section. WARNING ● If the low tire pressure warning light illuminates while driving, avoid sudden steering maneuvers or abrupt braking, reduce vehicle speed, pull off the road to a safe location and stop the vehicle as soon as possible. Driving with underinflated tires may permanently damage the tires and increase the likelihood of tire failure. Serious vehicle damage could occur and may lead to an accident and could result in serious personal injury. Check the tire pressure for all four tires. Adjust the tire pressure to the recommended COLD tire pressure shown on the Tire and Loading Information label to turn the low tire pressure warning light OFF. If you have a flat tire, replace it with a spare tire as soon as possible. ● When a spare tire is mounted or a wheel is replaced, the TPMS will not function and the low tire pressure warning light will flash for approximately 1 minute. The light will remain on after 1 minute. Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon as possible for tire replacement and/or system resetting. 6-2 In case of emergency I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ● Replacing tires with those not originally specified by NISSAN could affect the proper operation of the TPMS. ● Do not inject any tire liquid or aerosol tire sealant into the tires, as this may cause a malfunction of the tire pressure sensors. CHANGING A FLAT TIRE If you have a flat tire, follow the instructions below: Stopping the vehicle 1. Safely move the vehicle off the road and away from traffic. 2. Turn on the hazard warning flashers. 3. Park on a level surface and apply the parking brake. Shift the manual transmission into R (Reverse), or the CVT into P (Park). 4. Turn off the engine. 5. Raise the hood to warn other traffic and to signal professional road assistance personnel that you need assistance. 6. Have all passengers get out of the vehicle and stand in a safe place, away from traffic and clear of the vehicle. WARNING ● Make sure the parking brake is securely applied and the manual transmission is shifted into R (Reverse), or the CVT is shifted into P (Park). ● Never change tires when the vehicle is on a slope, ice or slippery areas. This is hazardous. ● Never change tires if oncoming traffic is close to your vehicle. Wait for professional road assistance. WCE0044 Blocking wheels 1 at both the front and Place suitable blocks 䊊 back of the wheel diagonally opposite the flat tire 2 to prevent the vehicle from moving when it is 䊊 jacked up. WARNING Be sure to block the wheel as the vehicle may move and result in personal injury. LCE0134 Getting the spare tire and tools 1. Open the trunk and remove the trunk divider (if so equipped) and the cargo net (if so equipped). Lift the trunk floor carpeting and A . Remove the jack and the spare tire cover 䊊 spare tire as indicated. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : In case of emergency 6-3 WCE0203 2. To remove the jack, turn the jack screw counterclockwise and lift out. WCE0055 Removing bolt-on wheel cover (if so equipped) CAUTION Do not use your hands to pry off wheel caps or wheel covers. Doing so could result in personal injury. Wheel cover attachment to the wheel is made by one of the wheel lug nuts. This wheel lug nut needs to be removed before the wheel cover can be removed from the wheel. 6-4 In case of emergency I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ● Use the correct jack-up points. Never use any other part of the vehicle for jack support. ● Never jack up the vehicle more than necessary. ● Never use blocks on or under the jack. ● Do not start or vehicle is on the vehicle to move. for vehicles differentials. CE1089 Jacking up vehicle and removing the damaged tire run the engine while jack. It may cause the This is especially true with limited slip ● Do not allow passengers to stay in the vehicle while it is on the jack. ● Never run the engine with a wheel(s) off the ground. It may cause the vehicle to move. WARNING ● Never get under the vehicle while it is supported only by the jack. If it is necessary to work under the vehicle, support it with safety stands. ● Use only the jack provided with your vehicle to lift the vehicle. Do not use the jack provided with your vehicle on other vehicles. The jack is designed for lifting only your vehicle during a tire change. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : In case of emergency 6-5 LCE0020 Always refer to the proper illustrations for the correct placement and jack-up points for your specific vehicle model and jack type. Carefully read the caution label attached to the jack body and the following instructions. 1. Loosen each wheel nut one or two turns by turning counterclockwise with the wheel nut wrench. Do not remove the wheel nuts until the tire is off the ground. 6-6 In case of emergency 2. Place the jack directly under the jack-up point as illustrated so the top of the jack contacts the vehicle at the jack-up point. Align the jack head between the two notches in the front or the rear as shown. Also fit the groove of the jack head between the notches as shown. WCE0048 Installing the spare tire The spare tire is designed for emergency use. See specific instructions under the heading “Wheels and tires” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual. The jack should be used on firm and level ground. 1. Clean any mud or dirt from the surface between the wheel and hub. 3. To lift the vehicle, securely hold the jack lever and rod with both hands. Carefully raise the vehicle until the tire clears the ground. Remove the wheel nuts, and then remove the tire. 2. Carefully put the spare tire on and tighten the wheel nuts finger tight. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 3. With the wheel nut wrench, tighten wheel nuts alternately and evenly as illustrated until they are tight. 4. Lower the vehicle slowly until the tire touches the ground. Then, with the wheel nut wrench, tighten the wheel nuts securely A ,䊊 B ,䊊 C ,䊊 D ). in the sequence illustrated (䊊 Lower the vehicle completely. WARNING Wheel nut tightening torque: 83 ft-lb (113 N·m) The wheel nuts must be kept tightened to specification at all times. It is recommended that wheel nuts be tightened to specification at each lubrication interval. ● Incorrect wheel nuts or improperly tightened wheel nuts can cause the wheel to become loose or come off. This could cause an accident. Adjust tire pressure to the COLD pressure. ● Do not use oil or grease on the wheel studs or nuts. This could cause the nuts to become loose. COLD tire pressures are shown on the Tire and Loading Information Label. ● Retighten the wheel nuts when the vehicle has been driven for 600 miles (1,000 km) (also in cases of a flat tire, etc.). COLD pressure: After vehicle has been parked for three hours or more or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km). LCE0136 5. Securely store the flat tire in the vehicle. 6. Install the jack in its storage area and tighten the jack screw clockwise. 7. Place the spare tire cover and the trunk floor carpeting over the damaged tire. As soon as possible, tighten the wheel nuts to the specified torque with a torque wrench. 8. Close the trunk. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : In case of emergency 6-7 JUMP STARTING WARNING ● Always make sure that the spare tire and jacking equipment are properly secured after use. Such items can become dangerous projectiles in an accident or sudden stop. ● The spare tire is designed for emergency use. See specific instructions under the heading “Wheels and tires” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual. To start your engine with a booster battery, the instructions and precautions below must be followed. If the battery of a vehicle equipped with the NISSAN Intelligent Key ™ is discharged, the ignition switch cannot be moved from the LOCK position, even using the mechanical key or the valet key. Connect the jumper cables to another vehicle, as in the case of a discharged battery, and then the ignition switch can be moved from the LOCK position. Then, jump start the vehicle. WARNING ● If done incorrectly, jump starting can lead to a battery explosion, resulting in severe injury or death. It could also damage your vehicle. ● Explosive hydrogen gas is always present in the vicinity of the battery. Keep all sparks and flames away from the battery. ● Do not allow battery fluid to come into contact with eyes, skin, clothing or painted surfaces. Battery fluid is a corrosive sulfuric acid solution which can cause severe burns. If the fluid should come into contact with anything, immediately flush the contacted area with water. ● Keep battery out of the reach of children. ● The booster battery must be rated at 12 volts. Use of an improperly rated battery can damage your vehicle. ● Whenever working on or near a battery, always wear suitable eye protectors (for example, goggles or industrial safety spectacles) and remove rings, metal bands, or any other jewelry. Do not lean over the battery when jump starting. ● Do not attempt to jump start a frozen battery. It could explode and cause serious injury. ● Your vehicle has an automatic engine cooling fan. It could come on at any time. Keep hands and other objects away from it. 6-8 In case of emergency I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ● If the battery of a vehicle equipped with the Intelligent Key system is discharged, the ignition switch cannot be moved from the LOCK position, even using the mechanical key or the valet key. Connect the jumper cables to another vehicle, as in the case of a discharged battery, and then the ignition knob can be moved from the LOCK position. Then, jump start the vehicle. WCE0054 WARNING Always follow the instructions below. Failure to do so could result in damage to the charging system and cause personal injury. 1. If the booster battery is in another vehicle, position the two vehicles to bring their batteries near each other. Do not allow the two vehicles to touch. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 2. Apply the parking brake. Move the shift selector to N (Neutral) (manual transmission) or to P (Park) (CVT). Switch off all unnecessary electrical systems (lights, heater, air conditioner, etc.). 3. Remove vent caps on the battery (if so equipped). Cover the battery with an old cloth to reduce explosion hazard. 4. Connect jumper cables in the sequence ilA,䊊 B,䊊 C,䊊 D ). lustrated (䊊 In case of emergency 6-9 PUSH STARTING CAUTION ● Always connect positive (⫹) to positive (⫹) and negative (⫺) to body ground (for example, strut mounting bolt, engine lift bracket, etc.) — not to the battery. 8. Replace the vent caps (if so equipped). Be sure to dispose of the cloth used to cover the vent holes as it may be contaminated with corrosive acid. ● Do not push start this vehicle. The three-way catalyst may be damaged. ● Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) models cannot be push-started or tow-started. Attempting to do so may cause transmission damage. ● Make sure the jumper cables do not touch moving parts in the engine compartment and that the cable clamps do not contact any other metal. ● For manual transmission models, never try to start the vehicle by towing it. When the engine starts, the forward surge could cause the vehicle to collide with the tow vehicle. 5. Start the engine of the booster vehicle and let it run for a few minutes. For Intelligent Key system equipped models, use the mechanical key to start the engine. 6. Keep the engine speed of the booster vehicle at about 2,000 rpm, and start the engine of the vehicle being jump started. CAUTION Do not keep the starter motor engaged for more than 10 seconds. If the engine does not start right away, place the ignition switch in the off position and wait 3 to 4 seconds before trying again. 7. After starting the engine, carefully disconnect the negative cable and then the positive cable. 6-10 In case of emergency CAUTION I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : IF YOUR VEHICLE OVERHEATS If your vehicle is overheating (indicated by an extremely high temperature gauge reading), or if you feel a lack of engine power, detect abnormal noise, etc., take the following steps. WARNING ● Do not continue to drive if your vehicle overheats. Doing so could cause engine damage or a vehicle fire. ● To avoid the danger of being scalded, never remove the radiator cap while the engine is still hot. When the radiator cap is removed, pressurized hot water will spurt out, possibly causing serious injury. ● Do not open the hood if steam is coming out. 1. Move the vehicle safely off the road, apply the parking brake and move the shift selector to N (Neutral) (manual transmission) or to P (Park) (CVT). Do not stop the engine. 2. Turn off the air conditioner (if so equipped). Open all the windows, move the heater or air conditioner temperature control to maximum hot and fan control to high speed. 3. Get out of the vehicle. Look and listen for steam or coolant escaping from the radiator before opening the hood. (If steam or coolant is escaping, turn off the engine.) Do not open the hood further until no steam or coolant can be seen. 6. After the engine cools down, check the coolant level in the engine coolant reservoir tank with the engine running. Add coolant to the engine coolant reservoir tank if necessary. Have your vehicle repaired at a NISSAN dealer. 4. Open the engine hood. WARNING If steam or water is coming from the engine, stand clear to prevent getting burned. 5. Visually check drive belts for damage or looseness. Also check if the cooling fan is running. The radiator hoses and radiator should not leak water. If coolant is leaking, the water pump belt is missing or loose, or the cooling fan does not run, stop the engine. WARNING Be careful not to allow your hands, hair, jewelry or clothing to come into contact with, or get caught in, engine belts or the engine cooling fan. The engine cooling fan can start at any time. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : In case of emergency 6-11 TOWING YOUR VEHICLE When towing your vehicle, all State (Provincial in Canada) and local regulations for towing must be followed. Incorrect towing equipment could damage your vehicle. Towing instructions are available from a NISSAN dealer. Local service operators are generally familiar with the applicable laws and procedures for towing. To assure proper towing and to prevent accidental damage to your vehicle, NISSAN recommends having a service operator tow your vehicle. It is advisable to have the service operator carefully read the following precautions: For information about towing your vehicle behind a recreational vehicle (RV), refer to “Flat towing” in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual. WARNING ● Never ride in a vehicle that is being towed. ● Never get under your vehicle after it has been lifted by a tow truck. CAUTION ● When towing, make sure that the transmission, axles, steering system and powertrain are in working condition. If any of these conditions apply, dollies or a flatbed tow truck must be used. WCE0194 䊊 (CVT) Continuously Variable Transmission B (M/T) Manual transmission 䊊 A ● Always attach safety chains before towing. 6-12 In case of emergency I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : TOWING RECOMMENDED BY NISSAN CAUTION ● Never tow Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) models with the front wheels on the ground or four wheels on the ground (forward or backward), as this may cause serious and expensive damage to the transmission. If it is necessary to tow the vehicle with the rear wheels raised always use towing dollies under the front wheels. NISSAN recommends that your vehicle be towed with the driving (front) wheels off the ground or place the vehicle on a flat bed truck as illustrated. ● When towing Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) models with the front wheels on towing dollies, or when towing manual transmission models with the front wheels on the ground: WCE0195 A (CVT) Continuously Variable Transmission 䊊 B (M/T) Manual transmission 䊊 – Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, and secure the steering wheel in a straight-ahead position with a rope or similar device. Never secure the steering wheel by turning the ignition switch to the LOCK position. This may damage the steering lock mechanism (for models equipped with steering lock mechanism). – I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Move the shift selector to the N (Neutral) position. In case of emergency 6-13 ● When towing Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) or manual transmission (M/T) models with the rear wheels on the ground (if you do not use towing dollies): Always release the parking brake. ● Observe the following restricted towing speeds and distances for manual transmissions (M/T) only: – Speed: Below 50 MPH (80 km/h) – Distance: Less than 50 miles (80 km) VEHICLE RECOVERY (freeing a stuck vehicle) WCE0146 Front Pulling a stuck vehicle WARNING ● Only use devices specifically designed for vehicle recovery and follow the manufacturer’s instructions. To avoid vehicle damage, serious personal injury or death when recovering a stuck vehicle: ● Always pull the recovery device straight out from the front of the vehicle. Never pull at an angle. ● Contact a professional towing service to recover the vehicle if you have any questions regarding the recovery procedure. ● Route recovery devices so they do not touch any part of the vehicle except the attachment point. ● Do not use the vehicle tie-downs to tow or free a stuck vehicle. 6-14 In case of emergency SCE0578 Rear I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : If your vehicle is stuck in sand, snow, mud, etc., use a tow strap or other device designed specifically for vehicle recovery. Always follow the manufacturer’s instructions for the recovery device. Do not use the tie-down hooks for towing or vehicle recovery. Rocking a stuck vehicle WARNING ● Stand clear of a stuck vehicle. ● Do not spin your tires at high speed. This could cause them to explode and result in serious injury. Parts of your vehicle could also overheat and be damaged. If your vehicle is stuck in sand, snow, mud, etc., use the following procedure: 4. Slowly rock the vehicle forward and backward. ● Shift back and forth between R (Reverse) and D (Drive) (CVT models) or 1st (Low) and R (Reverse) (M/T models). ● Apply the accelerator as little as possible to maintain the rocking motion. ● Release the accelerator pedal before shifting between R (Reverse) and D (Drive) (CVT models) or 1st (Low) and R (Reverse) (M/T models). ● Do not spin the tires above 35 mph (55 km/h). 5. If the vehicle cannot be freed after a few tries, contact a professional towing service to remove the vehicle. 1. Turn off the Vehicle Dynamic Control System (if so equipped). 2. Make sure the area in front and behind the vehicle is clear of obstructions. 3. Turn the steering wheel right and left to clear an area around the front tires. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : In case of emergency 6-15 MEMO 6-16 In case of emergency I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 7 Appearance and care Cleaning exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2 Washing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2 Waxing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2 Removing spots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3 Underbody . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3 Glass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3 Aluminum alloy wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3 Chrome parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4 Tire dressings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4 Cleaning interior. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4 Air fresheners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5 Floor mats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5 Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6 Corrosion protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6 Most common factors contributing to vehicle corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6 Environmental factors influence the rate of corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6 To protect your vehicle from corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : CLEANING EXTERIOR In order to maintain the appearance of your vehicle, it is important to take proper care of it. To protect the paint surfaces, please wash your vehicle as soon as you can: ● after a rainfall to prevent possible damage from acid rain. ● after driving on coastal roads. ● when contaminants such as soot, bird droppings, tree sap, metal particles or bugs get on the paint surface. ● when dust or mud builds up on the surface. Whenever possible, store or park your vehicle inside a garage or in a covered area. When it is necessary to park outside, park in a shady area or protect the vehicle with a body cover. Be careful not to scratch the paint surface when putting on or removing the body cover. WASHING Wash dirt off with a wet sponge and plenty of water. Clean the vehicle thoroughly using a mild soap, a special vehicle soap or general purpose dishwashing liquid mixed with clean, lukewarm (never hot) water. 7-2 Appearance and care CAUTION ● Do not use car washes that use acid in the detergent. Some car washes, especially brushless ones, use some acid for cleaning. The acid may react with some plastic vehicle components, causing them to crack. This could affect their appearance, and also could cause them not to function properly. Always check with your car wash to confirm that acid is not used. ● Do not wash the vehicle with strong household soap, strong chemical detergents, gasoline or solvents. ● Do not wash the vehicle in direct sunlight or while the vehicle body is hot, as the surface may become water-spotted. ● Avoid using tight-napped or rough cloths, such as washing mitts. Care must be taken when removing caked-on dirt or other foreign substances so the paint surface is not scratched or damaged. Rinse the vehicle thoroughly with plenty of clean water. Inside flanges, seams and folds on the doors, hatches and hood are particularly vulnerable to I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : the effects of road salt. Therefore, these areas must be cleaned regularly. Take care that the drain holes in the lower edge of the door are open. Spray water under the body and in the wheel wells to loosen the dirt and wash away road salt. A damp chamois can be used to dry the vehicle to avoid water spots. WAXING Regular waxing protects the paint surface and helps retain new vehicle appearance. Polishing is recommended to remove built-up wax residue and to avoid a weathered appearance before re-applying wax. A NISSAN dealer can assist you in choosing the proper product. ● Wax your vehicle only after a thorough washing. Follow the instructions supplied with the wax. ● Do not use a wax containing any abrasives, cutting compounds or cleaners that may damage the vehicle finish. Machine compounding or aggressive polishing on a base coat/clear coat paint finish may dull the finish or leave swirl marks. The high-mounted stop light must be properly reinstalled before driving your vehicle. REMOVING SPOTS Remove tar and oil spots, industrial dust, insects, and tree sap as quickly as possible from the surface of the paint to avoid lasting damage or staining. Special cleaning products are available at a NISSAN dealer or any automotive accessory store. Use glass cleaner to remove smoke and dust film from the glass surfaces. It is normal for glass to become coated with a film after the vehicle is parked in the hot sun. Glass cleaner and a soft cloth will easily remove this film. UNDERBODY In areas where road salt is used in winter, it is necessary to clean the underbody regularly in order to prevent dirt and salt from building up and causing the acceleration of corrosion on the underbody and suspension. Before the winter period and again in the spring, the underseal must be checked and, if necessary, retreated. CAUTION WAI0005 GLASS When cleaning the rear window, it may be easier to clean if the inside high-mounted stop light (if so equipped) is removed first. Be careful when removing the high-mounted stop light to reduce the risk of damaging the high-mounted stop light wires. When cleaning the inside of the windows, do not use sharp-edged tools, abrasive cleaners or chlorine-based disinfectant cleaners. They could damage the electrical conductors, radio antenna elements or rear window defroster elements. ALUMINUM ALLOY WHEELS Wash the wheels regularly with a sponge dampened in a mild soap solution, especially during winter months in areas where road salt is used. If not removed, road salt can discolor the wheels. To remove the high-mounted stop light: 1 䊊 2 䊊 Push toward rear of vehicle. Lift to remove. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Appearance and care 7-3 CLEANING INTERIOR CAUTION Follow the directions below to avoid staining or discoloring the wheels: ● Do not use a cleaner that uses strong acid or alkali contents to clean the wheels. ● Do not apply wheel cleaners to the wheels when they are hot. The wheel temperature should be the same as ambient temperature. ● Rinse the wheel to completely remove the cleaner within 15 minutes after the cleaner is applied. If you choose to use a tire dressing, take the following precautions: ● Use a water-based tire dressing. The coating on the tire dissolves more easily than with an oil-based tire dressing. ● Apply a light coat of tire dressing to help prevent it from entering the tire tread/grooves (where it would be difficult to remove). ● Wipe off excess tire dressing using a dry towel. Make sure the tire dressing is completely removed from the tire tread/grooves. ● Allow the tire dressing to dry as recommended by the tire dressing manufacturer. CHROME PARTS Clean all chrome parts regularly with a nonabrasive chrome polish to maintain the finish. Occasionally remove loose dust from the interior trim, plastic parts and seats using a vacuum cleaner or soft bristled brush. Wipe the vinyl and leather surfaces with a clean, soft cloth dampened in mild soap solution, then wipe clean with a dry, soft cloth. Regular care and cleaning is required in order to maintain the appearance of the leather. Before using any fabric protector, read the manufacturer’s recommendations. Some fabric protectors contain chemicals that may stain or bleach the seat material. Use a cloth dampened only with water to clean the meter and gauge lens. TIRE DRESSINGS NISSAN does not recommend the use of tire dressings. Tire manufacturers apply a coating to the tires to help reduce discoloration of the rubber. If a tire dressing is applied to the tires, it may react with the coating and form a compound. This compound may come off the tire while driving and stain the vehicle paint. 7-4 Appearance and care This vehicle has new and unique surfaces on the center console and door pull finishers. If cleaning is required use mild soap and water. However if mild soap and water won’t clean the center console and door pull finishers, use NISSAN Vinyl and Leather Cleaner (or equivalent). WARNING Do not use water or acidic cleaners (hot steam cleaners) on the seat. This can damage the seat or occupant classification sensor. This can also affect the operation of the air bag system and result in serious personal injury. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : CAUTION ● Never use benzene, thinner, or any similar material on the interior surfaces or surface damage may occur. Such damage is not covered under the NISSAN warranty. ● Small dirt particles can be abrasive and damaging to leather surfaces and should be removed promptly. Do not use saddle soap, car waxes, polishes, oils, cleaning fluids, solvents, detergents or ammonia-based cleaners as they may damage the leather’s natural finish. AIR FRESHENERS Most air fresheners use a solvent that could affect the vehicle interior. If you use an air freshener, take the following precautions: ● Hanging-type air fresheners can cause permanent discoloration when they contact vehicle interior surfaces. Place the air freshener in a location that allows it to hang free and not contact an interior surface. ● Liquid-type air fresheners typically clip on the vents. These products can cause immediate damage and discoloration when spilled on interior surfaces. ● Never use fabric protectors unless recommended by the manufacturer. Carefully read and follow the manufacturer’s instructions before using the air fresheners. ● Do not use glass or plastic cleaner on meter or gauge lens covers. It may damage the lens cover. FLOOR MATS The use of genuine NISSAN floor mats can extend the life of your vehicle carpet and make it easier to clean the interior. No matter what mats are used, be sure they are fitted for your vehicle and are properly positioned in the footwell to prevent interference with pedal operation. Mats should be maintained with regular cleaning and replaced if they become excessively worn. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : LPD0484 Floor mat positioning aid This vehicle includes a front floor mat bracket to act as a floor mat positioning aid. NISSAN floor mats have been specially designed for your vehicle model. The driver’s and passenger’s side floor mats have a grommet hole incorporated in them. Position the mat by placing the floor mat bracket hook through the floor mat grommet hole while centering the mat in the footwell. Periodically check to make certain the mats are properly positioned. Appearance and care 7-5 CORROSION PROTECTION SEAT BELTS The seat belts can be cleaned by wiping them with a sponge dampened in a mild soap solution. Allow the belts to dry completely in the shade before using them. See “Seat belt maintenance” in the “Safety – Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system” section of this manual. WARNING Do not allow wet seat belts to roll up in the retractor. NEVER use bleach, dye or chemical solvents to clean the seat belts, since these materials may severely weaken the seat belt webbing. MOST COMMON FACTORS CONTRIBUTING TO VEHICLE CORROSION ● The accumulation of moisture-retaining dirt and debris in body panel sections, cavities, and other areas. ● Damage to paint and other protective coatings caused by gravel and stone chips or minor traffic accidents. ENVIRONMENTAL FACTORS INFLUENCE THE RATE OF CORROSION Moisture Accumulation of sand, dirt and water on the vehicle body underside can accelerate corrosion. Wet floor coverings will not dry completely inside the vehicle and should be removed for drying to avoid floor panel corrosion. Relative humidity Corrosion will be accelerated in areas of high relative humidity, especially those areas where the temperatures stay above freezing and where atmospheric pollution exists and road salt is used. 7-6 Appearance and care I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Temperature High temperatures accelerate the rate of corrosion to those parts which are not well ventilated. Air pollution Industrial pollution, the presence of salt in the air in coastal areas, or heavy road salt use accelerates the corrosion process. Road salt also accelerates the disintegration of paint surfaces. TO PROTECT YOUR VEHICLE FROM CORROSION ● Wash and wax your vehicle often to keep the vehicle clean. ● Always check for minor damage to the paint and repair it as soon as possible. ● Keep drain holes at the bottom of the doors open to avoid water accumulation. ● Check the underbody for accumulation of sand, dirt or salt. If present, wash with water as soon as possible. CAUTION ● NEVER remove dirt, sand or other debris from the passenger compartment by washing it out with a hose. Remove dirt with a vacuum cleaner or broom. ● Never allow water or other liquids to come in contact with electronic components inside the vehicle as this may damage them. Chemicals used for road surface de-icing are extremely corrosive. They accelerate corrosion and deterioration of underbody components such as the exhaust system, fuel and brake lines, brake cables, floor pan and fenders. In winter, the underbody must be cleaned periodically. For additional protection against rust and corrosion, which may be required in some areas, consult a NISSAN dealer. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Appearance and care 7-7 MEMO 7-8 Appearance and care I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 8 Maintenance and do-it-yourself Maintenance requirements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2 General maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2 Explanation of general maintenance items . . . . . . . . . 8-2 Maintenance precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5 Engine compartment check locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6 Engine cooling system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8 Checking engine coolant level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8 Changing engine coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9 Engine oil. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9 Checking engine oil level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9 Changing engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-11 Changing engine oil filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12 Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) fluid . . . . . . 8-13 Brake and clutch fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13 Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13 Clutch fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14 Windshield-washer fluid. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14 Windshield-washer fluid reservoir . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14 Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15 Jump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16 Drive belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16 Spark plugs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17 Replacing spark plugs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17 Air cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18 In-cabin microfilter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19 Windshield wiper blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-20 Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-20 Replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-20 Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-21 Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-22 Engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-22 Passenger compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-24 Battery replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-25 Keyfob (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-25 NISSAN Intelligent Key™ (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . 8-27 Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-28 Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-28 Exterior and interior lights. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-29 Wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-31 Tire pressure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-31 Tire labeling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-35 Types of tires. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-37 Tire chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-38 Changing wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-38 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS Your NISSAN has been designed to have minimum maintenance requirements with long service intervals to save you both time and money. However, some day-to-day and regular maintenance is essential to maintain your NISSAN’s good mechanical condition, as well as its emissions and engine performance. It is the owner’s responsibility to make sure that the scheduled maintenance, as well as general maintenance, is performed. As the vehicle owner, you are the only one who can ensure that your vehicle receives proper maintenance. You are a vital link in the maintenance chain. Scheduled maintenance For your convenience, both required and optional scheduled maintenance items are described and listed in your “NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide”. You must refer to that guide to ensure that necessary maintenance is performed on your NISSAN at regular intervals. GENERAL MAINTENANCE Performing general maintenance checks requires minimal mechanical skill and only a few general automotive tools. These checks or inspections can be done by you, a qualified technician, or, if you prefer, a NISSAN dealer. Where to go for service If maintenance service is required or your vehicle appears to malfunction, have the systems checked and corrected by a NISSAN dealer. NISSAN technicians are well-trained specialists who are kept up-to-date with the latest service information through technical bulletins, service tips, and in-dealership training programs. They are completely qualified to work on NISSAN vehicles before they work on your vehicle, rather than after they have worked on it. You can be confident that a NISSAN dealer’s service department performs the best job to meet the maintenance requirements on your vehicle — in a reliable and economical way. 8-2 Maintenance and do-it-yourself When performing any checks or maintenance work, closely observe the “Maintenance precautions” later in this section. EXPLANATION OF GENERAL MAINTENANCE ITEMS Additional information on the following items with “ * ” is found later in this section. Outside the vehicle The maintenance items listed here should be performed from time to time, unless otherwise specified. Doors and engine hood Check that the doors and engine hood operate properly. Also ensure that all latches lock securely. Lubricate hinges, latches, latch pins, rollers and links as necessary. Make sure that the secondary latch keeps the hood from opening when the primary latch is released. General maintenance General maintenance includes those items which should be checked during normal day-to-day operation. They are essential for proper vehicle operation. It is your responsibility to perform these maintenance procedures regularly as prescribed. During the normal day-to-day operation of the vehicle, general maintenance should be performed regularly as prescribed in this section. If you detect any unusual sounds, vibrations or smells, be sure to check for the cause or have a NISSAN dealer do it promptly. In addition, you should notify a NISSAN dealer if you think that repairs are required. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : When driving in areas using road salt or other corrosive materials, check lubrication frequently. Lights* Clean the headlights on a regular basis. Make sure that the headlights, stop lights, tail lights, turn signal lights, and other lights are all operating properly and installed securely. Also check headlight aim. Road wheel nuts (lug nuts)* When checking the tires, make sure no wheel nuts are missing, and check for any loose wheel nuts. Tighten if necessary. Tire rotation* Tires should be rotated every 7,500 miles (12,000 km). Tires* Check the pressure with a gauge often and always prior to long distance trips. If necessary, adjust the pressure in all tires, including the spare, to the pressure specified. Check carefully for damage, cuts or excessive wear. Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) transmitter components Replace the TPMS transmitter grommet seal, valve core and cap when the tires are replaced due to wear or age. Wheel alignment and balance If the vehicle should pull to either side while driving on a straight and level road, or if you detect uneven or abnormal tire wear, there may be a need for wheel alignment. If the steering wheel or seat vibrates at normal highway speeds, wheel balancing may be needed. ● For additional information regarding tires, refer to “Important Tire Safety Information” (US) or “Tire Safety Information” (Canada) in the Warranty Information Booklet. Windshield Clean the windshield on a regular basis. Check the windshield at least every six months for cracks or other damage. Have a damaged windshield repaired by a qualified repair facility. Windshield wiper blades* Check for cracks or wear if they do not wipe properly. Inside the vehicle The maintenance items listed here should be checked on a regular basis, such as when performing periodic maintenance, cleaning the vehicle, etc. Additional information on the following items with an “*” is found later in this section. Accelerator pedal Check the pedal for smooth operation and make sure the pedal does not bind or require uneven effort. Keep the floor mat away from the pedal. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Brake pedal Check the pedal for smooth operation. If the brake pedal suddenly goes down further than normal, the pedal feels spongy or the vehicle seems to take longer to stop, see a NISSAN dealer immediately. Keep the floor mat away from the pedal. Brakes Check that the brakes do not pull the vehicle to one side when applied. Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) P (Park) position mechanism On a fairly steep hill, check that the vehicle is held securely with the shift selector in the P (Park) position without applying any brakes. Parking brake Check the parking brake operation regularly. The vehicle should be securely held on a fairly steep hill with only the parking brake applied. If the parking brake needs adjustment, see a NISSAN dealer. Seats Check seat position controls such as seat adjusters, seatback recliner, etc., to ensure they operate smoothly and all latches lock securely in every position. Check that the head restraints and headrests move up and down smoothly and the locks (if so equipped) hold securely in all latched positions. Seat belts Check that all parts of the seat belt system (for example, buckles, anchors, adjusters and retractors) operate properly and smoothly, Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-3 and are installed securely. Check the belt webbing for cuts, fraying, wear or damage. Engine coolant level* Check the coolant level when the engine is cold. Steering wheel Check for changes in the steering system, such as excessive freeplay, hard steering or strange noises. Engine drive belts* Make sure the drive belts are not frayed, worn, cracked or oily. Warning lights and chimes Make sure all warning lights and chimes are operating properly. Windshield wiper and washer* Check that the wipers and washer operate properly and that the wipers do not streak. Windshield defroster Check that the air comes out of the defroster outlets properly and in sufficient quantity when operating the heater or air conditioner. Under the hood and vehicle The maintenance items listed here should be checked periodically (for example, each time you check the engine oil or refuel). Battery* Check the fluid level in each cell. It should be between the MAX and MIN lines. Vehicles operated in high temperatures or under severe conditions require frequent checks of the battery fluid level. Brake and clutch fluid levels* Make sure that the brake and clutch fluid level is between the MIN and MAX lines on the reservoir. 8-4 Maintenance and do-it-yourself Engine oil level* Check the level after parking the vehicle on a level surface with the engine off. Wait more than 10 minutes for the oil to drain back into the oil pan. Exhaust system Make sure there are no loose supports, cracks or holes. If the sound of the exhaust seems unusual or there is a smell of exhaust fumes, immediately have the exhaust system inspected by a NISSAN dealer. See the carbon monoxide warning in the “Starting and driving” section of this manual. Fluid leaks Check under the vehicle for fuel, oil, water or other fluid leaks after the vehicle has been parked for a while. Water dripping from the air conditioner after use is normal. If you should notice any leaks or if gasoline fumes are evident, check for the cause and have it corrected immediately. Radiator and hoses Check the front of the radiator and clean off any dirt, insects, leaves, etc., that may have accumulated. Make sure the hoses have no cracks, deformation, rot or loose connections. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Underbody The underbody is frequently exposed to corrosive substances such as those used on icy roads or to control dust. It is very important to remove these substances from the underbody, otherwise rust may form on the floor pan, frame, fuel lines and exhaust system. At the end of winter, the underbody should be thoroughly flushed with plain water, in those areas where mud and dirt may have accumulated. See the “Appearance and care” section of this manual. Windshield-washer fluid* Check that there is adequate fluid in the reservoir. MAINTENANCE PRECAUTIONS When performing any inspection or maintenance work on your vehicle, always take care to prevent serious accidental injury to yourself or damage to the vehicle. The following are general precautions which should be closely observed. WARNING ● Park the vehicle on a level surface, apply the parking brake securely and block the wheels to prevent the vehicle from moving. For manual transmission models, move the shift selector to N (Neutral). For CVT models, move the shift selector to P (Park). ● Be sure the ignition switch is in the OFF or LOCK position when performing any parts replacement or repairs. ● If you must work with the engine running, keep your hands, clothing, hair and tools away from moving fans, belts and any other moving parts. ● It is advisable to secure or remove any loose clothing and remove any jewelry, such as rings, watches, etc. before working on your vehicle. ● Always wear eye protection whenever you work on your vehicle. ● If you must run the engine in an enclosed space such as a garage, be sure there is proper ventilation for exhaust gases to escape. ● Never leave the engine or the CVT related component harness connector disconnected while the ignition switch is in the ON position. ● Never get under the vehicle while it is supported only by a jack. If it is necessary to work under the vehicle, support it with safety stands. ● Never connect or disconnect the battery or any transistorized component while the ignition switch is in the ON position. ● Keep smoking materials, flame and sparks away from the fuel tank and battery. ● On gasoline engine models, the fuel filter or fuel lines should be serviced by a NISSAN dealer because the fuel lines are under high pressure even when the engine is off. CAUTION ● Do not work under the hood while the engine is hot. Turn the engine off and wait until it cools down. ● Avoid contact with used engine oil and coolant. Improperly disposed engine oil, engine coolant and/or other vehicle fluids can damage the environment. Always conform to local regulations for disposal of vehicle fluid. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ● Your vehicle is equipped with an automatic engine cooling fan. It may come on at any time without warning, even if the ignition key is in the OFF position and the engine is not running. To avoid injury, always disconnect the negative battery cable before working near the fan. This “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section gives instructions regarding only those items which are relatively easy for an owner to perform. A genuine NISSAN service manual is also available. See “Owner’s Manual/Service Manual order information” in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual. You should be aware that incomplete or improper servicing may result in operating difficulties or excessive emissions, and could affect warranty coverage. If in doubt about any servicing, have it done by a NISSAN dealer. Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-5 ENGINE COMPARTMENT CHECK LOCATIONS MR20DE engine 1. 2. 3. Engine coolant reservoir Engine oil filler cap Brake fluid reservoir/Clutch fluid reservoir (M/T model) 4. Battery 5. Air cleaner 6. Fuse/Fusible link box 7. Radiator cap 8. Engine oil dipstick 9. Drive belt location 10. Windshield-washer fluid reservoir LDI0709 8-6 Maintenance and do-it-yourself I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : QR25DE engine 1. 2. 3. Engine coolant reservoir Engine oil filler cap Brake fluid reservoir/Clutch fluid reservoir (M/T model) 4. Battery 5. Air cleaner 6. Fuse/Fusible link box 7. Radiator cap 8. Engine oil dipstick 9. Drive belt location 10. Windshield-washer fluid reservoir * Engine cover removed for clarity. WDI0637 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-7 ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM The engine cooling system is filled at the factory with Genuine NISSAN Engine Coolant to provide year-round anti-freeze and coolant protection. The anti-freeze solution contains rust and corrosion inhibitors. Additional engine cooling system additives are not necessary. WARNING ● Never remove the radiator or coolant reservoir cap when the engine is hot. Wait until the engine and radiator cool down. Serious burns could be caused by high pressure fluid escaping from the radiator. See precautions in “If your vehicle overheats” found in the “In case of emergency” section of this manual. ● The radiator is equipped with a pressure type radiator cap. To prevent engine damage, use only a genuine NISSAN radiator cap. CAUTION When adding or replacing coolant, be sure to use only a Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant or equivalent with the proper mixture ratio of 50% anti-freeze and 50% demineralized or distilled water. The use of other types of coolant solutions other than Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant or equivalent, may damage the engine cooling system. Outside temperature down to °C °F -35 -30 Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/ Coolant or equivalent 50% Demineralized or distilled water LDI0537 MR20DE 50% CHECKING ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL Check the coolant level in the reservoir when the engine is cold. If the coolant level is below B , add coolant to the MAX level the MIN level 䊊 A . If the reservoir is empty, check the coolant 䊊 level in the radiator when the engine is cold. If there is insufficient coolant in the radiator, fill the radiator with coolant up to the filler opening and A. also add it to the reservoir up to the MAX level 䊊 If the cooling system frequently requires coolant, have it checked by a NISSAN dealer. 8-8 Maintenance and do-it-yourself I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ENGINE OIL WARNING ● To avoid the danger of being scalded, never change the coolant when the engine is hot. ● Never remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could be caused by high pressure fluid escaping from the radiator. ● Avoid direct skin contact with used coolant. If skin contact is made, wash thoroughly with soap or hand cleaner as soon as possible. LDI0589 QR25DE CHANGING ENGINE COOLANT A NISSAN dealer can change the engine coolant. The service procedure can be found in the NISSAN Service Manual. ● Keep coolant out of the reach of children and pets. Engine coolant must be disposed of properly. Check your local regulations. WDI0591 MR20DE CHECKING ENGINE OIL LEVEL 1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and apply the parking brake. 2. Start the engine and let it idle until it reaches operating temperature. Improper servicing can result in reduced heater performance and engine overheating. 3. Turn off the engine. Wait more than 10 minutes for the oil to drain back into the oil pan. 4. Remove the dipstick and wipe it clean. Reinsert it all the way. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-9 LDI0590 QR25DE 5. Remove the dipstick again and check the oil level. It should be between the H (High) and B . This is the normal operL (Low) marks 䊊 ating oil level range. If the oil level is below A , remove the oil filler cap the L (Low) mark 䊊 and pour recommended oil through the C. opening. Do not overfill 䊊 6. Recheck oil level with the dipstick. It is normal to add some oil between oil maintenance intervals or during the break-in period, depending on the severity of operating conditions. 8-10 Maintenance and do-it-yourself WDI0521 LDI0371 CAUTION Oil level should be checked regularly. Operating the engine with an insufficient amount of oil can damage the engine, and such damage is not covered by warranty. Make sure to follow the engine oil changing intervals in the maintenance booklet. Operating under the following conditions may require more frequent oil change: ● repeated short distance driving ● driving in dusty conditions ● stop and go commuting. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : MR20DE engine A 䊊 B 䊊 C 䊊 Oil filler cap Oil drain plug Oil filter 4. Place a large drain pan under the drain plug B. 䊊 B with a wrench by 5. Remove the drain plug 䊊 turning it counterclockwise and completely drain the oil. QR25DE engine A 䊊 B 䊊 C 䊊 7. Refill engine with recommended oil through the oil filler opening, then install the oil filler cap securely. ● Waste oil must be disposed of properly. See “Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants” in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual for drain and refill capacity. Oil drain plug ● Try to avoid direct skin contact with used oil. If skin contact is made, wash thoroughly with soap or hand cleaner as soon as possible. Oil filter CHANGING ENGINE OIL 1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and apply the parking brake. 2. Start the engine and let it idle until it reaches operating temperature, then turn it off. 3. Remove the oil filler cap counterclockwise. 䊊 A WARNING ● Prolonged and repeated contact with used engine oil may cause skin cancer. Oil filler cap by turning it Drain plug tightening torque: 22 - 29 ft-lb (29 - 39 N·m) If the oil filter is to be changed, remove and replace it at this time. See “Changing engine oil filter” later in this section. ● Check your local regulations. WDI0597 6. Clean and reinstall the drain plug and a new washer. Securely tighten the drain plug with a wrench. Do not use excessive force. ● Keep used engine oil out of reach of children. The drain and refill capacity depends on the oil temperature and drain time. Use these specifications for reference only. Always use the dipstick to determine when the proper amount of oil is in the engine. 8. Start the engine. Check for leakage around the drain plug and oil filter. Correct as required. 9. Turn the engine off and wait more than 10 minutes. Check the oil level with the dipstick. Add engine oil if necessary. CAUTION Be careful not to burn yourself. The engine oil may be hot. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-11 CAUTION Be careful not to burn yourself. The engine oil may be hot. 5. Wipe the engine oil filter sealing surface with a clean rag. CAUTION Be sure to remove any old gasket material remaining on the sealing surface of the engine. Failure to do so could lead to engine damage. WDI0521 WDI0597 QR25DE engine MR20DE engine A 䊊 B 䊊 C 䊊 Oil filler cap Oil drain plug Oil filter A 䊊 B 䊊 C 䊊 Oil filler cap Oil drain plug Oil filter CHANGING ENGINE OIL FILTER 1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and apply the parking brake. 2. Turn the engine off. C. 3. Place a large drain pan under the oil filter 䊊 4. Loosen the oil filter with an oil filter wrench by turning it counterclockwise. Then remove the oil filter by turning it by hand. 8-12 Maintenance and do-it-yourself I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 6. Coat the gasket on the new filter with clean engine oil. 7. Screw on the oil filter until a slight resistance is felt, then tighten an additional 2/3 turn. 8. Start the engine and check for leakage around the oil filter. Correct as required. 9. Turn the engine off and wait more than 10 minutes. Check the oil level. Add engine oil if necessary. CONTINUOUSLY VARIABLE TRANSMISSION (CVT) FLUID CAUTION ● Use only Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-2. Do not mix with other fluids. ● Using transmission fluid other than Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-2 will damage the CVT, which is not covered by the NISSAN new vehicle limited warranty. When checking or replacement of CVT fluid is required, we recommend your NISSAN dealer for servicing. BRAKE AND CLUTCH FLUID For further brake and clutch fluid specification information, refer to “Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants” in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual. WARNING ● Use only new fluid from a sealed container. Old, inferior or contaminated fluid may damage the brake and clutch systems. The use of improper fluids can damage the brake system and affect the vehicle’s stopping ability. ● Clean the filler cap before removing. ● Brake and clutch fluid is poisonous and should be stored carefully in marked containers out of reach of children. CAUTION Do not spill the fluid on any painted surfaces. This will damage the paint. If fluid is spilled, immediately wash the surface with water. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : LDI0539 BRAKE FLUID Check the brake fluid level in the reservoir. If the brake warning light comes on, add Genuine NISSAN Brake Fluid or equivalent DOT 3 fluid up A . If fluid must be added freto the MAX line 䊊 quently, the system should be checked by a NISSAN dealer. Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-13 WINDSHIELD-WASHER FLUID Refill the reservoir more frequently when driving conditions require an increased amount of windshield-washer fluid. Recommended fluid is Genuine NISSAN Windshield Washer Concentrate Cleaner & Antifreeze or equivalent. CAUTION ● Do not substitute engine anti-freeze coolant for windshield-washer solution. This may result in damage to the paint. LDI0539 CLUTCH FLUID Check the clutch fluid level in the reservoir (manual transmissions only). Add Genuine NISSAN Brake Fluid or equivalent DOT 3 fluid up A . If fluid must be added freto the MAX line 䊊 quently, the system should be checked by a NISSAN dealer. LDI0540 WINDSHIELD-WASHER FLUID RESERVOIR Fill the windshield-washer fluid reservoir periodically. Add windshield-washer fluid when the low windshield-washer fluid warning light comes on (if so equipped). To fill the windshield-washer fluid reservoir, lift the cap off the reservoir tank and pour the windshield-washer fluid into the tank opening. Add a washer solvent to the washer for better cleaning. In the winter season, add a windshieldwasher antifreeze. Follow the manufacturer’s instructions for the mixture ratio. 8-14 Maintenance and do-it-yourself I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ● Do not fill the windshield-washer fluid reservoir tank with washer fluid concentrates at full strength. Some methyl alcohol based washer fluid concentrates may permanently stain the grille if spilled while filling the windshieldwasher fluid reservoir tank. ● Pre-mix washer fluid concentrates with water to the manufacturer’s recommended levels before pouring the fluid into the windshield-washer fluid reservoir tank. Do not use the windshieldwasher reservoir tank to mix the washer fluid concentrate and water. BATTERY ● Keep the battery surface clean and dry. Clean the battery with a solution of baking soda and water. ● Make certain the terminal connections are clean and securely tightened. ● If the vehicle is not to be used for 30 days or longer, disconnect the negative (-) battery terminal cable to prevent discharge. WARNING ● Do not expose the battery to flames, an electrical spark or a cigarette. Hydrogen gas generated by the battery is explosive. Explosive gases can cause blindness or injury. Do not allow battery fluid to contact your skin, eyes, fabrics or painted surfaces. Sulfuric acid can cause blindness or injury. After touching a battery or battery cap, do not touch or rub your eyes. Thoroughly wash your hands. If the acid contacts your eyes, skin or clothing, immediately flush with water for at least 15 minutes and seek medical attention. ● Do not operate the vehicle if the fluid in the battery is low. Low battery fluid can cause a higher load on the battery which can generate heat, reduce battery life, and in some cases lead to an explosion. ● When working on or near a battery, always wear suitable eye protection and remove all jewelry. ● Battery posts, terminals and related accessories contain lead and lead compounds. Wash hands after handling. ● Keep battery out of the reach of children. ● Do not tip the battery. Keep the vent caps tight and the battery level. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : WDI0224 1. Remove the vent caps with a screwdriver as shown. Use a cloth to protect the battery case. Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-15 DRIVE BELT Vehicles operated in high temperatures or under severe conditions require frequent checks of the battery fluid level. JUMP STARTING If jump starting is necessary, see “Jump starting” in the “In case of emergency” section of this manual. If the engine does not start by jump starting, the battery may have to be replaced. Contact a NISSAN dealer. WDI0638 MR20DE model 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. WDI0529 2. Check the fluid level in each cell. If it is necessary to add fluid, add only distilled water to bring the level up to the bottom of the filler opening. Do not overfill. . Reinstall the vent caps. 8-16 Maintenance and do-it-yourself I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Automatic tensioner Generator Water pump Air conditioner compressor (with A/C) or Idler pulley (without A/C) Crankshaft pulley SPARK PLUGS 1. Visually inspect the belt for signs of unusual wear, cuts, or fraying. If the belt is in poor condition, have it replaced or adjusted by a NISSAN dealer. 2. Have the belt checked regularly for condition. WDI0696 SDI1895 QR25DE model 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. REPLACING SPARK PLUGS Crankshaft pulley Idler Pulley Automatic tensioner Water pump Generator Air conditioner compressor Platinum-tipped spark plugs (if so equipped) A It is not necessary to replace platinum-tipped 䊊 spark plugs as frequently as conventional type spark plugs because they last much longer. Follow the maintenance log shown in the “NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide”. Do not service platinum-tipped spark plugs by cleaning or regapping. WARNING Be sure the ignition switch is in the OFF or LOCK position before servicing drive belt. The engine could rotate unexpectedly. ● Always replace spark plugs with recommended or equivalent ones. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-17 AIR CLEANER WARNING Be sure the engine and ignition switch are off and that the parking brake is engaged securely. CAUTION WARNING Be sure the engine and ignition switch are off and that the parking brake is engaged securely. CAUTION Be sure to use the correct socket to remove the spark plugs. An incorrect socket can damage the spark plugs. Be sure to use the correct socket to remove the spark plugs. An incorrect socket can damage the spark plugs. If replacement is required, see your NISSAN dealer for assistance. If replacement is required, see your NISSAN dealer for assistance. Iridium-tipped spark plugs (if so equipped) LDI0710 MR20DE The air cleaner filter should not be cleaned and reused. Replace it according to the maintenance log shown in the “NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide.” A It is not necessary to replace iridium-tipped 䊊 spark plugs as frequently as conventional type spark plugs because they last much longer. Follow the maintenance log shown in the “NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide”. Do not service iridium-tipped spark plugs by cleaning or regapping. To remove the air cleaner filter: 3. Unlatch the clips and move the air cleaner cover upward. ● Always replace spark plugs with recommended or equivalent ones. 8-18 Maintenance and do-it-yourself 4. Remove the air cleaner filter. ● For the MR20DE, release the 2 retaining A and pull the unit upward. clips 䊊 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : A and ● For the QR25DE, push the tabs 䊊 B. pull the unit upward 䊊 WARNING ● Operating the engine with the air cleaner removed can cause you or others to be burned. The air cleaner not only cleans the air, it stops the flame if the engine backfires. If it isn’t there, and the engine backfires, you could be burned. Do not drive with the air cleaner removed, and be careful when working on the engine with the air cleaner removed. WDI0596 QR25DE 5. Wipe the inside of the air cleaner filter housing and the cover with a damp cloth. IN-CABIN MICROFILTER The in-cabin microfilter restricts the entry of airborne dust and pollen particles and reduces some objectionable outside odors. The filter is located behind the trim panel near the accelerator pedal. Refer to the “NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide” for change intervals. If replacement is required, see your NISSAN dealer. ● Never pour fuel into the throttle body or attempt to start the engine with the air cleaner removed. Doing so could result in serious injury. NOTE: After installing a new air cleaner, make sure the air cleaner cover is seated in the housing and latch the clips. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-19 WINDSHIELD WIPER BLADES CLEANING CAUTION If your windshield is not clear after using the windshield washer or if a wiper blade chatters when running, wax or other material may be on the blade or windshield. ● After wiper blade replacement, return the wiper arm to its original position; otherwise it may be damaged when the hood is opened. Clean the outside of the windshield with a washer solution or a mild detergent. Your windshield is clean if beads do not form when rinsing with clear water. ● Make sure the wiper blades contact the glass; otherwise the arms may be damaged from wind pressure. Clean each blade by wiping it with a cloth soaked in a washer solution or a mild detergent. Then rinse the blades with clear water. If your windshield is still not clear after cleaning the blades and using the wiper, install new windshield wiper blades. CAUTION Worn windshield wiper blades can damage the windshield and impair driver vision. WDI0408 REPLACING Replace the wiper blades if they are worn. 1. Lift the wiper arm away from the windshield. 䊊 2 3 䊊 Push the release tab, then move the wiper blade down the wiper arm to remove. Remove the wiper blade. 4. Insert the new wiper blade onto the wiper arm until it clicks into place. 5. Rotate wiper blade so the dimple is in the groove. 8-20 Maintenance and do-it-yourself I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : BRAKES If the brakes do not operate properly, have the brakes checked by a NISSAN dealer. Self-adjusting brakes Your vehicle is equipped with self-adjusting brakes. Proper brake inspection intervals should be followed. For more information regarding brake inspections, see the appropriate maintenance schedule information in the “NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide”. The front and rear disc-type brakes self-adjust every time the brake pedal is applied. WARNING See a NISSAN dealer for a brake system check if the brake pedal height does not return to normal. Brake pad wear indicators WDI0337 If you wax the surface of the hood, be careful not A . This may to let wax get into the washer nozzle 䊊 cause clogging or improper windshield-washer operation. If wax gets into the nozzle, remove it B. with a needle or small pin 䊊 The disc brake pads on your vehicle have audible wear indicators. When a brake pad requires replacement, a high pitched scraping or screeching sound will be heard when the vehicle is in motion. The noise will be heard whether or not the brake pedal is depressed. Have the brakes checked as soon as possible if the wear indicator sound is heard. Under some driving or climate conditions, occasional brake squeak, squeal or other noise may be heard. Occasional brake noise during light to moderate stops is normal and does not affect the function or performance of the brake system. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-21 FUSES LDI0455 Two types of fuses are used. Type 䊊 is used in the fuse boxes in the engine compartment. Type B is used in the passenger compartment fuse 䊊 box. A Type A fuses are provided as spare fuses. They are stored in the passenger compartment fuse box. Type A fuses can be installed in the engine compartment and passenger compartment fuse boxes. 8-22 Maintenance and do-it-yourself LDI0542 LDI0457 If a type A fuse is used to replace a type B fuse, the type A fuse will not be level with the fuse pocket as shown in the illustration. This will not affect the performance of the fuse. Make sure the fuse is installed in the fuse box securely. Type B fuses cannot be installed in the underhood fuse boxes. Only use type A fuses in the underhood fuse boxes. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : (MR20DE engine) ENGINE COMPARTMENT CAUTION Never use a fuse of a higher or lower amperage rating than specified on the fuse box cover. This could damage the electrical system or cause a fire. NOTE: For checking and replacing fuses on QR25DE engine models, see a NISSAN dealer. If any electrical equipment does not come on, check for an open fuse. 1. Be sure the ignition switch and the headlight switch are OFF. 2. Open the engine hood. 3. Remove the fuse box cover by pushing the A and lifting the cover up from the tabs 䊊 B. front 䊊 4. Remove the fuse with the fuse puller. The fuse puller is located in the center of the fuse block in the passenger compartment. LDI0546 WDI0452 5. If the fuse is open 䊊, replace it with a new B. fuse 䊊 MR20DE A 6. If a new fuse also opens, have the electrical system checked and repaired by a NISSAN dealer. Fusible links If any electrical equipment does not operate and the fuses are in good condition, check the fusible A ,䊊 B and 䊊 C . If any of these links in the holders 䊊 fusible links are melted, replace only with genuine NISSAN parts. For checking and replacing the fusible links in A and 䊊 B and 䊊 C , see a NISSAN dealer. holders 䊊 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-23 LDI0593 QR25DE WDI0569 PASSENGER COMPARTMENT CAUTION Never use a fuse of a higher or lower amperage rating than specified on the fuse box cover. This could damage the electrical system or cause a fire. If any electrical equipment does not operate, check for an open fuse. 1. Be sure the ignition switch and the headlight switch are OFF. A. 2. Open the storage bin 䊊 8-24 Maintenance and do-it-yourself I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 3. Pull the storage bin upward and out to reB . A fuse guide is on the storage bin. move 䊊 C . The 4. Remove the fuse with the fuse puller 䊊 fuse puller is located in the center of the fuse block. 5. If the fuse is open, replace it with an equivalent good fuse. 6. If a new fuse also opens, have the electrical system checked and repaired by a NISSAN dealer. 7. Install the storage bin. BATTERY REPLACEMENT CAUTION Be careful not to allow children to swallow the battery or removed parts. LDI0484 KEYFOB (if so equipped) Replace the battery in the keyfob as follows: 1 䊊 2 䊊 A. Open the lid using a coin 䊊 B. Remove the battery 䊊 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 3 䊊 C with the “+” facing Install a new battery 䊊 down. ● Hold the battery by the edges. Holding the battery across the contact points will seriously deplete the storage capacity. Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-25 ● Do not touch the internal circuit and electric terminals as it could cause a malfunction. ● When changing the battery, do not let dust or oil get on the keyfob. FCC Notice: Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. ● There is danger of explosion if a lithium battery is incorrectly replaced. Replace only with the same or equivalent type. This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules and RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Recommended battery: CR2025 or equivalent. 4 䊊 Close the lid securely. button, then the 5. Press the button two or three times to check the keyfob operation. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. If the battery is removed for any reason other than replacement, perform step 5. ● An improperly disposed battery can hurt the environment. Always confirm local regulations for battery disposal. ● The keyfob is water-resistant; however, if it does get wet, immediately wipe completely dry. ● The operational range of the keyfob extends to approximately 33 ft (10 m) from the vehicle. This range may vary with conditions. SDI1867 8-26 Maintenance and do-it-yourself I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY™ (if so equipped) Replace the battery in the Intelligent Key as follows: 1. Remove the mechanical key from the Intelligent Key. A into the slit 䊊 B 2. Insert a small screwdriver 䊊 of the corner and twist it to separate the upper part from the lower part. Use a cloth to protect the casing. 3. Replace the battery with a new one. Recommended battery: CR2025 or equivalent. ● Do not touch the internal circuit and electric terminals as doing so could cause a malfunction. ● Hold the battery by the edges. Holding the battery across the contact points will seriously deplete the storage capacity. ● Make sure that the + side faces the bottom of the case. WDI0535 C 䊊 D. 4. Close the lid securely as illustrated 䊊 5. Operate the buttons to check the operation. See a NISSAN dealer if you need assistance for replacement. FCC Notice: Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules and RSS-210 of Industry Canada. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-27 LIGHTS HEADLIGHTS Replacing the halogen headlight bulb ● Use the same number and wattage as shown in the chart. The headlight is a semi-sealed beam type which uses a replaceable headlight (halogen) bulb. Because the headlight assembly must be removed from the vehicle for bulb replacement, see your NISSAN dealer. Fog may temporarily form inside the lens of the exterior lights in the rain or in a car wash. A temperature difference between the inside and the outside of the lens causes the fog. This is not a malfunction. If large drops of water collect inside the lens, contact a NISSAN dealer. CAUTION ● Aiming is not necessary after replacing the bulb. When aiming adjustment is necessary, contact a NISSAN dealer. ● Do not leave the headlight assembly open without a bulb installed for a long period of time. Dust, moisture, smoke, etc. entering the headlight body may affect bulb performance. Remove the bulb from the headlight assembly just before a replacement bulb is installed. ● Only touch the base when handling the bulb. Never touch the glass envelope. Touching the glass could significantly affect bulb life and/or headlight performance. ● High pressure halogen gas is sealed inside the halogen bulb. The bulb may break if the glass envelope is scratched or the bulb is dropped. 8-28 Maintenance and do-it-yourself I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : EXTERIOR AND INTERIOR LIGHTS Item Headlight assembly Low/High (Halogen) Turn/Park Side marker Front fog light* (if so equipped) Front map lights* (if so equipped) Interior light Trunk light High-mounted stop light* Inside (if so equipped) Spoiler (if so equipped) Rear combination light Turn signal light Stop/Tail Backup (reversing) Rear side marker License plate light* Wattage (W) Bulb No.* 55/60 27/7 4 55 8 8 5 H13 3457AK 194 H11LL 168 AL57 158 16 — 921LF LED 27/7 27/7 16 4 5 3057K 3057K 921 194 W5W * Always check with the Parts Department at a NISSAN dealer for the latest parts information. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-29 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Front map lights (if so equipped) Interior light Headlight assembly Front fog light (if so equipped) High-mounted stop light (if so equipped) Spoiler mounted stop light (if so equipped) License plate light Rear combination light WDI0257 Indicates bulb removal Indicates bulb replacement Replacement procedures All other lights are either type A, B, C or D. When replacing a bulb, first remove the lens and/or cover. WDI0599 8-30 Maintenance and do-it-yourself I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : WHEELS AND TIRES If you have a flat tire, see “Flat tire” in the “In case of emergency” section of this manual. TIRE PRESSURE Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) (if so equipped) WDI0206 Interior light 1 to protect the interior light housUse a cloth 䊊 ing. LDI0711 Map light (if so equipped) A to protect the light housing. Use a cloth 䊊 This vehicle is equipped with the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). It monitors tire pressure of all tires except the spare. When the low tire pressure warning light is lit, one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. The TPMS will activate only when the vehicle is driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h). Also, this system may not detect a sudden drop in tire pressure (for example a flat tire while driving). For more details, refer to “Low tire pressure warning light” in the “Instruments and controls” section, “Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)” in the “Starting and driving” section, and “Flat tire” in the “In case of emergency” section. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-31 Tire inflation pressure Check the tire pressures (including the spare) often and always prior to long distance trips. The recommended tire pressure specifications are shown on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label or the Tire and Loading Information label under the “Cold Tire Pressure” heading. The Tire and Loading Information label is affixed to the driver side center pillar. Tire pressures should be checked regularly because: ● Most tires naturally lose air over time. ● Tires can lose air suddenly when driven over potholes or other objects or if the vehicle strikes a curb while parking. The tire pressures should be checked when the tires are cold. The tires are considered COLD after the vehicle has been parked for 3 or more hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km) at moderate speeds. 8-32 Maintenance and do-it-yourself Incorrect tire pressure, including under inflation, may adversely affect tire life and vehicle handling. WARNING ● Improperly inflated tires can fail suddenly and cause an accident. ● The Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) is located on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label. The vehicle weight capacity is indicated on the Tire and Loading Information label (if so equipped). Do not load your vehicle beyond this capacity. Overloading your vehicle may result in reduced tire life, unsafe operating conditions due to premature tire failure, or unfavorable handling characteristics and could also lead to a serious accident. Loading beyond the specified capacity may also result in failure of other vehicle components. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ● Before taking a long trip, or whenever you heavily load your vehicle, use a tire pressure gauge to ensure that the tire pressures are at the specified level. ● For additional information regarding tires, refer to “Important Tire Safety Information” (US) or “Tire Safety Information” (Canada) in the Warranty Information Booklet. 5 䊊 6 䊊 Tire size – refer to “Tire labeling” later in this section. Spare tire size. LDI0545 Tire and loading information label 1 䊊 2 䊊 3 䊊 Seating capacity: The maximum number of occupants that can be seated in the vehicle. Vehicle load limit: See “Vehicle loading information” in the “Technical and consumer information” section. Original tire size: The size of the tires originally installed on the vehicle at the factory. 4 䊊 Cold tire pressure: Inflate the tires to this pressure when the tires are cold. Tires are considered COLD after the vehicle has been parked for 3 or more hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km) at moderate speeds. The recommended cold tire inflation is set by the manufacturer to provide the best balance of tire wear, vehicle handling, driveability, tire noise, etc., up to the vehicle’s GVWR. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-33 4. Read the tire pressure on the gauge stem and compare to the specification shown on the Tire and Loading Information label. 5. Add air to the tire as needed. If too much air is added, press the core of the valve stem briefly with the tip of the gauge stem to release pressure. Recheck the pressure and add or release air as needed. 6. Install the valve stem cap. LDI0393 Checking tire pressure 7. Check the pressure of all other tires, including the spare. 1. Remove the valve stem cap from the tire. 2. Press the pressure gauge squarely onto the valve stem. Do not press too hard or force the valve stem sideways, or air will escape. If the hissing sound of air escaping from the tire is heard while checking the pressure, reposition the gauge to eliminate this leakage. 3. Remove the gauge. 8-34 Maintenance and do-it-yourself I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Size Front Original Tire: P205/60R15 P205/55R16 P225/45R17 Rear Original Tire: P205/60R15 P205/55R16 P225/45R17 Spare Tire: T125/70D16 Cold Tire Inflation Pressure 230 kPa, 33 PSI 240 kPa, 35 PSI 230 kPa, 33 PSI 240 kPa, 35 PSI 420 kPa, 60 PSI WDI0394 WDI0395 Example TIRE LABELING Federal law requires tire manufacturers to place standardized information on the sidewall of all tires. This information identifies and describes the fundamental characteristics of the tire and also provides the tire identification number (TIN) for safety standard certification. The TIN can be used to identify the tire in case of a recall. Example 1 Tire size (example: P215/65R15 95H) 䊊 1. P: The “P” indicates the tire is designed for passenger vehicles (not all tires have this information). 2. Three-digit number (215): This number gives the width in millimeters of the tire from sidewall edge to sidewall edge. 3. Two-digit number (65): This number, known as the aspect ratio, gives the tire’s ratio of height to width. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 4. R: The “R” stands for radial. 5. Two-digit number (15): This number is the wheel or rim diameter in inches. 6. Two- or three-digit number (95): This number is the tire’s load index. It is a measurement of how much weight each tire can support. You may not find this information on all tires because it is not required by law. 7. H: Tire speed rating. You should not drive the vehicle faster than the tire speed rating. Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-35 3 Tire ply composition and material 䊊 The number of layers or plies of rubbercoated fabric in the tire. Tire manufacturers also must indicate the materials in the tire, which include steel, nylon, polyester, and others. 4 Maximum permissible inflation pres䊊 sure WDI0396 Example 2 TIN (Tire Identification Number) for a 䊊 new tire (example: DOT XX XX XXX XXXX) 1. DOT: Abbreviation for the “Department Of Transportation”. The symbol can be placed above, below or to the left or right of the Tire Identification Number. 2. Two-digit code: identification mark. Manufacturer’s 3. Two-digit code: Tire size. 8-36 Maintenance and do-it-yourself 4. Three-digit code: Tire type code (Optional). 5. Three-digit code: Date of Manufacture. 6. Four numbers represent the week and year the tire was built. For example, the numbers 3103 means the 31st week of 2003. If these numbers are missing, then look on the other sidewall of the tire. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : This number is the greatest amount of air pressure that should be put in the tire. Do not exceed the maximum permissible inflation pressure. 5 Maximum load rating 䊊 This number indicates the maximum load in kilograms and pounds that can be carried by the tire. When replacing the tires on the vehicle, always use a tire that has the same load rating as the factory installed tire. 6 Term of “tubeless” or “tube type” 䊊 Indicates whether the tire requires an inner tube (“tube type”) or not (“tubeless”). 7 The word “radial” 䊊 The word “radial” is shown if the tire has radial structure. 8 Manufacturer or brand name 䊊 Manufacturer or brand name is shown. Other Tire-related Terminology In addition to the many terms that are defined throughout this section, Intended Outboard Sidewall is (1) the sidewall that contains a whitewall, bears white lettering or bears manufacturer, brand, and/or model name molding that is higher or deeper than the same molding on the other sidewall of the tire, or (2) the outward facing sidewall of an asymmetrical tire that has a particular side that must always face outward when mounted on a vehicle. TYPES OF TIRES WARNING ● When changing or replacing tires, be sure all four tires are of the same type (i.e., Summer, All Season or Snow) and construction. A NISSAN dealer may be able to help you with information about tire type, size, speed rating and availability. ● Replacement tires may have a lower speed rating than the factory equipped tires, and may not match the potential maximum vehicle speed. Never exceed the maximum speed rating of the tire. ● For additional information regarding tires, refer to “Important Tire Safety Information” (US) or “Tire Safety Information” (Canada) in the Warranty Information Booklet. All season tires NISSAN specifies All Season tires on some models to provide good performance all year, including snowy and icy road conditions. All Season tires are identified by ALL SEASON and/or M&S on the tire sidewall. Snow tires have better snow traction than All Season tires and may be more appropriate in some areas. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Summer tires NISSAN specifies summer tires on some models to provide superior performance on dry roads. Summer tire performance is substantially reduced in snow and ice. Summer tires do not have the tire traction rating “M&S” on the tire sidewall. If you plan to operate your vehicle in snowy or icy conditions, NISSAN recommends the use of SNOW tires or ALL SEASON tires on all four wheels. Snow tires If snow tires are needed, it is necessary to select tires equivalent in size and load rating to the original equipment tires. If you do not, it can adversely affect the safety and handling of your vehicle. Generally, snow tires have lower speed ratings than factory equipped tires and may not match the potential maximum vehicle speed. Never exceed the maximum speed rating of the tire. If you install snow tires, they must be the same size, brand, construction and tread pattern on all four wheels. For additional traction on icy roads, studded tires may be used. However, some U.S. states and Canadian provinces prohibit their use. Check local, state and provincial laws before installing Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-37 studded tires. Skid and traction capabilities of studded snow tires on wet or dry surfaces may be poorer than that of non-studded snow tires. TIRE CHAINS CAUTION Tire chains/cables should not be installed on P225/45R17 size tires. Installation of the tire chains/cables on P225/45R17 size tires will cause damage to the vehicle. If you plan to use tire chains/cables, you should install P205/55R16 size tires on your vehicle. Use of tire chains may be prohibited according to location. Check the local laws before installing tire chains. When installing tire chains, make sure they are the proper size for the tires on your vehicle and are installed according to the chain manufacturer’s suggestions. Use only SAE class “S” chains. Class “S” chains are used on vehicles with restricted tire to vehicle clearance. Vehicles that can use Class “S” chains are designed to meet the minimum clearances between the tire and the closest vehicle suspension or body component required to accommodate the use of a winter traction device (tire chains or cables). The minimum clearances are determined using the factory equipped tires. Other types may damage your vehicle. Use chain tensioners when 8-38 Maintenance and do-it-yourself recommended by the tire chain manufacturer to ensure a tight fit. Loose end links of the tire chain must be secured or removed to prevent the possibility of whipping action damage to the fenders or underbody. If possible, avoid fully loading your vehicle when using tire chains. In addition, drive at a reduced speed. Otherwise, your vehicle may be damaged and/or vehicle handling and performance may be adversely affected. Tire chains must be installed only on the front wheels and not on the rear wheels. Never install tire chains on a TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire. Do not use tire chains on dry roads. Driving with chains in such conditions can cause damage to the various mechanisms of the vehicle due to some overstress. WDI0258 CHANGING WHEELS AND TIRES Tire rotation NISSAN recommends rotating the tires every 7,500 miles (12,000 km). See “Flat tire” in the “In case of emergency” section of this manual for tire replacing procedures. As soon as possible, tighten the wheel nuts to the specified torque with a torque wrench. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Wheel nut tightening torque: 83 ft-lb (113 N·m) ● The original tires have built-in tread wear indicators. When the wear indicators are visible, the tire(s) should be replaced. The wheel nuts must be kept tightened to specifications at all times. It is recommended that wheel nuts be tightened to specification at each tire rotation interval. ● Tires degrade with age and use. Have tires, including the spare, over 6 years old checked by a qualified technician because some tire damage may not be obvious. Replace the tires as necessary to prevent tire failure and possible personal injury. WARNING ● After rotating the tires, check and adjust the tire pressure. ● Retighten the wheel nuts when the vehicle has been driven for 600 miles (1,000 km) (also in cases of a flat tire, etc.). ● Do not include the spare tire in the tire rotation. ● For additional information regarding tires, refer to “Important Tire Safety Information” (US) or “Tire Safety Information” (Canada) in the Warranty Information Booklet. WDI0259 1. 2. Wear indicator Location mark Tire wear and damage WARNING ● Tires should be periodically inspected for wear, cracking, bulging or objects caught in the tread. If excessive wear, cracks, bulging or deep cuts are found, the tire(s) should be replaced. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ● Improper service of the spare tire may result in serious personal injury. If it is necessary to repair the spare tire, contact a NISSAN dealer. ● For additional information regarding tires, refer to “Important Tire Safety Information” (US) or “Tire Safety Information” (Canada) in the Warranty Information Booklet. Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-39 Replacing wheels and tires When replacing a tire, use the same size, tread design, speed rating and load carrying capacity as originally equipped. Recommended types and sizes are shown in “Wheels and tires” in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual. WARNING ● The use of tires other than those recommended or the mixed use of tires of different brands, construction (bias, bias-belted or radial), or tread patterns can adversely affect the ride, braking, handling, VDC system (if so equipped), ground clearance, body-to-tire clearance, tire chain clearance, speedometer calibration, headlight aim and bumper height. Some of these effects may lead to accidents and could result in serious personal injury. ● If your vehicle was originally equipped with 4 tires that were the same size and you are only replacing 2 of the 4 tires , install the new tires on the rear axle. Placing new tires on the front axle may cause loss of vehicle control in some driving conditions and cause an accident and personal injury. 8-40 Maintenance and do-it-yourself ● If the wheels are changed for any reason, always replace with wheels which have the same off-set dimension. Wheels of a different off-set could cause premature tire wear, degrade vehicle handling characteristics, affect the VDC system (if so equipped) and/or interference with the brake discs/drums. Such interference can lead to decreased braking efficiency and/or early brake pad/shoe wear. Refer to “Wheels and tires” in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual for wheel off-set dimensions. ● Do not install a damaged or deformed wheel or tire even if it has been repaired. Such wheels or tires could have structural damage and could fail without warning. ● The use of retread recommended. tires is not ● For additional information regarding tires, refer to “Important Tire Safety Information” (US) or “Tire Safety Information” (Canada) in the Warranty Information Booklet. Wheel balance ● When a spare tire is mounted or a wheel is replaced, the TPMS (if so equipped) will not function and the low tire pressure warning light will flash for approximately 1 minute. The light will remain on after 1 minute. Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon as possible for tire replacement and/or system resetting. Unbalanced wheels may affect vehicle handling and tire life. Even with regular use, wheels can get out of balance. Therefore, they should be balanced as required. ● Replacing tires with those not originally specified by NISSAN could affect the proper operation of the TPMS (if so equipped). ● For additional information regarding tires, refer to “Important Tire Safety Information” (US) or “Tire Safety Information” (Canada) in the Warranty Information Booklet. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Wheel balance service should be performed with the wheels off the vehicle. Spin balancing the wheels on the vehicle could lead to mechanical damage. Care of wheels ● Wash the wheels when washing the vehicle to maintain their appearance. ● Clean the inner side of the wheels when the wheel is changed or the underside of the vehicle is washed. ● Do not use abrasive cleaners when washing the wheels. ● Inspect wheel rims regularly for dents or corrosion. Such damage may cause loss of pressure or poor seal at the tire bead. ● NISSAN recommends waxing the road wheels to protect against road salt in areas where it is used during winter. Spare tire (TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire) Observe the following precautions if the TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire must be used. Otherwise, your vehicle could be damaged or involved in an accident: WARNING ● The spare tire should be used for emergency use only. It should be replaced with the standard tire at the first opportunity to avoid possible tire or differential damage. ● Drive carefully while the TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire is installed. Avoid sharp turns and abrupt braking while driving. ● Periodically check spare tire inflation pressure. Always keep the pressure of the TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire at 60 psi (420 kPa, 4.2 bar). ● Tire tread of the TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire will wear at a faster rate than the standard tire. Replace the spare tire as soon as the tread wear indicators appear. ● Do not use the spare tire on other vehicles. ● Do not use more than one spare tire at the same time. ● Do not tow a trailer when the TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire is installed. CAUTION ● With the TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire installed do not drive the vehicle at speeds faster than 50 MPH (80 km/h). ● Do not use tire chains on a TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire. Tire chains will not fit properly and may cause damage to the vehicle. ● When driving on roads covered with snow or ice, the TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire should be used on the rear wheels and the original tire used on the front wheels (drive wheels). Use tire chains only on the front (original) tires. ● Because the TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire is smaller than the original tire, ground clearance is reduced. To avoid damage to the vehicle, do not drive over obstacles. Also, do not drive the vehicle through an automatic car wash since it may get caught. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-41 MEMO 8-42 Maintenance and do-it-yourself I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 9 Technical and consumer information Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . 9-2 Fuel recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3 Engine oil and oil filter recommendations . . . . . . . . . . 9-5 Air conditioner system refrigerant and oil recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6 Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7 Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7 Wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8 Dimensions and weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8 When traveling or registering your vehicle in another country . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9 Vehicle identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9 Vehicle identification number (VIN) plate . . . . . . . . . . 9-9 Vehicle identification number (chassis number) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9 Engine serial number. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10 F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label . . . . . . . . . . 9-10 Emission control information label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11 Tire and loading information label. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11 Air conditioner specification label. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11 Installing front license plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12 Vehicle loading information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12 Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12 Vehicle load capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-13 Loading tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-15 Measurement of weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-15 Towing a trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-16 Maximum load limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-16 Towing load/specification. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-19 Towing safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-19 Flat towing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-23 Uniform tire quality grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24 Emission control system warranty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-25 Reporting safety defects (US only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-25 Readiness for inspection/maintenance (I/M) test . . . . . 9-25 Event Data Recorders (EDR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-26 Owner’s Manual/Service Manual order information . . . 9-27 In the event of a collision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-27 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : CAPACITIES AND RECOMMENDED FUEL/LUBRICANTS The following are approximate capacities. The actual refill capacities may be slightly different. When refilling, follow the procedure described in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section to determine the proper refill capacity. Fuel Engine oil *7 Drain and Refill With oil filter change Without oil filter change MR20DE QR25DE MR20DE QR25DE Cooling system With reservoir MR20DE CVT M/T Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) fluid Manual transmission gear oil MR20DE QR25DE QR25DE Brake and clutch fluid Multi-purpose grease Air conditioning system refrigerant Air conditioning system oil Windshield-washer fluid Capacity (Approximate) US measure Imp measure 14-1/2 gal 12-1/8 gal Liter 55.0 4-1/8 qt 4-1/2 qt 3-7/8 qt 4-1/4 qt 3-3/8 qt 3-3/4 qt 3-1/8 qt 3-1/2 qt 3.9 4.3 3.6 4.0 1-7/8 gal 1-7/8 gal 1-7/8 gal — 1-1/2 gal 1-5/8 gal 1-1/2 gal — 7.0 7.1 6.9 — — — — — — — Recommended Fluids and Lubricants Refill to the proper level according to the instructions in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section *8 — — — — — — — — — — — — See “Fuel recommendation” later in this section. • Engine oil with API Certification Mark *1 • Viscosity SAE 5W-30 *1 50% Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant or equivalent 50% Demineralized or distilled water Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-2 *2 Genuine NISSAN gear oil (ETL8997B) 75W-80 or equivalent *3 Genuine NISSAN Manual Transmission Fluid (MTF) HQ Multi 75W-85 or equivalent *4 Genuine NISSAN Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid or equivalent DOT 3 *5 NLGI No. 2 (Lithium Soap base) HFC-134a (R-134a) *6 NISSAN A/C System Oil Type S or equivalent *6 Genuine NISSAN Windshield Washer Concentrate Cleaner & Antifreeze or equivalent *1: For further details, see “Engine oil and oil filter recommendations.” *2: Use only Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-2 Using transmission fluid other than Genuine NISSAN CVT Fluid NS-2 will damage the CVT, which is not covered by the NISSAN new vehicle limited warranty. *3: If Genuine NISSAN gear oil is not available, API GL-4, Viscosity SAE 75W-80 may be used as a temporary replacement. However, use Genuine NISSAN gear oil as soon as it is available. *4: If Genuine NISSAN Manual Transmission Fluid (MTF) Muti 75W85 is not available, API GL-4, Viscosity SAE 75W-85 may be used as a temporary replacement. However, use Genuine NISSAN gear oil as soon as it is available. *5: Available in mainland USA through your NISSAN dealer. *6: For further details, see “Air conditioner system refrigerant and oil recommendations.” *7: For further details, see “Engine Oil” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual. *8: See your NISSAN dealer for service. 9-2 Technical and consumer information I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : FUEL RECOMMENDATION MR20DE and QR25DE engine except Spec-V Use unleaded regular gasoline with an octane rating of at least 87 AKI (Anti-Knock Index) number (Research octane number 91). QR25DE engine Spec-V only Use unleaded premium gasoline with an octane rating of at least 91 AKI (Anti-Knock Index) number (Research octane number 96). If unleaded premium gasoline is not available, unleaded regular gasoline with an octane rating of at lease 87 AKI (Research octane number 91) can be used, but only under the following precautions: ● have the fuel tank filled only partially with unleaded regular gasoline, and fill up with unleaded premium as soon as possible. ● avoid full throttle driving and abrupt acceleration. However, for maximum vehicle performance, the use of unleaded premium gasoline is recommended. CAUTION ● Using a fuel other than that specified could adversely affect the emission control system, and may also affect the warranty coverage. ● Under no circumstances should a leaded gasoline be used, because this will damage the three-way catalyst. ● Do not use E-85 fuel in your vehicle. Your vehicle is not designed to run on E-85 fuel. Using E-85 fuel can damage the fuel system components and is not covered by the NISSAN new vehicle limited warranty. Gasoline specifications NISSAN recommends using gasoline that meets the World-Wide Fuel Charter (WWFC) specifications where it is available. Many of the automobile manufacturers developed this specification to improve emission control system and vehicle performance. Ask your service station manager if the gasoline meets the WWFC specifications. Reformulated gasoline supports efforts towards cleaner air and suggests that you use reformulated gasoline when available. Gasoline containing oxygenates Some fuel suppliers sell gasoline containing oxygenates such as ethanol, MTBE and methanol with or without advertising their presence. NISSAN does not recommend the use of fuels of which the oxygenate content and the fuel compatibility for your NISSAN cannot be readily determined. If in doubt, ask your service station manager. If you use oxygenate-blend gasoline, please take the following precautions as the usage of such fuels may cause vehicle performance problems and/or fuel system damage. ● The fuel should be unleaded and have an octane rating no lower than that recommended for unleaded gasoline. ● If an oxygenate-blend other than methanol blend is used, it should contain no more than 10% oxygenate. (MTBE may, however, be added up to 15%.) Some fuel suppliers are now producing reformulated gasolines. These gasolines are specially designed to reduce vehicle emissions. NISSAN I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Technical and consumer information 9-3 ● If a methanol blend is used, it should contain no more than 5% methanol (methyl alcohol, wood alcohol). It should also contain a suitable amount of appropriate cosolvents and corrosion inhibitors. If not properly formulated with appropriate cosolvents and corrosion inhibitors, such methanol blends may cause fuel system damage and/or vehicle performance problems. At this time, sufficient data is not available to ensure that all methanol blends are suitable for use in NISSAN vehicles. If any driveability problems such as engine stalling and difficult hot-starting are experienced after using oxygenate-blend fuels, immediately change to a non-oxygenate fuel or a fuel with a low blend of MTBE. Take care not to spill gasoline during refueling. Gasoline containing oxygenates can cause paint damage. E–85 fuel E-85 fuel is a mixture of approximately 85% fuel ethanol and 15% unleaded gasoline. E-85 can only be used in a Flexible Fuel Vehicle (FFV). Do not use E-85 in your vehicle. U.S. government regulations require fuel ethanol dispensing pumps to be identified by a small, square, orange 9-4 Technical and consumer information and black label with the common abbreviation or the appropriate percentage for that region. Aftermarket fuel additives NISSAN does not recommend the use of any aftermarket fuel additives (for example, fuel injector cleaner, octane booster, intake valve deposit removers, etc.) which are sold commercially. Many of these additives intended for gum, varnish or deposit removal may contain active solvents or similar ingredients that can be harmful to the fuel system and engine. Octane rating tips Using unleaded gasoline with an octane rating lower than recommended can cause persistent, heavy “spark knock.” (“Spark knock” is a metallic rapping noise.) If severe, this can lead to engine damage. If you detect a persistent heavy spark knock even when using gasoline of the stated octane rating, or if you hear steady spark knock while holding a steady speed on level roads, have a NISSAN dealer correct the condition. Failure to correct the condition is misuse of the vehicle, for which NISSAN is not responsible. Incorrect ignition timing may result in spark knock, after-run and/or overheating, which may cause excessive fuel consumption or engine I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : damage. If any of the above symptoms are encountered, have your vehicle checked at a NISSAN dealer. However, now and then you may notice light spark knock for a short time while accelerating or driving up hills. This is not a cause for concern, because you get the greatest fuel benefit when there is light spark knock for a short time under heavy engine load. CAUTION ● Your vehicle is not designed to run on E-85 fuel. Using E-85 fuel in a vehicle not specifically designed for E-85 fuel can damage fuel system components and is not covered by the NISSAN new vehicle limited warranty. ● E-85 is a mixture of approximately 85% fuel ethanol and 15% unleaded gasoline. ● U.S. government regulations require ethanol dispensing pumps to be identified by a small, square, orange and black label with the common abbreviation or the appropriate percentage for that region. Oil viscosity The engine oil viscosity or thickness changes with temperature. Because of this, it is important to select the engine oil viscosity based on the temperatures at which the vehicle will be operated before the next oil change. Choosing an oil viscosity other than that recommended could cause serious engine damage. Selecting the correct oil filter WTI0183 ENGINE OIL AND OIL FILTER RECOMMENDATIONS Selecting the correct oil It is essential to choose the correct grade, quality and viscosity engine oil to ensure satisfactory engine life and performance. See “Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants” earlier in this section. NISSAN recommends the use of an energy conserving oil in order to improve fuel economy. Select only engine oils that meet the American Petroleum Institute (API) certification or International Lubricant Standardization and Approval Committee (ILSAC) certification and SAE viscosity standard. These oils have the API certification mark on the front of the container. Oils which do not have the specified quality label should not be used as they could cause engine damage. Oil additives NISSAN does not recommend the use of oil additives. The use of an oil additive is not necessary when the proper oil type is used and maintenance intervals are followed. Oil which may contain foreign matter or has been previously used should not be used. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Your new NISSAN vehicle is equipped with a high-quality genuine NISSAN oil filter. When replacing, use a genuine NISSAN oil filter or its equivalent for the reason described in “Change intervals.” Change intervals The oil and oil filter change intervals for your engine are based on the use of the specified quality oils and filters. Using engine oil and filters that are not of the specified quality, or exceeding recommended oil and filter change intervals could reduce engine life. Damage to the engine caused by improper maintenance or use of incorrect oil and filter quality and/or viscosity is not covered by the NISSAN new vehicle limited warranty. Technical and consumer information 9-5 Your engine was filled with a high-quality engine oil when it was built. You do not have to change the oil before the first recommended change interval. Oil and filter change intervals depend upon how you use your vehicle. Operation under the following conditions may require more frequent oil and filter changes: ● repeated short distance driving at cold outside temperatures ● driving in dusty conditions ● extensive idling ● towing a trailer ● stop and go commuting Refer to the “NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide” for the maintenance schedule. CAUTION The use of any other refrigerant or oil will cause severe damage to the air conditioning system and will require the replacement of all air conditioner system components. The refrigerant HFC-134a (R-134a) in your NISSAN vehicle does not harm the earth’s ozone layer. Although this refrigerant does not affect the earth’s atmosphere, certain government regulations require the recovery and recycling of any refrigerant during automotive air conditioner system service. A NISSAN dealer has the trained technicians and equipment needed to recover and recycle your air conditioner system refrigerant. Contact a NISSAN dealer when servicing your air conditioner system. AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM REFRIGERANT AND OIL RECOMMENDATIONS The air conditioner system in your NISSAN vehicle must be charged with the refrigerant HFC-134a (R-134a) and the oil, NISSAN A/C system oil Type S or the exact equivalents. 9-6 Technical and consumer information I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : SPECIFICATIONS ENGINE Model Type Cylinder arrangement Bore x Stroke Displacement Firing order in (mm) cu in (cm3) MR20DE QR25DE Gasoline, 4-cycle, DOHC 4-cylinder, inline 3.307 x 3.547 (84.0 x 90.1) 121.86 (1,997) 1–3–4–2 Gasoline, 4-cycle, DOHC 4-cylinder, inline 3.5 x 3.9 (89.0 x 100.0) 151.82 (2,488) 1–3–4–2 Idle speed M/T CVT (in “N” position) Ignition timing (degree B.T.D.C. at idle speed) CO % at idle No adjustment is necessary. Spark plug Spark plug gap (Nominal) PLZKAR6A-11 (all except California models) FXE20HR-11 (California models) DILKAR6A-11 0.043 (1.1) 0.043 (1.1) in (mm) Camshaft operation This spark ignition system complies with the Canadian standard ICES-002. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Timing chain Technical and consumer information 9-7 WHEELS AND TIRES Wheel type DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS Size Offset in (mm) Steel 15 x 6.5JJ 1.77 (45) Aluminum and steel 16 x 6.5JJ 1.77 (45) Aluminum 17 x 7.0JJ 1.97 (50) Tire size Spare tire P205/60R15 P205/55R16 P225/45VR17 P225/45WR17 Unit: in (mm) MR20DE Model Overall length Overall width Overall height QR25DE 179.8 (4,567) 180.1 (4,575) 70.5 (1,790) 70.5 (1,790) 59.5 (1,511) 59.1 (1,501) (MT), 59.5 (1, 511) (CVT) Front Track 15 X 6.5 and 16 X 6.5 inch wheel 17 X 7.0 inch wheel T125/70D16 59.8 (1,520) N/A N/A 59.5 (1,510) Rear Track 15 X 6.5 and 16 X 6.5 inch wheel 17 X 7.0 inch wheel Wheelbase Gross vehicle weight rating Gross axle weight rating Front Rear 9-8 Technical and consumer information I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 60.8 (1,544) N/A N/A 105.7 (2,685) 60.4 (1,534) 105.7 (2,685) lb (kg) See the “F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label” on the center pillar between the driver’s side front and rear doors. lb (kg) lb (kg) WHEN TRAVELING OR REGISTERING YOUR VEHICLE IN ANOTHER COUNTRY VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION When planning to drive your NISSAN vehicle in another country, you should first find out if the fuel available is suitable for your vehicle’s engine. Using fuel with an octane rating that is too low may cause engine damage. All gasoline vehicles must be operated with unleaded gasoline. Therefore, avoid taking your vehicle to areas where appropriate fuel is not available. When transferring the registration of your vehicle to another country, state, province or district, it may be necessary to modify the vehicle to meet local laws and regulations. The laws and regulations for motor vehicle emission control and safety standards vary according to the country, state, province or district; therefore, vehicle specifications may differ. When any vehicle is to be taken into another country, state, province or district and registered, its modifications, transportation, and registration are the responsibility of the user. NISSAN is not responsible for any inconvenience that may result. STI0457 STI0465 VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (VIN) PLATE VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (chassis number) The vehicle identification number (VIN) plate is attached as shown. This number is the identification for your vehicle and is used in the vehicle registration. The vehicle identification number is located as shown. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Technical and consumer information 9-9 STI0466 MR20DE WTI0096 QR25DE ENGINE SERIAL NUMBER The number is stamped on the engine as shown. 9-10 Technical and consumer information STI0349 F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. CERTIFICATION LABEL The Federal/Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard (F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S.) certification label is affixed as shown. This label contains valuable vehicle information, such as: Gross Vehicle Weight Ratings (GVWR), Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR), month and year of manufacture, Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), etc. Review it carefully. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : WTI0188 WTI0174 WTI0198 EMISSION CONTROL INFORMATION LABEL TIRE AND LOADING INFORMATION LABEL AIR CONDITIONER SPECIFICATION LABEL The emission control information label is attached to the underside of the hood as shown. The cold tire pressure is shown on the Tire and Loading Information label. The label is located as shown. The air conditioner specification label is affixed to the underside of the hood as shown. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Technical and consumer information 9-11 INSTALLING FRONT LICENSE PLATE VEHICLE LOADING INFORMATION Use the following steps to mount the front license plate: 1 䊊 2 䊊 3 䊊 Slide the metal mounting clips onto the license plate holder as indicated. Make holes on the plastic finisher at the location mark (small dimple) using a 0.31 in (8 mm) drill. Apply light pressure to the drill. Install the license plate holder using the two screws provided with the holder. Mount the license plate using two M614mm bolts. License plate bolt tightening torque: 3.8 - 4.7 ft-lb (5.10 - 6.37 N·m) WARNING ● It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area inside a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in these areas are more likely to be seriously injured or killed. ● Do not allow people to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat belts. ● Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and using a seat belt properly. TERMS It is important to familiarize yourself with the following terms before loading your vehicle: ● Curb Weight (actual weight of your vehicle) - vehicle weight including: standard and optional equipment, fluids, emergency tools, and spare tire assembly. This weight does not include passengers and cargo. WTI0187 9-12 Technical and consumer information I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ● GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) - curb weight plus the combined weight of passengers and cargo. ● GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) - maximum total combined weight of the unloaded vehicle, passengers, luggage, hitch, trailer tongue load and any other optional equipment. This information is located on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label. ● GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) maximum weight (load) limit specified for the front or rear axle. This information is located on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label. ● Vehicle Capacity Weight, Load limit, Total load capacity - maximum total weight limit specified of the load (passengers and cargo) for the vehicle. This is the maximum combined weight of occupants and cargo that can be loaded into the vehicle. If the vehicle is used to tow a trailer, the trailer tongue weight must be included as part of the cargo load. This information is located on the Tire and Loading Information label (if so equipped). ● Cargo capacity - permissible weight of cargo, the subtracted weight of occupants from the load limit. VEHICLE LOAD CAPACITY Do not exceed the load limit of your vehicle shown as “The combined weight of occupants and cargo” on the Tire and Loading Information label. Do not exceed the number of occupants shown as “Seating Capacity” on the Tire and Loading Information label. To get “the combined weight of occupants and cargo”, add the weight of all occupants, then add the total luggage weight. Examples are shown in the following illustration. ● GCWR (Gross Combined Weight rating) - The maximum total weight rating of the vehicle, passengers, cargo, and trailer. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Technical and consumer information 9-13 Steps for determining correct load limit 1. Locate the statement “The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs” on your vehicle’s placard. 2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be riding in your vehicle. 3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kg or XXX lbs. 4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if the XXX amount equals 1400 lbs. and there will be five 150 lb. passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs. (1400-750 (5 X 150) = 650 lbs) or (640-340 (5 X 70) = 300 kg.) LTI0152 Example 9-14 Technical and consumer information I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4. 6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle. Before driving a loaded vehicle, confirm that you do not exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) or the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) for your vehicle. See “Measurement of Weights” later in this section. Also check tires for proper inflation pressures. See the Tire and Loading Information label. LOADING TIPS ● The GVW must not exceed GVWR or GAWR as specified on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label. ● Do not load the front and rear axle to the GAWR. Doing so will exceed the GVWR. WARNING ● Properly secure all cargo with ropes or straps to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. Do not place cargo higher than the seatbacks. In a sudden stop or collision, unsecured cargo could cause personal injury. ● Do not load your vehicle any heavier than the GVWR or the maximum front and rear GAWRs. If you do, parts of your vehicle can break, tire damage could occur, or it can change the way your vehicle handles. This could result in loss of control and cause personal injury. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ● Overloading not only can shorten the life of your vehicle and the tire, but can also cause unsafe vehicle handling and longer braking distances. This may cause a premature tire failure which could result in a serious accident and personal injury. Failures caused by overloading are not covered by the vehicle’s warranty. MEASUREMENT OF WEIGHTS Secure loose items to prevent weight shifts that could affect the balance of your vehicle. When the vehicle is loaded, drive to a scale and weigh the front and the rear wheels separately to determine axle loads. Individual axle loads should not exceed either of the gross axle weight ratings (GAWR). The total of the axle loads should not exceed the gross vehicle weight rating (GVWR). These ratings are given on the vehicle certification label. If weight ratings are exceeded, move or remove items to bring all weights below the ratings. Technical and consumer information 9-15 TOWING A TRAILER WARNING Overloading or improper loading of a trailer and its cargo can adversely affect vehicle handling, braking and performance and may lead to accidents. CAUTION ● Do not tow a trailer or haul a heavy load for the first 500 miles (800 km). Your engine, axle or other parts could be damaged. MAXIMUM LOAD LIMITS Maximum trailer loads Never allow the total trailer load to exceed the value specified in the “Towing Load/Specification” chart found later in this section. The total trailer load equals trailer weight plus its cargo weight. ● When towing a trailer load of 1,000 lbs. (454 kg) or more, trailers with a brake system must be used. ● For the first 500 miles (800 km) that you tow a trailer, do not drive over 50 mph (80 km/h) and do not make starts at full throttle. This helps the engine and other parts of your vehicle wear in at the heavier loads. LTI0164 The Gross Combined Weight Rating (GCWR) equals the combined weight of the towing vehicle (including passengers and cargo) plus the total trailer load. Towing loads greater than these or using improper towing equipment could adversely affect vehicle handling, braking and performance. Your new vehicle was designed to be used primarily to carry passengers and cargo. Remember that towing a trailer places additional loads on your vehicle’s engine, drive train, steering, braking and other systems. The ability of your vehicle to tow a trailer is not only related to the maximum trailer loads, but also the places you plan to tow. Tow weights appropriate for level highway driving may have to be reduced for low traction situations (for example, on slippery boat ramps). A NISSAN Towing Guide (U.S. only) is available on the website at www.nissanusa.com. This guide includes information on trailer towing capability and the special equipment required for proper towing. 9-16 Technical and consumer information I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Temperature conditions can also affect towing. For example, towing a heavy trailer in high outside temperatures on graded roads can affect engine performance and cause overheating. The engine protection mode, which helps reduce the chance of engine damage, could activate and automatically decrease engine power. Vehicle speed may decrease under high load. Plan your trip carefully to account for trailer and vehicle load, weather and road conditions. WARNING Overheating can result in reduced engine power and vehicle speed. The reduced speed may be lower than other traffic, which could increase the chance of a collision. Be especially careful when driving. If the vehicle cannot maintain a safe driving speed, pull to the side of the road in a safe area. Allow the engine to cool and return to normal operation. See “If your vehicle overheats” in the “In case of emergency” section of this manual. CAUTION WTI0160 TI1012M Tongue load Keep the tongue load between 10 - 15 percent of the total trailer load or use the trailer tongue load specified by the trailer manufacturer. The tongue load must be within the maximum tongue load limits shown in the following “Towing Load/Specification” chart. If the tongue load becomes excessive, rearrange cargo to allow for proper tongue load. Vehicle damage resulting from improper towing procedures is not covered by NISSAN warranties. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Maximum Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW)/Maximum Gross Axle Weight (GAW) The GVW of the towing vehicle must not exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) shown on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label. The GVW equals the combined weight of the unloaded vehicle, passengers, luggage, hitch, trailer tongue load and any other optional equipment. In addition, front or rear GAW must not exceed the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) shown on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label. Technical and consumer information 9-17 Towing capacities are calculated assuming a base vehicle with driver and any options required to achieve the rating. Additional passengers, cargo and/or optional equipment, such as the trailer hitch, will add weight to the vehicle and reduce your vehicle’s maximum towing capacity and trailer tongue load. To determine the Gross Trailer Weight, weigh your trailer on a scale with all equipment and cargo, that are normally in the trailer when it is towed. Make sure the Gross Trailer Weight is not more than the Gross Trailer Weight Rating shown on the trailer and is not more than the calculated available maximum towing capacity. The vehicle and trailer need to be weighed to confirm the vehicle is within the GVWR, Front GAWR, Rear GAWR, Gross Combined Weight Rating (GCWR) and Towing capacity. Also weigh the front and rear axles on the scale to make sure the Front Gross Axle Weight and Rear Gross Axle Weight are not more than Front Gross Axle Weight and Rear Gross Axle Weight on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label. The cargo in the trailer and vehicle may need to be moved or removed to meet the specified ratings. All vehicle and trailer weights can be measured using platform type scales commonly found at truck stops, highway weigh stations, building supply centers or salvage yards. To determine the available payload capacity for tongue load, use the following procedure. Example: 1. Locate the GVWR on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label. ● Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW) as weighed on a scale - including passengers, cargo and hitch - 3,820 lb. (1732 kg). 2. Weigh your vehicle on the scale with all of the passengers and cargo that are normally in the vehicle when towing a trailer. ● Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) from F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label 3,920 lb. (1778 kg). 3. Subtract the actual vehicle weight from the GVWR. The remaining amount is the available maximum tongue load. ● Maximum Towing Load from “Towing Load/Specification⬙ chart - 1,000 lb. (454 kg). 3,920 lb. (1778 kg) – 3,820 lb. (1732 kg) GVWR GVW = 100 lb. (45 kg) Available for tongue weight 1,000 lb. (454 kg) Capacity available for towing 100 lb. (45 kg) Available tongue weight / 1,000 lb. (454 kg) Available capacity = 10 % tongue weight The available towing capacity may be less than the maximum towing capacity due to the passenger and cargo load in the vehicle. Remember to keep trailer tongue weight between 10 - 15% of the trailer weight or within the trailer tongue load specification recommended by the trailer manufacturer. If the tongue load becomes excessive, rearrange the cargo to obtain the proper tongue load. Do not exceed the maximum tongue weight specification shown in the “Towing load/specification” chart even if the calculated available tongue weight is greater than 15%. If the calculated tongue weight is less than 10% , reduce the total trailer weight to match the available tongue weight. Always verify that available capacities are within the required ratings. 9-18 Technical and consumer information I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : TOWING LOAD/SPECIFICATION TOWING LOAD / SPECIFICATION UNIT: lb (kg) MAXIMUM TOWING LOAD *1 1,000 (454) MAXIMUM TONGUE LOAD 100 (45) *1: The towing capacity values are calculated assuming a base vehicle with driver and any options required to achieve the rating. Additional passengers, cargo and/or optional equipment will add weight to the vehicle and reduce your vehicle’s maximum towing capacity. TOWING SAFETY Trailer hitch Choose a proper hitch for your vehicle and trailer. Make sure the trailer hitch is securely attached to the vehicle, to help avoid personal injury or property damage due to sway caused by crosswinds, rough road surfaces or passing trucks. Ball mount WARNING Trailer hitch components have specific weight ratings. Your vehicle may be capable of towing a trailer heavier than the weight rating of the hitch components. Never exceed the weight rating of the hitch components. Doing so can cause serious personal injury or property damage. The hitch ball is attached to the ball mount and the ball mount is inserted into the hitch receiver. Choose a proper class ball mount based on the trailer weight. Additionally, the ball mount should be chosen to keep the trailer tongue level with the ground. Hitch ball Sudden maneuvers, wind gusts, and buffeting caused by other vehicles can affect trailer handling. Sway control devices may be used to help control these affects. If you choose to use one, contact a reputable trailer hitch supplier to make sure the sway control device will work with the vehicle, hitch, trailer and the trailer’s brake system. Follow the instructions provided by the manufacturer for installing and using the sway control device. Sway control device Choose a hitch ball of the proper size and weight rating for your trailer: ● The required hitch ball size is stamped on most trailer couplers. Most hitch balls also have the size printed on the top of the ball. ● Choose the proper class hitch ball based on the trailer weight. ● The diameter of the threaded shank of the hitch ball must be matched to the ball mount hole diameter. The hitch ball shank should be no more than 1/16” smaller than the hole in the ball mount. ● The threaded shank of the hitch ball must be long enough to be properly secured to the ball mount. There should be at least 2 threads showing beyond the lock washer and nut. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Class I hitch Class I trailer hitch equipment (receiver, ball mount and hitch ball) can be used to tow trailers of a maximum weight of 2,000 lb (909 kg). You may add Class I trailer hitch equipment that has a 2,000 lb (909 kg) maximum weight rating to the vehicle, but your vehicle is only capable of towing the maximum trailer weights shown in the Towing Load/Specification chart earlier in this section. Technical and consumer information 9-19 CAUTION ● Do not use axle-mounted hitches. ● The hitch should not be attached to or affect the operation of the impactabsorbing bumper. ● Do not modify the vehicle exhaust system, brake system, etc. to install a trailer hitch. ● To reduce the possibility of additional damage if your vehicle is struck from the rear, where practical, remove the receiver when not in use. ● After the hitch is removed, seal the bolt holes to prevent exhaust fumes, water or dust from entering the passenger compartment. ● Regularly check that all trailer hitch mounting bolts are securely mounted. Tire pressures ● When towing a trailer, inflate the vehicle tires to the recommended cold tire pressure indicated on the Tire and Loading Information label. ● Trailer tire condition, size, load rating and proper inflation pressure should be in accordance with the trailer and tire manufacturer’s specifications. Safety chains Always use suitable safety chains between your vehicle and the trailer. The safety chains should be crossed and should be attached to the hitch, not to the vehicle bumper or axle. Be sure to leave enough slack in the chains to permit turning corners. Trailer lights CAUTION When splicing into the vehicle electrical system, a commercially available powertype module/converter must be used to provide power for all trailer lighting. This unit uses the vehicle battery as a direct power source for all trailer lights while using the vehicle tail light, stoplight and turn signal circuits as a signal source. The module/converter must draw no more that 15 milliamps from the stop and tail lamp circuits. Using a module/converter that exceeds these power requirements may damage the vehicle’s electrical system. See a reputable trailer dealer to obtain the proper equipment and to have it installed. Trailer lights should comply with federal and/or local regulations. For assistance in hooking up trailer lights, contact a NISSAN dealer or reputable trailer dealer. Trailer brakes If your trailer is equipped with a braking system, make sure it conforms to federal and/or local regulations and that it is properly installed. 9-20 Technical and consumer information I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : WARNING Never connect a trailer brake system directly to the vehicle brake system. Pre-towing tips ● Be certain your vehicle maintains a level position when a loaded and/or unloaded trailer is hitched. Do not drive the vehicle if it has an abnormal nose-up or nose-down condition; check for improper tongue load, overload, worn suspension or other possible causes of either condition. ● Always secure items in the trailer to prevent load shift while driving. ● Keep the cargo load as low as possible in the trailer to keep the trailer center of gravity low. ● Load the trailer so approximately 60% of the trailer load is in the front half and 40% is in the back half. Also make sure the load is balanced side to side. ● Check your hitch, trailer tire pressure, vehicle tire pressure, trailer light operation, and trailer wheel lug nuts every time you attach a trailer to the vehicle. ● Be certain your rearview mirrors conform to all federal, state or local regulations. If not, install any mirrors required for towing before driving the vehicle. ● Determine the overall height of the vehicle and trailer so the required clearance is known. Trailer towing tips In order to gain skill and an understanding of the vehicle’s behavior, you should practice turning, stopping and backing up in an area which is free from traffic. Steering stability and braking performance will be somewhat different than under normal driving conditions. ● Always secure items in the trailer to prevent load shift while driving. ● Lock the trailer hitch coupler with a pin or lock to prevent the coupler from inadvertently becoming unlatched. ● Avoid abrupt starts, acceleration or stops. ● Avoid sharp turns or lane changes. ● Always drive your vehicle at a moderate speed. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : ● When backing up, hold the bottom of the steering wheel with one hand. Move your hand in the direction in which you want the trailer to go. Make small corrections and back up slowly. If possible, have someone guide you when you are backing up. Always block the wheels on both vehicle and trailer when parking. Parking on a slope is not recommended; however, if you must do so: CAUTION If you move the shift selector to the P (Park) position before blocking the wheels and applying the parking brake, transmission damage could occur. 1. Apply and hold the brake pedal. 2. Have someone place blocks on the downhill side of the vehicle and trailer wheels. 3. After the wheel blocks are in place, slowly release the brake pedal until the blocks absorb the vehicle load. 4. Apply the parking brake. 5. Shift the transmission into P (Park). 6. Turn off the engine. Technical and consumer information 9-21 To drive away: 1. Start the vehicle. 2. Apply and hold the brake pedal. 3. Shift the transmission into gear. 4. Release the parking brake. 5. Drive slowly until the vehicle and trailer are clear from the blocks. 6. Apply and hold the brake pedal. 7. Have someone retrieve and store the blocks. ● While going downhill, the weight of the trailer pushing on the tow vehicle may decrease overall stability. Therefore, to maintain adequate control, reduce your speed and shift to a lower gear. Avoid long or repeated use of the brakes when descending a hill, as this reduces their effectiveness and could cause overheating. Shifting to a lower gear instead provides “engine braking” and reduces the need to brake as frequently. ● Avoid towing a trailer for your vehicle’s first 500 miles (805 km). ● For the first 500 miles (805 km) that you do tow, do not drive over 50 MPH (80 km/h). ● Have your vehicle serviced more often than at intervals specified in the recommended Maintenance Schedule in the “NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide”. ● When making a turn, your trailer wheels will be closer to the inside of the turn than your vehicle wheels. To compensate for this, make a larger than normal turning radius during the turn. ● Crosswinds and rough roads will adversely affect vehicle/trailer handling, possibly causing vehicle sway. When being passed by larger vehicles, be prepared for possible changes in crosswinds that could affect vehicle handling. Do the following if the trailer begins to sway: ● If the engine coolant temperature rises to a high temperature, refer to “If your vehicle overheats” in the “In case of emergency” section of this owner’s manual. 1. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal to allow the vehicle to coast and steer as straight ahead as the road conditions allow. This combination will help stabilize the vehicle. ● Trailer towing requires more fuel than normal circumstances. – Do not correct trailer sway by steering or applying the brakes. 9-22 Technical and consumer information I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 2. When the trailer sway stops, gently apply the brakes and pull to the side of the road in a safe area. 3. Try to rearrange the trailer load so it is balanced as described earlier in this section. ● Be careful when passing other vehicles. Passing while towing a trailer requires considerably more distance than normal passing. Remember, the length of the trailer must also pass the other vehicle before you can safely change lanes. ● Use the Tow Mode or downshift the transmission to a lower gear for engine braking when driving down steep or long hills. This will help slow the vehicle without applying the brakes. ● Avoid holding the brake pedal down too long or too frequently. This could cause the brakes to overheat, resulting in reduced braking efficiency. ● Increase your following distance to allow for greater stopping distances while towing a trailer. Anticipate stops and brake gradually. ● NISSAN recommends that the cruise control (if so equipped) not be used while towing a trailer. ● Some states or provinces have specific regulations and speed limits for vehicles that are towing trailers. Obey the local speed limits. ● Check your hitch, trailer wiring harness connections, and trailer wheel lug nuts after 50 miles (80 km) of travel and at every break. ● When launching a boat, don’t allow the water level to go over the exhaust tail pipe or rear bumper. ● Make sure you disconnect the trailer lights before backing the trailer into the water or the trailer lights may burn out. When towing a trailer, transmission fluid should be changed more frequently. For additional information, see the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section earlier in this manual. FLAT TOWING Towing your vehicle with all four wheels on the ground is sometimes called flat towing. This method is sometimes used when towing a vehicle behind a recreational vehicle, such as a motor home. Manual Transmission CAUTION ● Failure to follow these guidelines can result in severe transmission damage. ● Always tow with the manual transmission in Neutral. ● Whenever flat towing your vehicle, always tow forward, never backward. ● After towing 500 miles (805 km), start and idle the engine with the transmission in Neutral for two minutes. Failure to idle the engine after every 500 miles (805 km) of towing may cause damage to internal transmission parts. ● DO NOT tow any continuously variable transmission vehicle with all four wheels on the ground (flat towing). Doing so WILL DAMAGE internal transmission parts due to lack of transmission lubrication. ● For emergency towing procedures refer to “Towing recommended by NISSAN” in the “In case of emergency” section of this manual. Continuously Variable Transmission To tow a vehicle equipped with a continuously variable transmission, an appropriate vehicle dolly MUST be placed under the towed vehicle’s drive wheels. Always follow the dolly manufacturer’s recommendations when using their product. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Technical and consumer information 9-23 UNIFORM TIRE QUALITY GRADING DOT (Department of Transportation) Quality Grades: All passenger car tires must conform to federal safety requirements in addition to these grades. Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and maximum section width. For example: Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A Treadwear The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on the government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices and differences in road characteristics and climate. Traction AA, A, B and C The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C. Those grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction performance. 9-24 Technical and consumer information WARNING The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or peak traction characteristics. Temperature A, B and C The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C, representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat, and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : WARNING The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive speed, under-inflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause heat build-up and possible tire failure. EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM WARRANTY REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS (US only) READINESS FOR INSPECTION/ MAINTENANCE (I/M) TEST Your NISSAN vehicle is covered by the following emission warranties: If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying NISSAN. Due to legal requirements in some states and Canadian Provinces, your vehicle may be required to be in what is called the “ready condition” for an Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) test of the emission control system. For USA 1. Emission Defects Warranty 2. Emissions Performance Warranty Details of this warranty may be found with other vehicle warranties in your Warranty Information Booklet which comes with your NISSAN vehicle. If you did not receive a Warranty Information Booklet, or it is lost, you may obtain a replacement by writing to: ● Nissan North America, Inc. Consumer Affairs Department P.O. Box 685003 Franklin, TN 37068-5003 For Canada Emission Control System Warranty Details of this warranty may be found with other vehicle warranties in your Warranty Information Booklet which comes with your NISSAN vehicle. If you did not receive a Warranty Information Booklet, or it is lost, you may obtain a replacement by writing to: ● Nissan Canada Inc. 5290 Orbitor Drive Mississauga, Ontario, L4W 4Z5 If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or NISSAN. To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 400 Seventh Street, SW., Washington, D.C. 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov. You may notify NISSAN by contacting our Consumer Affairs Department, toll-free, at 1-800-NISSAN-1. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : The vehicle is set to the “ready condition” when it is driven through certain driving patterns. Usually, the ready condition can be obtained by ordinary usage of the vehicle. If a powertrain system component is repaired or the battery is disconnected, the vehicle may be reset to a “not ready” condition. Before taking the I/M test, check the vehicle’s inspection/maintenance test readiness condition. Turn the ignition switch ON without starting the engine. If the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) comes on steady for 20 seconds and then blinks for 10 seconds , the I/M test condition is “not ready”. If the MIL does not blink after 20 seconds, the I/M test condition is “ready”. If the MIL indicates the vehicle is in a “not ready” condition, drive the vehicle through the following pattern to set the vehicle to the ready condition. If you cannot or do not want to perform the driving pattern, a NISSAN dealer can conduct it for you. Technical and consumer information 9-25 EVENT DATA RECORDERS (EDR) WARNING Always drive the vehicle in a safe and prudent manner according to traffic conditions and obey all traffic laws. 1. Start the engine when the engine coolant temperature gauge needle points to C. Allow the engine to idle until the gauge needle points between the C and H (normal operating temperature). 8. Stop the vehicle. Place the shift selector in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) position. 9. Turn the engine off. 10. Repeat steps 1 - 8 at least one more time. If steps 1 through 7 are interrupted, repeat the preceding step. Any safe driving mode is acceptable between steps. Do not stop the engine until step 7 is completed. ● How various systems in your vehicle were operating; ● Whether or not the driver and passenger safety belts were buckled/fastened; ● How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator and/or brake pedal; and, ● How fast the vehicle was traveling. ● Sounds are not recorded. 2. Accelerate the vehicle to 55 MPH (88 km/h), then quickly release the accelerator pedal completely and keep it released for at least 10 seconds. 3. Quickly depress the accelerator pedal for a moment, then drive the vehicle at a speed of 53 - 60 MPH (86 - 96 km/h) for at least 9 minutes. 4. Stop the vehicle. 5. Accelerate the vehicle to 35 MPH (55 km/h) and maintain the speed for 20 seconds. 6. Repeat steps 4 through 5 at least 10 times. 7. Accelerate the vehicle to 55 MPH (88 km/h) and maintain the speed for at least 3 minutes. 9-26 Technical and consumer information This vehicle is equipped with an Event Data Recorder (EDR). The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in certain crash or near crash-like situations, such as an air bag deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data that will assist in understanding how a vehicle’s systems performed. The EDR is designed to record data related to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this vehicle is designed to record such data as: I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : These data can help provide a better understanding of the circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur. NOTE: EDR data are recorded by your vehicle only if a nontrivial crash situation occurs; no data are recorded by the EDR under normal driving conditions and no personal data (e.g. name, gender, age and crash location) are recorded. However, other parties, such as law enforcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of personally identifying data routinely acquired during a crash investigation. OWNER’S MANUAL/SERVICE MANUAL ORDER INFORMATION To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is required and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed. In addition to the vehicle manufacturer and NISSAN dealer, other parties, such as law enforcement, that have the special equipment, can read the information if they have access to the vehicle or the EDR. EDR data will only be accessed with the consent of the vehicle owner or lessee or as otherwise required or permitted by law. A genuine NISSAN Service Manual is the best source of service and repair information for your vehicle. Filled with wiring diagrams, illustrations and step-by-step diagnostic and adjustment procedures, this manual is the same one used by the factory-trained technicians working at NISSAN dealerships. Also available are genuine NISSAN Owner’s Manuals, and genuine NISSAN Service and Owner’s Manuals for older NISSAN models. For Canada To purchase a copy of a genuine NISSAN Service Manual or Owner’s Manual please contact your nearest NISSAN dealer. For the phone number and location of a NISSAN dealer in your area call the NISSAN Information Center at 1-800387-0122 and a bilingual NISSAN representative will assist you. For USA Also available are genuine NISSAN Service and Owner’s Manuals for older NISSAN models. For current pricing and availability of genuine NISSAN Service Manuals for the 2000 model year and later contact: IN THE EVENT OF A COLLISION 1-800-450-9491 www.nissan-techinfo.com Unfortunately, accidents do occur. In this unlikely event, there is some important information you should know. For current pricing and availability of genuine NISSAN Service Manuals for the 1999 model year and prior, see a NISSAN dealer, or contact: Many insurance companies routinely authorize the use of non-genuine collision parts in order to cut costs, among other reasons. 1-800-247-5321 For current pricing and availability of genuine NISSAN Owner’s Manuals for this model year and prior, see a NISSAN dealer, or contact: 1-800-247-5321 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Technical and consumer information 9-27 Insist on the use of genuine NISSAN collision parts! If you want your vehicle to be restored using parts made to NISSAN’s original exacting specifications – if you want to help it to last and hold its resale value, the solution is simple. Tell your insurance agent and your repair shop to only use Genuine NISSAN Collision Parts. NISSAN does not warrant non-NISSAN parts, nor does NISSAN’s warranty apply to damage caused by a non-genuine part. Using Genuine NISSAN Parts can help protect your personal safety, preserve your warranty protection and maintain the resale value of your vehicle. And if your vehicle was leased, using Genuine NISSAN Parts may prevent or limit unnecessary excess wear and tear expenses at the end of your lease. Why should you take a chance? In over 40 states, the law says you must be advised if non-genuine parts are used to repair your vehicle. And some states have enacted laws that restrict insurance companies from authorizing the use of non-genuine collision parts during the new vehicle warranty. These laws help protect you, so you can take action to protect yourself. It’s your right! If you should need further information visit us at: www.nissanusa.com (for U.S. customers) or www.nissan.ca (for Canadian customers). NISSAN designs its hoods with crumple zones to minimize the risk that the hood will penetrate the windshield of your vehicle in an accident. Nongenuine (imitation) parts may not provide such built-in safeguards. Also, non-genuine parts often show premature wear, rust and corrosion. 9-28 Technical and consumer information I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 10 Index A ABS (Anti-lock Braking System). . . . . . . .5-25 Air bag (See supplemental restraint system) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-43 Air bag system Front (See supplemental front impact air bag system) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-50 Side and curtain (See supplemental side air bag and curtain side-impact air bag system) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-55 Air bag warning labels . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-58 Air bag warning light. . . . . . . . . . .1-58, 2-14 Air cleaner housing filter . . . . . . . . . . . .8-18 Air conditioner Air conditioner operation . . . . . . . . . .4-18 Air conditioner service . . . . . . . . . . .4-22 Air conditioner specification label . . . . .9-11 Air conditioner system refrigerant and oil recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-6 Heater and air conditioner controls . . . .4-14 Servicing air conditioner . . . . . . . . . .4-22 Air flow charts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-19 Alarm system (See vehicle security system) . . . . . . . . .2-17 Anchor point locations . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-28 Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-61 Anti-lock brake warning light. . . . . . . . . .2-10 Anti-lock Braking System (ABS). . . . . . . .5-25 Armrests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-7 Audible reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-16 Audio system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-23 Compact disc (CD) player . . . . . . . . . .4-33, 4-36, 4-42, 4-47 FM/AM radio with compact disc (CD) player . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-31, 4-34 FM/AM/SAT radio with compact disc (CD) player . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-38, 4-44 Audio System iPod姞 Player. . . . . . . . . .4-54, 4-55, 4-57 Audio system Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-23 Steering wheel audio control switch . . .4-60 USB interface . . . . . . . . . . . .4-50, 4-52 Automatic Automatic power window switch . . . . .2-35 Automatic door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-6 AUX jack . . . . . . . . . .4-33, 4-37, 4-43, 4-49 B Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Charge warning light . . . . . . . . Before starting the engine . . . . . . . Belt (See drive belt) . . . . . . . . . . Block heater Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Bluetooth姞 hands-free phone system . Booster seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Brake Anti-lock Braking System (ABS). . Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Brake light (See stop light). . . . . Brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-15 .2-11 .5-11 .8-16 . . . .5-29 . . . .4-62 . . . .1-39 . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-25 .8-13 .8-29 .5-24 Brake warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-10 Brake wear indicators . . . . . . . .2-16, 8-21 Parking brake operation . . . . . . . . . .5-19 Self-adjusting brakes . . . . . . . . . . . .8-21 Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-21 Break-in schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-22 Brightness control Instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-23 Brightness/contrast button . . . . . . . . . . .4-8 Bulb check/instrument panel. . . . . . . . . .2-10 Bulb replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-29 C Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2 Car phone or CB radio . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-62 Cargo net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-32 Cargo (See vehicle loading information) . . .9-12 CD care and cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-59 CD player (See audio system) . . . .4-33, 4-36, 4-42, 4-47 Child restraint with top tether strap . . . . . .1-28 Child restraints . . . . . . .1-23, 1-23, 1-24, 1-26 Precautions on child restraints . . . . . . . .1-24, 1-31, 1-35, 1-39 Top tether strap anchor point locations . .1-28 Child safety rear door lock. . . . . . . . . . . .3-7 Chimes, audible reminders. . . . . . . . . . .2-16 Cleaning exterior and interior . . . . . . . . . .7-2 Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-32, 4-35, 4-40 Clutch Clutch fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-14 C.M.V.S.S. certification label . . . . . . . . . .9-10 Cold weather driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-28 Compact disc (CD) player . . . . . . . . . . . .4-33, 4-36, 4-42, 4-47 Console box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-31 Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT). . .5-12 Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-13 Driving with Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-12 Transmission shift selector lock release . .5-16 Control panel buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-2 Brightness/contrast button . . . . . . . . . .4-8 Enter button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-2 Setting button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-5 Controls Audio controls (steering wheel). . . . . . .4-60 Heater and air conditioner controls. . . . .4-14 Coolant Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2 Changing engine coolant . . . . . . . . . . .8-9 Checking engine coolant level . . . . . . . .8-8 Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . .2-7 Corrosion protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-6 Cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-20 Cup holders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-30 Curtain side-impact air bag system (See supplemental side air bag and curtain side-impact air bag system). . . . . . . . . . .1-55 10-2 D Daytime running light system (Canada only) . .2-23 Defroster switch Rear window and outside mirror defroster switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21 Dimensions and weights . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-8 Dimmer switch for instrument panel . . . . . .2-23 Display controls (see control panel buttons) . .4-2 Door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4, 3-5 Door open warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-11 Drive belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-16 Driving Cold weather driving . . . . . . . . . . . .5-28 Driving with Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-12 Driving with manual transmission . . . . . .5-17 Precautions when starting and driving . . . .5-2 E Economy - fuel . . . . . . . . . . . Emission control information label Emission control system warranty Engine Before starting the engine. . . Block heater . . . . . . . . . . Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . Changing engine coolant . . . Changing engine oil . . . . . . Changing engine oil filter . . . Checking engine coolant level Checking engine oil level . . . I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : . . . . . . .5-22 . . . . . . .9-11 . . . . . . .9-25 . . . . . . .5-11 . . . . . . .5-29 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2 . .8-9 .8-11 .8-12 . .8-8 . .8-9 Engine compartment check locations . . Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . Engine cooling system . . . . . . . . . . Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine oil and oil filter recommendation . Engine oil pressure warning light . . . . . Engine oil viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine serial number . . . . . . . . . . . Engine specifications . . . . . . . . . . . Starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine oil pressure gauge . . . . . . . . . . Enter button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Event data recorders . . . . . . . . . . . . . Exhaust gas (Carbon monoxide) . . . . . . . Eyeglass case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-6 . .2-7 . .8-8 . .8-9 . .9-5 .2-11 . .9-5 .9-10 . .9-7 .5-11 . .2-7 . .4-2 .9-26 . .5-2 .2-28 F Flashers (See hazard warning flasher switch) . . . . . .2-24 Flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-2 Floor mat positioning aid . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-5 Fluid Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-13 Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2 Clutch fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-14 Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-13 Engine coolant. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-8 Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-9 F.M.V.S.S. certification label. . . . . . . . . . .9-10 Fog light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-24 Folding rear seat . . . . . . . . . . . .1-3, 1-4, 1-5 Front air bag system (See supplemental restraint system) . Front seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel economy . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel octane rating . . . . . . . . . Fuel recommendation . . . . . . . Fuel-filler door and cap . . . . . . Fuel-filler door lock opener lever . Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fusible links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-50 . . . . . .1-2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2 .5-22 . .2-6 . .9-4 . .9-3 .3-25 .3-25 .8-22 .8-23 G Gas cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gauge Engine coolant temperature gauge Engine oil pressure gauge . . . . . Fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . g-force gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . Trip computer . . . . . . . . . . . . Trip odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . General maintenance . . . . . . . . . . g-force gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Glove box. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Glove box lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Grocery hooks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H Hands-free phone system, Bluetooth姞 . Hazard warning flasher switch . . . . . Headlight and turn signal switch . . . . Headlight control switch . . . . . . . . Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Heated seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Heater Heater and air conditioner controls. Heater operation . . . . . . . . . . . Hood release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-62 .2-24 .2-22 .2-22 .8-28 .2-26 . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-14 .4-17 .3-23 .2-25 I . . . .3-25 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-7 . .2-7 . .2-6 . .2-6 . .2-4 . .2-4 . .2-5 . .2-4 . .2-4 . .8-2 . .2-6 .2-31 .2-31 .2-33 Ignition switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-7 Immobilizer system . . . . . . . . .2-19, 3-2, 5-10 Important vehicle information label . . . . . . .9-10 In-cabin microfilter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-19 Increasing fuel economy. . . . . . . . . . . . .5-22 Indicator lights and audible reminders (See warning/indicator lights and audible reminders) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-9 Inside mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-28 Instrument brightness control . . . . . . . . . .2-23 Instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .0-6, 2-2 Instrument panel dimmer switch . . . . . . . .2-23 Intelligent Key system Key operating range . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-13 Key operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-14 Mechanical key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4 Remote keyless entry operation. . . . . . .3-17 Troubleshooting guide . . . . . . . . . . . .3-22 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Warning signals . . Interior light. . . . . . . Interior trunk lid release iPod姞 Player . . . . . . ISOFIX child restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-22 . . . . . . . .2-39 . . . . . . . .3-24 .4-54, 4-55, 4-57 . . . . . . . .1-26 J Jump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-8 K Keyfob battery replacement . . . . . . . . . . .8-25 Keyless entry With Intelligent Key system (See Intelligent Key system). . . . . . . . .3-17 Keys, Except Intelligent Key. . . . . . . . . . . .3-2 L Labels Air conditioner specification label . . . . .9-11 C.M.V.S.S. certification label . . . . . . . .9-10 Emission control information label . . . . .9-11 Engine serial number . . . . . . . . . . . .9-10 F.M.V.S.S. certification label. . . . . . . . .9-10 Tire and Loading Information label . . . . .9-11 Vehicle identification number (VIN) plate . .9-9 Warning labels (for SRS) . . . . . . . . . .1-58 LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-26 License plate Installing the license plate . . . . . . . . . .9-12 10-3 Light Air bag warning light . . . . . . . . .1-58, 2-14 Brake light (See stop light) . . . . . . . . .8-29 Bulb check/instrument panel . . . . . . . .2-10 Bulb replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-29 Charge warning light . . . . . . . . . . . .2-11 Fog light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-24 Headlight and turn signal switch . . . . . .2-22 Headlight control switch . . . . . . . . . .2-22 Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-28 Interior light. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-39 Light bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-28 Low tire pressure warning light . . . . . . .2-12 Low windshield-washer fluid warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-13 Passenger air bag and status light . . . . .1-52 Security indicator light. . . . . . . . . . . .2-15 Spotlights (See map light) . . . . . . . . .2-40 Trunk light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-41 Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-9 Lights Map lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-40 Lock Child safety rear door lock . . . . . . . . . .3-7 Door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4, 3-5 Fuel-filler door lock opener lever . . . . . .3-25 Glove box lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-31 Power door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-6 Trunk lid lock opener lever. . . . . . . . . .3-24 Low fuel warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-12 Low tire pressure warning light . . . . . . . . .2-12 Low windshield-washer fluid warning light. . .2-13 Luggage (See vehicle loading information) . .9-12 10-4 Oil M Maintenance General maintenance . . . . . Inside the vehicle . . . . . . . Maintenance precautions . . . Outside the vehicle . . . . . . Seat belt maintenance. . . . . Under the hood and vehicle . Malfunction indicator light . . . . . Manual front seat adjustment . . . Manual windows . . . . . . . . . . Map lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . Map pocket. . . . . . . . . . . . . Meters and gauges . . . . . . . . Instrument brightness control . Mirror Inside mirror . . . . . . . . . . Outside mirror control . . . . . Vanity mirror . . . . . . . . . . Moonroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-2 . .8-3 . .8-5 . .8-2 .1-22 . .8-4 .2-15 . .1-2 .2-37 .2-40 .2-27 . .2-3 .2-23 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-28 .3-28 .3-27 .2-37 N NISSAN Intelligent Key™. . . . . . . . . .3-3, 3-11 NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-19, 3-2, 5-10 O Octane rating (See fuel octane rating). . . . . .9-4 Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Changing engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . Changing engine oil filter . . . . . . . . . Checking engine oil level . . . . . . . . . Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine oil and oil filter recommendation . Engine oil viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . Outside mirror control . . . . . . . . . . . . . Overheat If your vehicle overheats . . . . . . . . . . Owner’s manual order form . . . . . . . . . . Owner’s manual/service manual order information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2 .8-11 .8-12 . .8-9 . .8-9 . .9-5 . .9-5 .3-28 .6-11 .9-27 .9-27 P Parking Parking brake operation . . . . . . . . . . .5-19 Parking/parking on hills . . . . . . . . . . .5-23 Phone, Bluetooth姞 hands-free system . . . . .4-62 Power Power door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-6 Power outlet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-26 Power rear windows . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-35 Power steering system . . . . . . . . . . .5-24 Power windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-34 Rear power windows . . . . . . . . . . . .2-35 Precautions Maintenance precautions . . . . . . . . . . .8-5 Precautions on child restraints. . . . . . . . .1-24, 1-31, 1-35, 1-39 Precautions on seat belt usage . . . . . . .1-13 Precautions on supplemental restraint system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Precautions when starting and driving . Programmable features . . . . . . . . . . . Push starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-43 . .5-2 . .4-5 .6-10 R Radio Car phone or CB radio . . . . . . . . . . .4-62 FM/AM radio with compact disc (CD) player . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-31, 4-34 FM/AM/SAT radio with compact disc (CD) player . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-38, 4-44 Steering wheel audio control switch . . . .4-60 Readiness for inspection maintenance (I/M) test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-25 Rear center seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-19 Rear power windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-35 Rear seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-3, 1-4, 1-5 Rear window and outside mirror defroster switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21 RearView Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-8 Recorders Event data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-26 Refrigerant recommendation . . . . . . . . . . .9-6 Registering your vehicle in another country . . .9-9 Reporting safety defects (US only) . . . . . . .9-25 S Safety Child safety rear door lock . . . . . . . . . .3-7 Child seat belts . . . . .1-24, 1-31, 1-35, 1-39 Reporting safety defects (US only) . . . . .9-25 Seat adjustment Front manual seat adjustment . . . . . . . .1-2 Seat belt Child safety. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-23 Infants and small children . . . . . . . . . .1-23 Injured Person . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-16 Larger children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-24 Precautions on seat belt usage . . . . . . .1-13 Pregnant women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-16 Rear center seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . .1-19 Seat belt extenders . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-22 Seat belt maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . .1-22 Seat belts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-13 Shoulder belt height adjustment . . . . . .1-21 Three-point type with retractor . . . . . . .1-16 Seat belt warning light. . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-13 Seatback pockets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-29 Seats Adjustment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-2 Front seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-2 Heated seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-26 Manual front seat adjustment . . . . . . . . .1-2 Rear seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-3, 1-4, 1-5 Security indicator light. . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-15 Security system (NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system), engine start . . . . . . . .2-19, 3-2, 5-10 Self-adjusting brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-21 Service manual order form . . . . . . . . . . .9-27 Servicing air conditioner. . . . . . . . . . . . .4-22 Setting button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-5 Shift lock release. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-16 Shifting Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-13 Manual transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-18 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : Shoulder belt height adjustment . . . . . . . .1-21 Side air bag system (See supplemental side air bag and curtain side-impact air bag system) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-55 Spark plug replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-17 Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4 Spotlights (See map light) . . . . . . . . . . .2-40 SRS warning label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-58 Starting Before starting the engine. . . . . . . . . .5-11 Jump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-8 Precautions when starting and driving . . . .5-2 Push starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-10 Starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-11 Steering Power steering system . . . . . . . . . . .5-24 Tilting steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . . .3-27 Steering wheel audio control switch . . . . . .4-60 Stop light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-29 Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-27 Storage bin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-28 Storage tray . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-28 Sunglasses case. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-28 Sunglasses holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-28 Sunroof (see Moonroof) . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-37 Supplemental air bag warning labels . . . . . .1-58 Supplemental air bag warning light . . .1-58, 2-14 Supplemental front impact air bag system . . .1-50 Supplemental restraint system Information and warning labels . . . . . . .1-58 Precautions on supplemental restraint system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-43 Supplemental restraint system (Supplemental air bag system) . . . . . . . . .1-43 Supplemental side and curtain side-impact air bag system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-55 10-5 Switch Automatic power window switch . . . . . .2-35 Fog light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-24 Hazard warning flasher switch . . . . . . .2-24 Headlight and turn signal switch . . . . . .2-22 Headlight control switch . . . . . . . . . .2-22 Ignition switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-7 Power door lock switch . . . . . . . . . . . .3-6 Rear window and outside mirror defroster switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21 Turn signal switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-24 Vehicle dynamic control (VDC) off switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-25 Windshield wiper and washer switch . . .2-20 T Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-5 Temperature gauge Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . .2-7 Theft (NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system), engine start . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-19, 3-2, 5-10 Three-way catalyst . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-2 Tilting steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-27 Tire Flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-2 Spare tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-3, 8-41 Tire and Loading Information label . . . . .9-11 Tire chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-38 Tire placard. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-11 Tire pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-31 Tire rotation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-38 Types of tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-37 Uniform tire quality grading . . . . . . . . .9-24 Wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-31 10-6 Wheel/tire size. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-8 Tire pressure Low tire pressure warning light . . . . . . .2-12 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) . . . .5-3 Top tether strap child restraint . . . . . . . . .1-28 Towing Flat towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-23 Tow truck towing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-12 Towing load/specification . . . . . . . . . .9-19 Trailer towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-16 Transmission Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-13 Driving with Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-12 Driving with manual transmission . . . . . .5-17 Selector lock release . . . . . . . . . . . .5-16 Travel (See registering your vehicle in another country) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-9 Trip computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4 Trip odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4 Trunk access through the rear seat . . . . .1-4, 1-5 Trunk lid lock opener lever. . . . . . . . . . . .3-24 Trunk light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-41 Turn signal switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-24 U Uniform tire quality grading . . . . . . . . . . .9-24 USB interface Audio file operation . . . . . . . . . .4-50, 4-52 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : V Vanity mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-27 Vehicle dimensions and weights . . . . . . . . .9-8 Vehicle dynamic control (VDC) off switch . . .2-25 Vehicle dynamic control (VDC) system. . . . .5-26 Vehicle identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-9 Vehicle identification number (VIN) (Chassis number) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-9 Vehicle identification number (VIN) plate . . . .9-9 Vehicle loading information . . . . . . . . . . .9-12 Vehicle recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-14 Vehicle security system . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-17 Vehicle security system (NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system), engine start. .2-19, 3-2, 5-10 Ventilators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-14 W Warning Air bag warning light . . . . . . . . .1-58, 2-14 Anti-lock brake warning light . . . . . . . .2-10 Battery charge warning light . . . . . . . .2-11 Brake warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-10 Door open warning light . . . . . . . . . . .2-11 Engine oil pressure warning light . . . . . .2-11 Hazard warning flasher switch . . . . . . .2-24 Low fuel warning light . . . . . . . . . . . .2-12 Low tire pressure warning light . . . . . . .2-12 Low windshield-washer fluid warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-13 Passenger air bag and status light . . . . .1-52 Seat belt warning light. . . . . . . . . . . .2-13 Vehicle security system . . . . . . . . . . .2-17 Warning labels (for SRS) . . . . . . . . Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Washer switch Windshield wiper and washer switch . Weights (See dimensions and weights) . . Wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Wheel/tire size. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . When traveling or registering your vehicle in another country . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Windows Locking passengers’ windows . . . . . Manual windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power rear windows . . . . . . . . . . . Power windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rear power windows . . . . . . . . . . Windshield wiper and washer switch . . . Windshield-washer fluid. . . . . . . . . . . Wiper Windshield wiper and washer switch . Wiper blades. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-58 . . .2-9 . . .2-9 . . . . .2-20 . .9-8 .8-31 . .9-8 . . .9-9 . . . . . . . .2-35 .2-37 .2-35 .2-34 .2-35 .2-20 .8-14 . .2-20 . .8-20 I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : 10-7 GAS STATION INFORMATION RECOMMENDED FUEL: MR20DE and QR25DE engine except Spec-V Use unleaded regular gasoline with an octane rating of at least 87 AKI (Anti-Knock Index) number (Research octane number 91). QR25DE engine Spec-V only Use unleaded premium gasoline with an octane rating of at least 91 AKI (Anti-Knock Index) number (Research octane number 96). If unleaded premium gasoline is not available, unleaded regular gasoline with an octane rating of at lease 87 AKI (Research octane number 91) can be used, but only under the following precautions: ● have the fuel tank filled only partially with unleaded regular gasoline, and fill up with unleaded premium as soon as possible. ● avoid full throttle driving and abrupt acceleration. However, for maximum vehicle performance, the use of unleaded premium gasoline is recommended. CAUTION ● Using a fuel other than that specified could adversely affect the emission control system, and may also affect the warranty coverage. ● Under no circumstances should a leaded gasoline be used, because this will damage the three-way catalyst. ● Do not use E-85 fuel in your vehicle. Your vehicle is not designed to run on E-85 fuel. Using E-85 fuel can damage the fuel system components and is not covered by the NISSAN new vehicle limited warranty. For additional information, see “Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants in the “Technical and consumer information” section. RECOMMENDED ENGINE OIL: ● Engine oil with API Certification Mark ● Viscosity SAE 5W-30 See “Engine oil and oil filter recommendations” in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual. I nf or mat i onPr ov i dedby : COLD TIRE PRESSURE: See Tire and Loading Information label. The label is typically located on the driver side center pillar or on the driver’s door. For additional information, see “Wheels and tires” in the “Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual. RECOMMENDED NEW VEHICLE BREAK-IN PROCEDURE: During the first 1,200 miles (2,000 km) of vehicle use, follow the recommendations outlined in the “Break-in schedule” information found in the “Starting and driving” section of this manual. Follow these recommendations for the future reliability and economy of your new vehicle. Failure to follow these recommendations may result in vehicle damage or shortened engine life. Printing : February 2010 Publication No.: OM0E 0B16U2 I nf or mat i onPr dby : Printed inovideU.S.A. B16-D
Source Exif Data:
File Type : PDF File Type Extension : pdf MIME Type : application/pdf PDF Version : 1.6 Linearized : Yes Author : Create Date : 2009:10:30 10:07:04-04:00 Keywords : nissan;, sentra;, 2010;, owner, manual;, owner’s, manual;, pdf;, vehicle, manual Modify Date : 2013:04:23 12:12:34-05:00 Has XFA : No XMP Toolkit : Adobe XMP Core 5.2-c001 63.139439, 2010/09/27-13:37:26 Producer : Creo Normalizer JTP Trapped : False Metadata Date : 2013:04:23 12:12:34-05:00 Document ID : uuid:679206ee-6ed5-4677-a998-d1483a94abf2 Instance ID : uuid:822b19e6-4d52-4b44-abb6-e29609b0b3f5 Format : application/pdf Title : 2010 Nissan Sentra Owner's Manual Description : Download the 2010 Nissan Sentra Owner's Manual at the official Nissan web site. Creator : Subject : 285569 (rnc 250334) Page Layout : SinglePage Page Mode : UseOutlines Page Count : 360EXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools